1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printable and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generates the outermost <book> element that wraps the entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
48 .set previousversion "4.92"
49 .include ./local_params
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I " "
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name.
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be in Roman.
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- a small number of other 2-column tables override it.
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for ASCII
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and UnixWare.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
352 The use, supply, or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of Exim,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
374 .cindex "documentation"
375 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
376 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
377 renditions of this document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
378 capable of showing a change indicator.
380 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
381 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
382 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
383 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
384 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
385 Furthermore, this manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
386 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389 .cindex "books about Exim"
390 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
391 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
392 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
393 (&url(https://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
395 The book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
396 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
397 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
398 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
400 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
401 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
402 Debian-specific features in the file
403 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
404 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
408 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
410 As Exim develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
411 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
412 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
413 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
414 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
416 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
417 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
418 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
419 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
421 All changes to Exim (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
422 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
424 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
425 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
426 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
430 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
431 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
432 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
433 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
434 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
435 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
436 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
437 .row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
440 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
441 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
442 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
446 .section "FTP site and websites" "SECID2"
449 The primary site for Exim source distributions is the &%exim.org%& FTP site,
450 available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP. These services, and the &%exim.org%&
451 website, are hosted at the University of Cambridge.
455 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim website contains a number of
456 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
457 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(https://wiki.exim.org)),
458 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
459 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
460 The wiki site should always redirect to the correct place, which is currently
461 provided by GitHub, and is open to editing by anyone with a GitHub account.
464 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
465 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
466 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
467 Please do not ask for configuration help in the bug-tracker.
470 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
471 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
472 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
476 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
477 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
478 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
481 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
482 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
483 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
484 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
485 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488 &url(https://alioth-lists.debian.net/cgi-bin/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
490 Please ask Debian-specific questions on that list and not on the general Exim
493 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
494 .cindex "bug reports"
495 .cindex "reporting bugs"
496 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
497 via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
498 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
499 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
503 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
505 .cindex "HTTPS download site"
506 .cindex "distribution" "FTP site"
507 .cindex "distribution" "https site"
508 The master distribution site for the Exim distribution is
510 &url(https://downloads.exim.org/)
512 The service is available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP.
513 We encourage people to migrate to HTTPS.
515 The content served at &url(https://downloads.exim.org/) is identical to the
516 content served at &url(https://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim) and
517 &url(ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim).
519 If accessing via a hostname containing &'ftp'&, then the file references that
520 follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at these sites.
521 If accessing via the hostname &'downloads'& then the subdirectories described
522 here are top-level directories.
524 There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
527 Within the top exim directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
534 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
536 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The three
537 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
538 The &_.xz_& file is usually the smallest, while the &_.gz_& file is the
539 most portable to old systems.
541 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
542 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
543 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
544 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
545 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
546 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
547 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
548 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from the Exim Maintainer's
549 PGP keys, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
550 &_Exim-Maintainers-Keyring.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
551 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
553 At the time of the last update, releases were being made by Jeremy Harris and signed
554 with key &'0xBCE58C8CE41F32DF'&. Other recent keys used for signing are those
555 of Heiko Schlittermann, &'0x26101B62F69376CE'&,
556 and of Phil Pennock, &'0x4D1E900E14C1CC04'&.
558 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
560 &_exim-n.nn.tar.xz.asc_&
561 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
562 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
564 For each released version, the log of changes is made available in a
565 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
566 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
568 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
569 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
570 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
571 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
573 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
574 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
579 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& and &_.xz_& forms.
582 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
584 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
585 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
586 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
587 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
588 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
589 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
590 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
592 .cindex "domainless addresses"
593 .cindex "address" "without domain"
594 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
595 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
596 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
597 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
600 .cindex "transport" "external"
601 .cindex "external transports"
602 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
603 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
604 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
605 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
606 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
607 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
609 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
610 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
611 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
614 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
615 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
616 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
617 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
618 a number of common scanners are provided.
622 .section "Runtime configuration" "SECID7"
623 Exim's runtime configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
624 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
625 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
626 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
627 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
630 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
631 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
632 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
633 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
634 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
635 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
636 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
637 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages in the queue) do so in Exim's own
638 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
639 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
640 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
641 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
643 Control of messages in the queue can be done via certain privileged command
644 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
645 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
646 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
650 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
651 .cindex "terminology definitions"
652 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
653 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
654 It is the last part of a message and is separated from the &'header'& (see
655 below) by a blank line.
657 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
658 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
659 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
660 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
661 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
662 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
663 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
664 rise to further bounce messages.
666 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
667 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
668 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
671 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
672 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
673 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
676 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
677 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
678 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
680 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
681 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
682 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
683 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
684 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
685 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
686 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
687 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
689 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
690 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
691 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
692 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
693 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
694 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
697 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
698 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
699 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to the
700 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
701 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
703 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
704 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
705 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
706 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
707 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
708 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
710 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
711 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
714 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
715 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery
716 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
717 Exim's case, the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
718 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
720 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
721 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
722 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
723 is used by other MTAs and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
724 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
726 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
727 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
728 messages in its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
729 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
730 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
731 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
738 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
742 .cindex "incorporated code"
743 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
746 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
749 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
750 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
751 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
752 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
753 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
754 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
756 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
757 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
758 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
759 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
760 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
761 following statements:
764 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
766 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
767 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
768 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
770 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
771 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
772 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
773 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
774 restrictions applied to it).
777 .cindex "SPA authentication"
778 .cindex "Samba project"
779 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
780 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
781 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
782 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
786 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
787 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
788 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
789 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
790 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
791 conditions expressed therein.
794 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
796 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
797 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
801 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
802 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
804 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
805 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
806 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
809 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
810 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
811 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
812 details, please contact
814 Office of Technology Transfer
815 Carnegie Mellon University
817 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
818 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
819 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
822 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
825 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
826 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(https://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
828 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
829 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
830 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
831 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
832 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
833 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
834 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
839 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
842 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
843 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
844 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
845 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
848 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
849 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
853 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
854 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
855 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
856 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
857 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
858 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
859 software without specific, written prior permission.
861 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
862 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
863 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
864 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
865 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
866 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
871 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
872 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
873 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
874 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
875 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
879 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
880 not covered by any specific license requirements. It is assumed that the
881 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
888 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
892 "Receiving and delivering mail"
895 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
896 .cindex "design philosophy"
897 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
898 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
899 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
900 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
901 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
902 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
905 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
906 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
907 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
908 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs from being abused as
909 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
910 unsolicited junk and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
911 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
914 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
915 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
916 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
917 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
918 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
919 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
920 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
921 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
922 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
925 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
926 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
928 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
929 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
930 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
931 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
933 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
934 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
935 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
936 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
937 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
939 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
940 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
941 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
943 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
944 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
945 runs at the start of every delivery process.
950 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
951 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
952 .cindex "Sieve filter"
953 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
954 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
955 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
956 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
957 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
958 of filtering are available:
961 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
964 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
965 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
968 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
972 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
973 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
974 .cindex "format" "of message id"
975 .cindex "id of message"
980 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
981 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
982 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
983 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
984 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
985 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
986 id is used to construct filenames, and the names of files in those systems are
987 not always case-sensitive.
989 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
990 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
991 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
992 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
993 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
994 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
998 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
999 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1000 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1001 way of representing the date and time of day).
1003 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1004 received the message.
1006 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1008 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1009 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1010 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1011 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1012 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1014 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1015 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1016 (1/100) of a second.
1020 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1021 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1022 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1023 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1024 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1027 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1028 .cindex "receiving mail"
1029 .cindex "message" "reception"
1030 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1031 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1032 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1033 there are several possibilities:
1036 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1037 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1038 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1040 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1041 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1042 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1043 command. This is called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1044 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1045 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1047 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1048 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1049 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1050 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1051 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1053 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1054 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1055 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1056 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1060 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1061 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1062 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1063 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1064 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1065 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1066 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1067 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender addresses
1068 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1069 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1070 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1071 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1072 users to change sender addresses.
1074 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1075 checking by the non-SMTP ACL if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1076 (either over TCP/IP or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1077 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1078 individual recipients or the entire message can be rejected if local policy
1079 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1080 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1082 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1083 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1084 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1085 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1086 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1087 message is received.
1093 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1094 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1095 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1096 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1097 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1098 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1099 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1100 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1102 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1103 By default, all these message files are held in a single directory called
1104 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1105 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1106 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1107 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1108 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1109 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1110 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1111 affect file system performance.
1113 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1114 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1115 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1116 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1117 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1119 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1120 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1121 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1122 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1123 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1124 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1125 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1126 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1127 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1128 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1129 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1130 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1134 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1135 .cindex "message" "life of"
1136 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1137 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1138 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1139 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1140 cannot proceed &-- for example when a message can neither be delivered to its
1141 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1142 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1144 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1145 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1146 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1147 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1148 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1151 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1152 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1153 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1154 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1155 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to all frozen messages.
1157 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1158 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1159 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1160 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1161 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1162 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1163 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator and are normally
1164 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1165 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1166 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1169 .cindex "journal file"
1170 .cindex "file" "journal"
1171 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1172 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1173 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1174 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1175 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1176 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1177 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1178 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1180 Should the system or Exim crash after a successful delivery but before
1181 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1182 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1183 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1184 deliveries caused by crashes.
1188 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1189 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1190 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1191 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1192 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1193 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1194 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1195 specify which ones are included in the binary. Runtime options specify which
1196 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1198 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1199 Each driver that is specified in the runtime configuration is an &'instance'&
1200 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1201 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1202 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1203 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1204 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1205 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1206 the driver's features in general.
1208 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1209 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1210 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1211 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1214 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1215 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1216 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1217 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1218 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1219 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1221 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1222 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1223 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1224 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1225 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1226 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1228 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1229 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1230 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1233 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1234 addresses in domains that are not recognized specifically by the local host.
1235 Typically these are addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1236 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1237 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1238 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1239 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1240 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1241 configured to fail the address.
1243 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1244 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1245 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1246 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1247 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1248 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1250 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1251 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1252 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1253 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1254 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1255 the address is bounced.
1259 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1260 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1261 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1262 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1263 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1264 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1265 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1266 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1268 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1269 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1270 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1271 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1272 sends all messages to a message-scanning program unless they have been
1273 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1274 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1275 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1280 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1281 .cindex "router" "running details"
1282 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1283 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1284 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1285 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1286 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1287 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1291 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1292 transport or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1293 original address ceases
1294 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1295 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1296 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1297 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1298 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1301 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1302 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1303 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1304 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1305 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1307 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1308 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default, the address
1309 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1310 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1311 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1313 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1314 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1315 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1316 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1317 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1319 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1320 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1321 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1323 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1324 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1325 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1326 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1328 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1329 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1332 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1333 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1334 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1335 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1336 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1338 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1339 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1340 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1341 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1342 facility for this purpose.
1345 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1346 .cindex "case of local parts"
1347 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1348 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1349 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1350 and remote transports and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1351 check, local parts are treated case-sensitively. This happens only when
1352 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1353 routed addresses are shown.
1357 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1358 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1359 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1360 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1361 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1362 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1365 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1366 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1367 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1368 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1369 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1370 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1371 of any other conditions.
1373 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1374 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1375 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1377 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1378 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1379 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1380 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1381 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1383 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1384 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1385 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1386 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1387 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1389 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1390 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1391 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1393 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1394 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1396 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1397 of domains that it defines.
1399 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1400 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1402 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1403 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1404 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1405 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1406 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1407 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1408 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1409 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1411 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1412 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1414 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1415 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1416 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1417 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1418 remaining preconditions.
1420 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1421 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1422 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1423 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1424 could lead to confusion.
1426 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1427 set of addresses that it defines.
1429 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1430 specified files is tested.
1432 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1433 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1434 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1435 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1439 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1440 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1441 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1442 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1443 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1444 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1445 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1449 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1450 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1451 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1454 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1455 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1456 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1457 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1458 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1460 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1461 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1463 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1464 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1465 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1466 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1467 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1468 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1471 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router, in turn, subject to
1472 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1473 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1474 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1475 processed entirely independently of each other.
1477 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1478 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1479 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1480 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1481 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1482 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1483 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1484 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1485 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1487 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1488 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1489 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1490 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1491 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1492 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1493 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1494 addresses to the same domain.
1496 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1497 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1498 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1499 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1500 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1501 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1502 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1503 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1505 .cindex "queue runner"
1506 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1507 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1508 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1509 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1510 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1511 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1512 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1513 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1514 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1516 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1517 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1518 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1519 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1520 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1521 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1523 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1524 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1525 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1526 messages to other addresses.
1528 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1529 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1530 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1533 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1534 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1535 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1541 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1542 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1543 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1544 .cindex "queue runner"
1545 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1546 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1547 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1548 intervals or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1549 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1550 first attempt will remain in your queue forever. A queue runner process works
1551 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1552 passed its retry time.
1553 You can run several queue runners at once.
1555 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1556 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1557 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1558 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1559 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1564 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1565 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1566 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1567 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1568 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1569 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1570 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1571 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1572 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1575 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1576 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1577 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1579 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1580 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1581 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1582 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1583 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1588 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1589 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1590 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1591 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1592 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1593 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1594 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1595 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1596 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1597 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1598 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1600 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1601 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1602 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1605 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1606 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1607 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1608 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1609 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1610 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1611 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1616 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1617 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1618 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1619 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left in the queue,
1620 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1621 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1622 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1623 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1630 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1632 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1633 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1635 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1636 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1637 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1638 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1641 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1642 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1644 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1645 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1646 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1647 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1651 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1652 following subdirectories are created:
1655 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1656 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1657 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1658 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1659 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1660 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1661 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1664 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory and are built
1665 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1666 that may be useful to some sites.
1669 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1670 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1671 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1672 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1673 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1674 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1676 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1677 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1678 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1679 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1680 overridden if necessary.
1681 .cindex compiler requirements
1682 .cindex compiler version
1683 A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1686 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1687 .cindex "PCRE library"
1688 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1689 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need to
1690 install the PCRE package or the PCRE development package for your operating
1691 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1692 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1693 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1694 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1695 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1696 If your operating system has no
1697 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1698 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1699 More information on PCRE is available at &url(https://www.pcre.org/).
1701 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1702 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1703 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1704 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1705 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1706 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1707 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1709 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1710 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1711 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1712 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1713 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1714 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1715 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1716 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1718 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1719 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1720 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1721 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1722 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1723 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1724 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1725 Berkeley DB library.
1727 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1728 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1732 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1733 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1735 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1736 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1737 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1738 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1739 filename is used unmodified.
1741 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1742 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1743 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1744 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1746 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1747 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1748 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1750 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1751 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1752 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions when Exim last revamped support were numbered 4.&'x'&.
1753 Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All versions of
1754 Berkeley DB could be obtained from
1755 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/), which is now a redirect to their new owner's
1756 page with far newer versions listed.
1757 It is probably wise to plan to move your storage configurations away from
1758 Berkeley DB format, as today there are smaller and simpler alternatives more
1759 suited to Exim's usage model.
1761 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1762 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1763 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/tdb/files/). It has its own interface, and also
1764 operates on a single file.
1768 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1769 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1770 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1771 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1772 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1776 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1777 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1779 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1780 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1781 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1782 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1783 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1784 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1786 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1787 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1788 in one of these lines:
1793 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1794 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1795 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1796 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1799 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1800 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1802 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1803 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1807 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1808 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1809 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1810 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1811 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1812 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1813 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1814 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1815 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1816 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1817 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1818 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1820 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1821 without them. They are the location of the runtime configuration file
1822 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1823 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1824 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1825 a colon-separated list of filenames; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1827 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1828 at runtime, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1829 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1830 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1831 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at runtime, so that errors
1832 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1835 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1836 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1837 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1838 facilities, you need to set
1840 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1842 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1843 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1846 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1847 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1848 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1849 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1850 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1851 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1852 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1854 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1855 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1856 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1857 configuration files, for example, to change the C compiler, which
1858 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1863 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1864 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1866 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1867 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1868 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1869 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1870 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1871 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1872 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1874 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1875 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1876 &url(https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1877 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1878 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1882 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1886 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1887 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1888 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1889 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1890 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1891 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1892 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1893 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1894 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1895 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1898 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1899 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1902 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1905 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1907 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1908 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1911 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1912 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1914 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1915 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1918 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1920 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1921 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1925 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1927 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1928 library and include files. For example:
1932 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1933 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1935 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1936 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1940 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1943 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1944 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1945 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1950 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1952 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1953 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1954 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1955 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1956 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1957 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1958 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1959 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1960 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1961 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1962 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1963 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1966 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1967 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1968 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1970 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1971 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1973 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1975 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1976 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1977 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1978 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1979 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1980 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1984 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1985 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1986 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1987 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1988 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1989 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1992 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1993 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1994 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1995 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1996 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1998 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
2003 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2004 .cindex "lookup modules"
2005 .cindex "dynamic modules"
2006 .cindex ".so building"
2007 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2008 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2010 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2011 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2013 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2015 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2016 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2017 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2018 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2019 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2020 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2022 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2023 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2024 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2033 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2034 .cindex "build directory"
2035 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2036 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2037 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2038 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2039 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2040 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2041 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2043 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2044 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2045 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2046 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2047 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2048 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2049 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2050 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2052 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2053 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2054 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2058 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2059 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2060 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2061 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2062 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2063 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2064 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2068 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2069 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2070 given in addition to the short output.
2074 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2075 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2076 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2077 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2078 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2079 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2080 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2083 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2084 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2086 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2087 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2088 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2089 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2091 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2092 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2093 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2094 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2095 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2096 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2097 and are often not needed.
2099 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2100 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2101 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2102 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2103 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2104 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2105 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2106 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2107 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2110 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2111 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2112 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2113 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2117 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2118 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2119 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2120 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2121 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2122 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2123 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2124 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2125 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2126 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2127 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2128 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2129 containing the lines
2134 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2135 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2137 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2138 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2139 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2142 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2143 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2144 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2145 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2146 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2147 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2148 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2149 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2150 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2151 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2157 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2158 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2159 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2160 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2161 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2162 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2163 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2164 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause runtime configuration
2167 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2168 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2169 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2170 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2171 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2172 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2173 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2174 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2175 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2176 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2177 syntax. For instance:
2180 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2182 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2183 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2184 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2187 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2188 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2189 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2193 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2194 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2196 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2197 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2198 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2199 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2200 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2201 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2204 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2205 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2207 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2208 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2211 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2212 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2214 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2215 definition of all three of these variables into your
2216 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2219 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2220 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2221 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2222 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2224 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2225 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2226 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2227 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2228 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2231 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2232 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2233 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2234 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2235 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2238 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2240 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2241 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2242 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2243 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2244 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2245 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2249 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2250 .cindex "building Eximon"
2251 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2252 where the files that are involved are
2254 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2255 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2256 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2257 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2258 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2259 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2261 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2262 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2263 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2264 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2265 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2266 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2267 LOG_DEPTH at runtime.
2271 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2272 .cindex "installing Exim"
2273 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2274 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2275 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2276 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2277 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2278 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2279 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2280 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2281 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2282 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2283 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2284 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2286 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2287 Exim's runtime configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2288 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2289 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2290 by the installation script. If a runtime configuration file already exists, it
2291 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2292 alternative files, no default is installed.
2294 .cindex "system aliases file"
2295 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2296 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2297 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2298 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2299 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2300 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2301 and outputs a comment to the user.
2303 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2304 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2305 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2306 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2307 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2309 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2310 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2311 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2312 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2313 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2316 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2317 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2320 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2322 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2323 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2324 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2325 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2326 but this usage is deprecated.
2328 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2329 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2330 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2331 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2332 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2333 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2335 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2336 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2337 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2338 for example, &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2339 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2340 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2341 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2343 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2344 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2345 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2348 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2350 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2351 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2352 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2353 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2356 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2358 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2359 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2362 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2363 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2365 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2369 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2371 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2373 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2374 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2375 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2377 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2382 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2383 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2384 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2385 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2386 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the FTP site (see section
2389 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2390 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2391 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2395 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2396 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2397 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2398 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2399 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2405 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2406 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2407 Having installed Exim, you can check that the runtime configuration file is
2408 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2409 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2413 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2414 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2415 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2416 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2417 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2420 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2422 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2424 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2426 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2427 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2428 user agent. For example:
2430 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2431 From: user@your.domain.example
2432 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2433 Subject: Testing Exim
2435 This is a test message.
2438 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2439 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2440 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2442 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2443 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2444 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2445 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2446 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2447 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2449 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2451 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2452 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2453 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2454 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2455 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2457 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2458 .cindex "lock files"
2459 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2460 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2461 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2462 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2463 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2464 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2465 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2466 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2467 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2468 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2469 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2470 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2472 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2473 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2474 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2475 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2476 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2479 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2480 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2481 within the runtime configuration, all other file and directory names
2482 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2486 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2487 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2488 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2489 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2490 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2491 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2492 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2493 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2494 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2495 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2496 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2497 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2498 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2500 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2501 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2502 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2503 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2504 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2505 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2508 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2509 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2510 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2511 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2513 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2514 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2515 favourite user agent.
2517 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2518 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2519 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2520 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2521 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2522 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2526 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2527 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2528 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2529 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2530 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2531 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2532 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2533 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2539 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2540 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2541 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2543 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2545 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2546 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2547 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2548 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2549 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2551 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2553 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2555 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2556 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2557 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2562 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2563 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2565 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2566 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2567 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2568 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2569 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2570 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2571 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2572 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2573 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2576 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2578 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2579 were present before any other options.
2580 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2582 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2583 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2584 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2587 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2588 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2589 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2593 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2594 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2595 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2598 .cindex "queue runner"
2599 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2600 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2601 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2603 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2604 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2605 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2606 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2607 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2608 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2609 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2610 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2613 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2614 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2615 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2616 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2617 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2618 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2621 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2622 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2623 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2624 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2625 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2626 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2628 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2629 .cindex "envelope sender"
2630 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2631 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2632 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2633 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2634 users to set envelope senders.
2636 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2637 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2638 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
2639 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
2640 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2641 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2642 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2644 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2645 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2646 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2647 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2648 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2649 that are available to trusted users.
2651 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2652 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2653 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2654 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2655 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2657 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2658 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2659 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2660 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2662 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2663 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2664 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2665 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2667 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2668 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2673 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2674 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2675 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2681 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2682 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2683 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2684 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2685 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2686 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2687 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2688 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2690 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2691 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2692 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2693 . creates a man page for the options.
2694 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2697 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2704 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2705 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2706 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2707 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2710 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2711 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2712 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2715 .vitem &%--version%&
2716 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2717 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2724 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2727 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2729 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2730 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2731 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2732 clean; it ignores this option.
2737 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2738 .cindex "queue runner"
2739 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2740 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2741 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2743 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2744 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2745 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2746 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2748 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2749 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2750 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2751 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2753 When a listening daemon
2754 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2755 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2756 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2757 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2758 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2759 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2762 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2763 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2764 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2768 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2769 .cindex signal "to reload configuration"
2770 .cindex daemon "reload configuration"
2771 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2772 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2773 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2774 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2775 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2776 because these are reread each time they are used.
2780 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2781 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2785 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2786 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2787 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2788 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2789 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2790 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2792 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2793 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2794 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2795 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2796 test data. A line history is supported.
2798 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2799 continuations. As in Exim's runtime configuration, white space at the start of
2800 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2801 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2802 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2803 message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2804 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2806 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2807 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2808 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2809 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2811 Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2812 defined and macros will be expanded.
2813 Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2814 available to admin users.
2816 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2818 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2819 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2820 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2821 of a file. For example:
2823 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2825 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2826 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2827 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2828 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2829 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2830 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2831 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2834 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2836 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2837 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2838 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2839 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2840 system filters are recognized.
2842 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2844 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2845 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2846 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2847 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2848 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2849 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2850 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2851 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2854 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2855 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2856 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2858 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2860 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2861 variables that are used by the user filter.
2863 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2868 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2869 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2870 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2873 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2874 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2875 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2876 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2878 When testing a filter file,
2879 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2880 .cindex "envelope sender"
2881 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2882 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2883 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2884 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2885 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2888 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2890 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2891 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2892 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2895 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2897 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2898 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2899 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2900 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2901 actually being delivered.
2903 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2905 .cindex affix "filter testing"
2906 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2907 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2910 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2912 .cindex affix "filter testing"
2913 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2914 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2917 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2919 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2920 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2921 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2922 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2923 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2924 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2925 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2926 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2927 after a full stop. For example:
2929 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2930 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2932 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2933 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2934 conversion to the canonical form is
2935 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2937 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2938 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2939 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2940 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2941 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2945 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2946 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2947 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2950 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2951 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2952 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2954 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2955 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2956 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2957 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2958 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2959 session were authenticated.
2961 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2962 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2963 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2965 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2966 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2967 specialized SMTP test program such as
2968 &url(https://www.jetmore.org/john/code/swaks/,swaks).
2970 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2972 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2973 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2974 updating the callout cache database.
2978 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2979 .cindex "building alias file"
2980 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2981 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2982 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2983 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2984 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2987 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2988 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2989 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2990 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2991 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2992 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2995 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2997 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2998 .cindex "querying exim information"
2999 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
3000 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
3001 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
3002 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
3003 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
3006 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
3007 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
3008 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3009 recognised DSCP names.
3011 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
3012 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
3013 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3014 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3015 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3016 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3017 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3018 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3019 way to guarantee a correct response.
3023 .cindex "local message reception"
3024 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3025 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3026 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3027 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3028 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3029 if no other conflicting option is present.
3031 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3032 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3033 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3034 suppressing this for special cases.
3036 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3037 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3039 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3040 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3041 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3044 .cindex "message" "format"
3045 .cindex "format" "message"
3046 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3047 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3048 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3049 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3050 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3052 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3053 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3055 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3056 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3057 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3058 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3059 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3061 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3062 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3063 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3064 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3065 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3067 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3068 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3069 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3070 .cindex "malware scan test"
3071 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3072 (depending on the used scanner interface),
3073 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3074 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3075 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3076 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3077 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3079 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3080 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3081 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3082 This option requires admin privileges.
3084 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3085 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3086 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3090 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3091 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3092 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3093 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3094 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3095 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3096 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3098 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3099 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3100 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3101 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3102 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3104 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3105 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3106 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3107 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3112 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3113 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3114 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3115 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3116 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3117 arguments, for example:
3119 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3121 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3122 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3123 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3124 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3125 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3126 users, the output is as in this example:
3128 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3130 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3131 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3133 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the runtime
3134 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3135 backward compatibility.)
3136 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3137 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3139 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3140 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3141 name will not be output.
3143 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3144 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3145 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3146 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3147 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3148 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3149 written directly into the spool directory.
3151 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3153 exim -bP +local_domains
3155 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3156 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3158 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3159 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3160 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3161 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3162 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3163 that driver are output. For example:
3165 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3167 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3168 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3169 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3170 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3171 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3174 .cindex "environment"
3175 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3176 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3179 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3180 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3181 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3182 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3183 The output format is one item per line.
3184 For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3185 the exit status will be nonzero.
3189 .cindex "queue" "listing messages in"
3190 .cindex "listing" "messages in the queue"
3191 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3192 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3193 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3194 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3195 to allow any user to see the queue.
3197 Each message in the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3199 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3200 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3203 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3204 .cindex "size" "of message"
3205 The first line contains the length of time the message has been in the queue
3206 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3207 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3208 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3209 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3210 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3211 before the sender address.
3213 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3214 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3215 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3217 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3218 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3219 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3220 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3221 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3227 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3228 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3229 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3235 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3236 This option counts the number of messages in the queue, and writes the total
3237 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3238 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3243 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3244 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3245 lots of messages in the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3246 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3250 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3254 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3259 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3260 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3261 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3262 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3267 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3268 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3269 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3270 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3271 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3273 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3274 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3276 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3277 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3278 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3279 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3280 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3281 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3282 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3283 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3284 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3286 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3287 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3292 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3293 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3294 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3295 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3296 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3297 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3298 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3302 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3303 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3304 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3305 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3306 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3307 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3308 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3309 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3310 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3312 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3313 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3314 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3316 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3317 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3318 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3319 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3321 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3322 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3323 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3325 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3326 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3327 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3328 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3329 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3331 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3332 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3336 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3337 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3338 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3339 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3340 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3341 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3342 messages to the MTA.
3345 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3346 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3347 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3348 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3349 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3350 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3351 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3355 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3356 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3357 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3358 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3359 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3360 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3361 the listening daemon.
3365 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3366 .cindex "address" "testing"
3367 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3368 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3369 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3370 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3371 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3373 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3374 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3376 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3377 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3380 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3381 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3382 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3383 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3384 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3387 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3388 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3389 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3390 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3392 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3393 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3394 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3395 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3398 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3399 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3401 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3402 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3403 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3404 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3405 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3406 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3411 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3412 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3413 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3414 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3415 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3416 name of the runtime configuration file that is in use.
3418 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3419 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3420 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3421 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3422 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3423 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3424 dynamic testing facilities.
3428 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3429 .cindex "address" "verification"
3430 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3431 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3432 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3433 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3434 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3435 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3437 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3438 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3439 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3441 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3442 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3444 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3445 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3448 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3449 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3450 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3451 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3452 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3454 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3455 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3456 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3457 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3458 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3459 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3462 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3463 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3464 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3467 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3468 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3469 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3470 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3472 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3473 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3474 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3475 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3479 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3480 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3487 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3488 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3489 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3490 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3492 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3493 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3494 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3495 each port only when the first connection is received.
3497 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3498 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3500 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3502 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3503 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3504 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3505 This option causes Exim to find the runtime configuration file from the given
3506 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3507 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single filename,
3508 but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3509 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3510 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3512 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3513 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3514 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3515 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3516 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3517 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3518 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3519 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3520 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3522 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3523 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3524 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3525 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3526 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3527 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3528 in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3530 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3531 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3532 must start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3533 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3534 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3535 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3536 unset, any filename can be used with &%-C%&.
3538 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3539 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3540 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3543 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3544 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3545 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3546 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3547 specified by this option.
3550 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3552 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3553 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3554 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3555 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3556 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3557 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3559 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3560 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3561 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3562 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3563 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3564 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3565 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3567 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3568 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3569 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3575 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3576 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3579 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3581 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3582 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3585 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3587 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3588 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3589 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3590 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3591 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3592 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3593 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3596 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3597 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3598 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3599 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3600 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3601 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3602 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3605 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3606 &`auth `& authenticators
3607 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3608 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3609 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3610 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3611 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3612 &`filter `& filter handling
3613 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3614 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3615 &`ident `& ident lookup
3616 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3617 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3618 &`load `& system load checks
3619 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3620 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3621 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3622 &`memory `& memory handling
3623 &`noutf8 `& modifier: avoid UTF-8 line-drawing
3624 &`pid `& modifier: add pid to debug output lines
3625 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3626 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3627 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3628 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3629 &`retry `& retry handling
3630 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3631 &`route `& address routing
3632 &`timestamp `& modifier: add timestamp to debug output lines
3634 &`transport `& transports
3635 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3636 &`verify `& address verification logic
3637 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3639 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3640 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3641 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3642 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3643 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3644 turn everything off.
3646 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3647 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3648 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3649 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3650 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3653 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3654 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3655 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3656 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3657 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3660 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3661 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3664 .cindex debugging "UTF-8 in"
3665 .cindex UTF-8 "in debug output"
3666 The &`noutf8`& selector disables the use of
3667 UTF-8 line-drawing characters to group related information.
3668 When disabled. ascii-art is used instead.
3669 Using the &`+all`& option does not set this modifier,
3671 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3672 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3674 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3676 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3677 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3678 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3679 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3682 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3683 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3684 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3685 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3689 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3690 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3691 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3692 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3693 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3694 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3695 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3696 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3699 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3700 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3701 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3702 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3703 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3705 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3707 .cindex "sender" "name"
3708 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3709 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3710 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3711 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3712 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3713 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3715 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3717 .cindex "sender" "address"
3718 .cindex "address" "sender"
3719 .cindex "trusted users"
3720 .cindex "envelope sender"
3721 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3722 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3723 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3724 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3727 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3728 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3729 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3730 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3733 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3734 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3735 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3736 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3737 examples of shell commands:
3739 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3740 exim -f "" user@domain
3742 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3743 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3746 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3747 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3748 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3749 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3752 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3753 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3754 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3755 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3756 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3757 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3761 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3762 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3764 control = suppress_local_fixups
3766 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3767 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3770 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3773 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3775 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3776 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3777 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3782 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3783 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3784 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3785 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3786 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3787 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3789 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3791 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3792 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3793 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3794 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3795 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3796 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3798 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3800 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3802 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3803 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3804 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3805 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3806 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3807 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3808 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3811 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3812 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3813 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3814 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3815 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3816 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3818 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3819 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3820 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3821 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3823 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3825 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3826 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3827 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3828 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3829 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3830 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3831 can be used only by an admin user.
3833 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3834 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3836 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3837 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3838 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3839 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3840 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3841 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3842 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3843 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3847 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3848 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3849 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3853 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3854 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3855 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3857 .vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3859 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3860 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3861 alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3865 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3866 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that a
3867 remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3871 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3872 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3873 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3875 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3877 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3878 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3879 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3880 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3881 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3882 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3886 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3887 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3888 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3893 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3894 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3895 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3897 .vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3899 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3900 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3901 connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3902 The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3904 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3906 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3907 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3908 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message, in turn,
3909 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3910 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3911 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3912 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3913 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3914 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3915 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3916 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3917 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3918 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3920 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3922 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3923 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3924 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3925 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3926 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3927 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3928 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3929 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3931 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3933 .cindex "freezing messages"
3934 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3935 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3936 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3937 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3938 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3939 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3942 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3944 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3945 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3946 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3947 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3948 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3949 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3950 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3951 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3954 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3956 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3957 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3958 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3959 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3960 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3962 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3964 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3965 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3966 .cindex "removing recipients"
3967 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3968 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3969 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3970 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3971 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3972 can be used only by an admin user.
3974 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3976 .cindex "removing messages"
3977 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3978 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3979 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3980 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3981 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3982 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3983 placed in the queue.
3988 . .cindex REQUIRETLS
3989 . This option is used to request REQUIRETLS processing on the message.
3990 . It is used internally by Exim in conjunction with -E when generating
3994 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3996 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3997 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3998 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3999 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
4000 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
4001 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
4002 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
4003 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
4004 user. See also &%-bem%&.
4006 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4008 .cindex "thawing messages"
4009 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
4010 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
4011 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
4012 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
4013 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
4014 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
4017 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4019 .cindex "listing" "message body"
4020 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
4021 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
4022 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4024 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4026 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
4027 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
4028 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
4029 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
4030 only by an admin user.
4032 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4034 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
4035 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
4036 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4037 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4038 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4040 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4042 .cindex "listing" "message log"
4043 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
4044 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4045 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4049 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4050 treats it that way too.
4054 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4055 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4056 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4057 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4058 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4059 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4060 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4063 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4064 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4065 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4066 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4067 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4068 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4069 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4074 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4075 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4076 When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4077 option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4079 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4081 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4084 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4086 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4087 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4088 alternative alias filename. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4091 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4093 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4094 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4095 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4096 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4097 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4098 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4102 .cindex "background delivery"
4103 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4104 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4105 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4106 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4107 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4108 processes to finish.
4110 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4111 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4112 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4113 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4115 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4116 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4117 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4118 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4122 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4123 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4124 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4125 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4126 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4127 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4129 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4130 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4133 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4134 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4136 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4137 message is left in the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4138 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4139 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4144 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4149 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4150 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4151 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4152 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4153 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4154 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4155 are placed in the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4156 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4157 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4158 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4163 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4164 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4165 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4166 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4167 configuration file is in effect.
4169 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4170 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4171 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4172 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4173 done at this time, so the message remains in the queue until a subsequent queue
4174 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4175 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4176 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4177 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4182 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4183 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4184 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4187 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4189 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4190 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4191 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4192 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4196 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4197 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4198 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4199 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4200 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4204 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4205 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4206 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4207 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4208 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4212 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4213 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4218 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4219 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4224 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4225 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4226 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4227 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4228 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4229 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4232 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4233 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4235 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4237 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4238 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4239 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4240 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4241 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4242 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4244 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4245 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4247 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4249 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4250 followed by a colon and the port number:
4252 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4254 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4255 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4256 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4257 whichever one is last.
4259 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4261 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4262 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4263 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4264 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4265 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4266 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4268 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4270 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4271 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4272 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4273 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4274 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4275 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4277 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4279 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4280 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4281 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4282 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4283 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4284 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4285 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4286 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4288 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4290 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4291 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4292 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4293 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4294 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4296 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4298 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4299 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4300 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4301 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4302 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4303 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4304 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4306 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4307 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4308 is sending the bounce.
4310 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4312 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4313 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4314 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4315 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4316 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4317 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4318 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4319 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4320 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4321 be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4323 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4325 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4326 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4327 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4328 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4329 uses the name it is given.
4331 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4333 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4334 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4335 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4336 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4337 used, when there is no default.
4341 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4342 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4343 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4344 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4348 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4349 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4350 whatever that means.
4352 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4354 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4355 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4356 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4357 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4358 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4359 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4360 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4362 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4364 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4365 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4366 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4367 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4368 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4370 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4372 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4373 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4374 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4375 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4376 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4377 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4381 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4383 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4385 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4386 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4387 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4388 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4389 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4390 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4391 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4392 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid filename.
4396 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4397 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4398 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4399 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4404 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4405 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4406 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4407 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4410 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4412 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4414 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4416 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4417 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4418 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4419 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4420 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4421 Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4425 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4426 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4427 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4428 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4429 and &%-S%& options).
4431 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4432 If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4433 the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4434 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4435 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4436 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4437 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4440 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4441 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4442 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4443 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4444 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4447 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4448 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4449 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4450 this to be repeated periodically.
4452 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4453 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4454 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4455 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4457 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4458 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4459 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4461 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4462 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4463 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4464 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4468 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4469 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4470 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4471 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4472 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4473 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4476 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4477 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4478 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4479 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4480 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4481 delivered down a single SMTP
4482 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4483 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4484 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4485 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4486 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4489 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4491 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4492 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4493 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4494 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages in the queue using
4495 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4497 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4499 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4500 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4501 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4502 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4503 their retry times are tried.
4505 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4507 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4508 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4511 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4513 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4514 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4515 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains in the queue
4518 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4521 .cindex "named queues"
4522 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4523 If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4524 queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4525 The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4526 For a periodic queue run (see below)
4527 append to the name a slash and a time value.
4529 If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4530 will specify a queue to operate on.
4533 exim -bp -qGquarantine
4535 exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4538 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4539 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4540 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4541 starting message id. For example:
4543 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4545 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4546 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4547 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4549 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4551 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4552 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4553 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4554 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4555 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4556 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4558 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4559 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4560 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4561 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4562 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4563 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4564 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4565 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4566 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4568 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4570 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4571 process every 30 minutes.
4573 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4574 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4576 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4578 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4581 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4583 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4585 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4587 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4588 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4589 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4590 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4591 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4592 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4593 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4595 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4596 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4597 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4598 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4599 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4600 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4602 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4603 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4605 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4607 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4608 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4609 applied to each queue run.
4611 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4612 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4613 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4614 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4615 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4616 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4617 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4618 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4619 address will be skipped.
4621 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4622 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4623 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4626 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4627 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4628 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4629 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4630 an arbitrary command instead.
4634 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4636 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4638 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4639 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4640 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4641 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4642 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4643 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4645 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4647 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4648 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4649 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4653 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4654 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4655 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4656 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4657 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4658 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4659 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4660 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4661 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4663 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4664 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4665 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4666 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4667 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4668 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4669 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4670 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4671 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4672 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4673 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4675 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4676 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4677 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4678 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4679 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4680 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4682 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4683 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4684 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4685 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4686 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4687 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4688 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4689 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4690 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4694 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4695 compatibility with Sendmail.
4697 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4698 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4699 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4700 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4701 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4702 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4703 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4704 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4709 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4710 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4711 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4712 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4713 set. Exim ignores this option.
4717 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4718 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4719 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4720 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4721 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4722 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4727 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4728 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4729 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4732 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4734 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4735 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4737 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4739 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4740 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4741 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4749 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4750 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4751 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4752 . creates a man page for the options.
4753 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4756 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4763 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4764 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4767 .chapter "The Exim runtime configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4768 "The runtime configuration file"
4770 .cindex "runtime configuration"
4771 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4772 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4773 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4774 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4775 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4776 Exim uses a single runtime configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4777 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4778 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4781 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4782 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4783 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4784 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4785 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4786 actually alter the string.
4788 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4789 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4790 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4791 give a colon-separated list of filenames, in which case Exim uses the first
4792 existing file in the list.
4795 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4796 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4797 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4798 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4799 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4800 The runtime configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4801 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4802 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4803 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4804 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4806 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4807 to root, anybody who is able to edit the runtime configuration file has an
4808 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4809 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4810 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4812 Up to Exim version 4.72, the runtime configuration file was also permitted to
4813 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4814 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4815 compromise the Exim user account.
4817 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4818 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4819 defines just one filename, the installation process copies the default
4820 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4821 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4822 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4827 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4828 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4829 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4830 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4831 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4832 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4833 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4834 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4835 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4836 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4837 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4839 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4840 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4841 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4842 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4843 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4844 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4845 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4846 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4847 message in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4850 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4851 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4852 start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4853 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any
4854 filename can be used with &%-C%&.
4856 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4857 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4858 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4859 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4860 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4861 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4863 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4864 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4865 necessarily be discarded.
4866 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4867 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4868 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4869 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4870 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4871 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4873 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4874 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4875 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4876 looks for a file whose name is the configuration filename followed by a dot
4877 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4878 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4879 each filename in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4881 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4882 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4883 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4887 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4888 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4889 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4890 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4891 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4892 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4893 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4894 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4897 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4900 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4901 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4902 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4904 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4905 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4906 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4908 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4909 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4910 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4912 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4913 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4914 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4915 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4918 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4919 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4920 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4922 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4923 want to use this feature, you must set
4925 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4927 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4928 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4931 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4932 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4933 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4934 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4936 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4937 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4938 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4939 and does not introduce a comment.
4941 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4942 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4943 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4944 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4945 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4947 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4948 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4949 change settings as required.
4951 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4952 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4953 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4954 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4955 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4960 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4961 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4962 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4963 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4964 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4965 You can include other files inside Exim's runtime configuration file by
4968 &`.include`& <&'filename'&>
4969 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'filename'&>
4971 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the filename are optional. If you use
4972 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4973 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
4974 The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
4975 the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute filename
4978 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4979 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4980 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4981 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4983 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4984 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4987 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4990 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4991 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4996 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4997 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4998 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4999 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
5000 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
5001 definition, and must be of the form
5003 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
5005 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
5006 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
5007 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
5008 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
5009 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
5011 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
5012 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
5013 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
5015 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
5016 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
5017 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
5018 scanned for each, in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
5019 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
5020 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
5021 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
5024 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
5025 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
5027 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
5028 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
5029 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
5030 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
5031 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
5032 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5035 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5036 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5037 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5042 MAC == updated value
5044 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5045 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5046 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5047 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5051 MAC == MAC and something added
5053 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5054 from a number of other files.
5056 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5057 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5058 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5059 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5060 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5065 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5066 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5067 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5068 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5070 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5071 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5073 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5075 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5077 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5078 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5079 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5082 .section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5083 Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5084 differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5085 All of these macros start with an underscore.
5086 They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5089 The following classes of macros are defined:
5091 &` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5092 &` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5093 &` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5094 &` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5095 &` _LOG_* `& log_selector values
5096 &` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5097 &` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5098 &` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5099 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5100 &` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5101 &` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5102 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5105 Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5108 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5109 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5110 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5111 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5112 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5113 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5114 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5116 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5117 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5118 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5122 message_size_limit = 50M
5124 message_size_limit = 100M
5127 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5128 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5129 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5130 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5131 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5133 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5134 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5135 in this line"& will always be true.
5137 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5138 to clarify complicated nestings.
5142 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5143 .cindex "common option syntax"
5144 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5145 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5146 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5147 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5148 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5149 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5150 space) and then the value. For example:
5152 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5154 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5155 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5156 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5157 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5158 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5159 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5160 word &"hide"&. For example:
5162 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5164 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5166 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5168 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5169 all instances of the same driver.
5171 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5172 that are found in option settings.
5175 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5176 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5177 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5178 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5179 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5180 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5181 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5182 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5183 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5184 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5185 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5186 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5191 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5196 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5201 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5202 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5203 .cindex "format" "integer"
5204 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5205 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5206 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5207 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5210 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5211 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5212 if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5214 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5215 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5216 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5220 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5221 .cindex "integer format"
5222 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5223 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5224 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5225 Such options are always output in octal.
5228 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5229 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5230 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5231 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5232 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5236 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5237 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5238 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5239 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5240 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5250 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5251 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5252 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5256 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5257 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5258 .cindex "format" "string"
5259 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5260 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5261 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5262 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5263 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5264 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5265 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5266 therefore equivalent:
5268 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5269 trusted_users = uucp:\
5270 # This comment line is ignored
5273 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5274 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5275 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5276 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5277 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5280 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5281 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5282 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5284 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5285 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5289 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5290 character, that character replaces the pair.
5292 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5293 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5294 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5295 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5296 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5297 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5300 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5301 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5302 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5303 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5304 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5305 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5306 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5307 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5308 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5309 within a quoted configuration string.
5312 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5313 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5314 .cindex "format" "user name"
5315 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5316 .cindex "format" "group name"
5317 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5318 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5319 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5320 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5323 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5324 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5325 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5326 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5327 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5328 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5329 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5330 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5331 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5332 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5333 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5335 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5336 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5337 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5338 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5339 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5340 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5343 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5345 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5347 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5348 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5349 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5350 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5352 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5353 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5354 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5355 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5356 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5357 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5358 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5359 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5361 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5363 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5364 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5365 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5367 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5368 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5369 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5370 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5371 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5372 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5373 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5374 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5375 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5377 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5379 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5380 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5381 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5382 the value in quotes. For example:
5384 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5386 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5387 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5388 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5389 enclosing an empty list item.
5393 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5394 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5395 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5396 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5398 senders = user@domain :
5400 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5401 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5402 items, the second of which is empty:
5404 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5406 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5407 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5408 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5409 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5413 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5414 is at the end of the list.
5419 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5420 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5421 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5422 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5423 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5424 a sequence of lines like this:
5426 <&'instance name'&>:
5431 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5432 followed by three options settings:
5437 transport = local_delivery
5439 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5440 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5441 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5442 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5443 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5444 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5446 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5447 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5449 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5450 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5451 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5452 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5453 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5456 .cindex "generic options"
5457 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5458 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5459 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5460 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5461 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5462 .cindex "private options"
5463 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5464 they all have default values.
5466 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5467 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5468 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5470 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5471 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5472 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5473 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5474 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5475 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5476 configuration lines:
5481 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5482 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5483 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5484 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5490 command_timeout = 10s
5492 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5493 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5496 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5497 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5498 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5506 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5507 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5509 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5510 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5511 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5512 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5513 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5514 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5515 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5516 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5517 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5518 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5519 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5523 .section "Macros" "SECTdefconfmacros"
5524 All macros should be defined before any options.
5526 One macro is specified, but commented out, in the default configuration:
5528 # ROUTER_SMARTHOST=MAIL.HOSTNAME.FOR.CENTRAL.SERVER.EXAMPLE
5530 If all off-site mail is expected to be delivered to a "smarthost", then set the
5531 hostname here and uncomment the macro. This will affect which router is used
5532 later on. If this is left commented out, then Exim will perform direct-to-MX
5533 deliveries using a &(dnslookup)& router.
5535 In addition to macros defined here, Exim includes a number of built-in macros
5536 to enable configuration to be guarded by a binary built with support for a
5537 given feature. See section &<<SECTbuiltinmacros>>& for more details.
5540 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5541 The main (global) configuration option settings section must always come first
5542 in the file, after the macros.
5543 The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is the line
5545 # primary_hostname =
5547 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5548 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5549 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5550 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5552 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5554 domainlist local_domains = @
5555 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5556 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5558 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5559 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5560 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5561 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5563 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5564 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5567 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5568 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5569 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5570 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5571 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5572 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5574 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5575 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5576 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5577 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5578 domain is permitted.
5580 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5581 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5582 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5583 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5584 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5585 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5587 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5588 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5589 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5591 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5593 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5594 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5596 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5597 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5598 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5599 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5600 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5601 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5602 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5603 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5604 contents of a message to be checked.
5606 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5608 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5609 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5611 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5612 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5613 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5614 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5616 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5618 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5619 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5620 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5622 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5623 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5624 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5625 connecting to this server; in this case, the wildcard means all clients. The
5626 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5627 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5628 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5630 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5632 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5633 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5635 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5636 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5637 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5638 .cindex "submissions protocol"
5639 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5640 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5641 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5642 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5643 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5644 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5645 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5646 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5647 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5648 Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5649 to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5650 much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5652 RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5653 which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5654 RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5655 which should be used in preference to 587.
5656 You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5658 Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5660 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5663 # qualify_recipient =
5665 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5666 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5667 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5668 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5669 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5670 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5672 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5673 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5674 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5675 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5677 # allow_domain_literals
5679 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5680 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5681 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5682 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5683 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5684 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5686 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5690 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5691 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5692 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5693 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5694 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5695 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5696 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5697 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5699 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5700 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5705 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5706 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5707 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5708 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5709 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5710 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5713 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5714 1413 (hence their names):
5717 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5719 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5720 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5721 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5722 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5723 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5724 information, you can change this.
5726 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5727 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5732 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5733 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5734 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5735 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5737 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5738 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5740 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5741 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5743 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5746 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5747 +tls_certificate_verified
5750 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5752 # percent_hack_domains =
5754 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5755 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5756 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5758 The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5759 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5760 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5761 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5762 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5763 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5764 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5765 always bounce messages.
5767 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5768 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5770 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5771 discarded after 2 days in the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5772 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5773 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5774 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5776 Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5777 large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5778 directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5779 many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5780 Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5783 # split_spool_directory = true
5786 In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5787 messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5788 characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5789 violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5790 In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5791 problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5792 check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5794 # check_rfc2047_length = false
5797 If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
5798 8BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5799 that are not 8-bit clean.
5801 # accept_8bitmime = false
5804 Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5805 imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5806 &%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5807 &%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5808 Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5809 option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5811 # keep_environment = ^LDAP
5812 # add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5816 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5817 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5818 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5819 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5820 It starts with the line
5824 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5825 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5826 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5828 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5829 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5830 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5831 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5832 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5833 result of the ACL processing.
5837 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5842 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5843 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5844 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5845 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5846 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5847 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5849 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5850 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5851 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5854 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5855 domains = +local_domains
5856 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5858 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5859 domains = !+local_domains
5860 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5862 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5863 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5864 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5865 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5866 in Internet mail addresses.
5868 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5869 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5870 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5871 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5872 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5873 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5874 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5875 policy of being as safe as possible.
5877 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5878 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5879 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5880 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5881 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5882 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5884 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5885 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5886 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5887 have to modify this rule.
5889 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5890 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5891 common convention of local parts constructed as
5892 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5893 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5894 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5895 filename (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5896 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5897 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5899 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5900 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5901 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5902 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5903 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5904 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5905 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5907 accept local_parts = postmaster
5908 domains = +local_domains
5910 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5911 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5912 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5913 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5914 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5916 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5917 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5918 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5920 require verify = sender
5922 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5923 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5924 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5925 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5926 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5927 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5928 discusses the details of address verification.
5930 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5931 control = submission
5933 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5934 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5935 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5936 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5937 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5938 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5939 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5940 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5941 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5943 accept authenticated = *
5944 control = submission
5946 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5947 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5948 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5949 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5950 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5951 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5953 require message = relay not permitted
5954 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5956 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5957 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5959 require verify = recipient
5961 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5962 fails, the address is rejected.
5964 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5965 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5967 # dnslists = black.list.example
5969 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5970 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5971 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5972 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5974 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5975 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5976 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5979 # require verify = csa
5981 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5982 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5987 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5988 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5992 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5993 of this ACL are commented out:
5996 # message = This message contains a virus \
5999 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
6000 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
6001 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
6002 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
6004 # warn spam = nobody
6005 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
6006 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
6007 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
6008 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
6010 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
6011 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
6012 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
6013 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
6014 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
6015 whatever the spam score.
6019 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
6022 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
6023 .cindex "default" "routers"
6024 .cindex "routers" "default"
6025 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
6030 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
6031 messages. An address is passed to each router, in turn, until it is either
6032 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
6033 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
6034 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
6037 # driver = ipliteral
6038 # domains = !+local_domains
6039 # transport = remote_smtp
6041 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
6042 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
6043 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
6044 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
6045 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
6047 Which router is used next depends upon whether or not the ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6048 macro has been defined, per
6050 .ifdef ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6059 If ROUTER_SMARTHOST has been defined, either at the top of the file or on the
6060 command-line, then we route all non-local mail to that smarthost; otherwise, we'll
6061 perform DNS lookups for direct-to-MX lookup. Any mail which is to a local domain will
6062 skip these routers because of the &%domains%& option.
6066 driver = manualroute
6067 domains = ! +local_domains
6068 transport = smarthost_smtp
6069 route_data = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6070 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0.0.0.0 ; 127.0.0.0/8 ; ::1
6073 This router only handles mail which is not to any local domains; this is
6074 specified by the line
6076 domains = ! +local_domains
6078 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6079 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6080 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6081 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6082 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6083 passed on to the following routers.
6085 The name of the router driver is &(manualroute)& because we are manually
6086 specifying how mail should be routed onwards, instead of using DNS MX.
6087 While the name of this router instance is arbitrary, the &%driver%& option must
6088 be one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6090 With no pre-conditions other than &%domains%&, all mail for non-local domains
6091 will be handled by this router, and the &%no_more%& setting will ensure that no
6092 other routers will be used for messages matching the pre-conditions. See
6093 &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for more on how the pre-conditions apply. For messages which
6094 are handled by this router, we provide a hostname to deliver to in &%route_data%&
6095 and the macro supplies the value; the address is then queued for the
6096 &(smarthost_smtp)& transport.
6101 domains = ! +local_domains
6102 transport = remote_smtp
6103 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6106 The &%domains%& option behaves as per smarthost, above.
6108 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6109 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6110 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6111 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6112 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6114 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6115 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6116 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6117 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6118 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6119 the address fails and is bounced.
6121 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6122 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6123 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6124 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6125 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6126 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6127 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6134 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6136 file_transport = address_file
6137 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6139 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6140 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6141 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6142 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6143 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6146 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6147 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6148 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6149 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6154 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6155 # local_part_suffix_optional
6156 file = $home/.forward
6161 file_transport = address_file
6162 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6163 reply_transport = address_reply
6165 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6166 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6167 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6168 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6169 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6172 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6173 # local_part_suffix_optional
6175 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6176 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6177 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6178 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6179 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6180 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6181 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6183 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6184 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6185 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6186 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6188 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6189 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6190 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6191 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6192 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6193 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6194 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6196 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6197 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6198 There are two reasons for doing this:
6201 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6202 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6205 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6206 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6207 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6208 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6212 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6213 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6214 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6215 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6217 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6218 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6219 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6221 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6223 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6229 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6230 # local_part_suffix_optional
6231 transport = local_delivery
6233 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6234 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6235 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6236 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6237 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6240 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6241 .cindex "default" "transports"
6242 .cindex "transports" "default"
6243 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6244 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6245 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6249 Two remote transports and four local transports are defined.
6253 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6255 dnssec_request_domains = *
6262 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6263 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6264 The &%message_size_limit%& usage is a hack to avoid sending on messages
6265 with over-long lines. The built-in macro _HAVE_DANE guards configuration
6266 to try to use DNSSEC for all queries and to use DANE for delivery;
6267 see section &<<SECDANE>>& for more details.
6269 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is
6270 negotiated between client and server and not expected to cause problems
6271 but can be disabled if needed. The built-in macro _HAVE_PRDR guards the
6272 use of the &%hosts_try_prdr%& configuration option.
6274 The other remote transport is used when delivering to a specific smarthost
6275 with whom there must be some kind of existing relationship, instead of the
6276 usual federated system.
6281 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6285 # Comment out any of these which you have to, then file a Support
6286 # request with your smarthost provider to get things fixed:
6287 hosts_require_tls = *
6288 tls_verify_hosts = *
6289 # As long as tls_verify_hosts is enabled, this won't matter, but if you
6290 # have to comment it out then this will at least log whether you succeed
6292 tls_try_verify_hosts = *
6294 # The SNI name should match the name which we'll expect to verify;
6295 # many mail systems don't use SNI and this doesn't matter, but if it does,
6296 # we need to send a name which the remote site will recognize.
6297 # This _should_ be the name which the smarthost operators specified as
6298 # the hostname for sending your mail to.
6299 tls_sni = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6301 .ifdef _HAVE_OPENSSL
6302 tls_require_ciphers = HIGH:!aNULL:@STRENGTH
6305 tls_require_ciphers = SECURE192:-VERS-SSL3.0:-VERS-TLS1.0:-VERS-TLS1.1
6312 After the same &%message_size_limit%& hack, we then specify that this Transport
6313 can handle messages to multiple domains in one run. The assumption here is
6314 that you're routing all non-local mail to the same place and that place is
6315 happy to take all messages from you as quickly as possible.
6316 All other options depend upon built-in macros; if Exim was built without TLS support
6317 then no other options are defined.
6318 If TLS is available, then we configure "stronger than default" TLS ciphersuites
6319 and versions using the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option, where the value to be
6320 used depends upon the library providing TLS.
6321 Beyond that, the options adopt the stance that you should have TLS support available
6322 from your smarthost on today's Internet, so we turn on requiring TLS for the
6323 mail to be delivered, and requiring that the certificate be valid, and match
6324 the expected hostname. The &%tls_sni%& option can be used by service providers
6325 to select an appropriate certificate to present to you and here we re-use the
6326 ROUTER_SMARTHOST macro, because that is unaffected by CNAMEs present in DNS.
6327 You want to specify the hostname which you'll expect to validate for, and that
6328 should not be subject to insecure tampering via DNS results.
6330 For the &%hosts_try_prdr%& option see the previous transport.
6332 All other options are defaulted.
6336 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6343 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6344 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6345 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6346 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6347 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6348 show how this can be done.
6350 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6351 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6352 similarly-named options above.
6358 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6359 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6360 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6361 be returned to the sender.
6369 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6370 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6371 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6376 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6381 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6382 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6383 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6384 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6385 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6386 introduced by the line
6390 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6393 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6395 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6396 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6397 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6398 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6399 measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6401 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6402 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6403 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6406 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6407 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6411 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6412 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6416 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6417 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6418 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6420 begin authenticators
6422 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6423 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6424 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6425 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6426 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6427 to support most MUA software.
6429 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6432 # driver = plaintext
6433 # server_set_id = $auth2
6434 # server_prompts = :
6435 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6436 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6438 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6441 # driver = plaintext
6442 # server_set_id = $auth1
6443 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6444 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6445 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6448 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6449 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6450 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6451 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6452 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6453 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6454 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6455 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6457 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6458 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6459 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6460 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6462 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6463 usercode and password are in different positions.
6464 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6466 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6470 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6471 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6473 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6475 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6477 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6478 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6479 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6480 regular expressions is discussed in
6481 online Perl manpages, in
6482 many Perl reference books, and also in
6483 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6484 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6485 . --- the http: URL here redirects to another page with the ISBN in the URL
6486 . --- where trying to use https: just redirects back to http:, so sticking
6487 . --- to the old URL for now. 2018-09-07.
6489 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6490 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6491 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6492 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6493 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6496 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6497 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6498 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6499 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6501 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6503 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6504 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6505 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6506 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6507 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6508 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6511 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6512 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6513 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6514 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6515 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6516 match anywhere in the subject string.
6518 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6519 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6521 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6523 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6526 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6528 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6529 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6533 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6534 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6536 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6537 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6538 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6539 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6540 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6541 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6544 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6545 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6546 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6547 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6548 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6549 The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6551 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6552 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6553 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6554 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6555 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6556 The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6559 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6560 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6561 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6562 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6563 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6564 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6566 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6567 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6568 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6569 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6570 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6572 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6573 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6575 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6576 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6577 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6578 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6579 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6581 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6582 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6584 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6585 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6587 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6588 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6589 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6594 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6595 matches the list item.
6597 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6598 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6600 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6602 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6603 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6604 causes a second lookup to occur.
6606 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6607 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6608 lookup is permitted.
6611 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6612 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6613 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6614 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6617 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6618 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6619 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6621 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6622 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6623 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6624 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6627 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6628 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6629 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6634 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6635 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6636 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6641 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6642 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6643 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6644 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6647 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6648 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6649 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6650 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6651 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6652 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6653 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6654 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb and
6655 tools for building the files can be found in several places:
6657 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html)
6658 &url(http://www.corpit.ru/mjt/tinycdb.html)
6659 &url(https://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb)
6660 &url(https://github.com/philpennock/cdbtools) (in Go)
6662 . --- 2018-09-07: corpit.ru http:-only
6663 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6664 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6665 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6666 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6668 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6669 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6670 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6671 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6672 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6673 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6674 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6676 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6677 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6678 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6679 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6680 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6681 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6682 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6684 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6685 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6687 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6688 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6689 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6690 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6691 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6692 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6693 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6695 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6696 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6697 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6699 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6700 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6701 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6702 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6703 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6704 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6705 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6706 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6707 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6708 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6710 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6711 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6712 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6713 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6714 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6715 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6716 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6717 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6718 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6720 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6721 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6722 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6723 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6724 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6725 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6726 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6728 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6729 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6730 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6731 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6733 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6734 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6735 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6736 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6737 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6739 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6740 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6741 lookup types support only literal keys.
6743 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6744 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6745 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6748 &*Warning 3*&: Do not use an IPv4-mapped IPv6 address for a key; use the
6749 IPv4, in dotted-quad form. (Exim converts IPv4-mapped IPv6 addresses to this
6750 notation before executing the lookup.)
6755 .cindex json "lookup type"
6756 .cindex JSON expansions
6757 &(json)&: The given file is a text file with a JSON structure.
6758 An element of the structure is extracted, defined by the search key.
6759 The key is a list of subelement selectors
6760 (colon-separated by default but changeable in the usual way)
6761 which are applied in turn to select smaller and smaller portions
6762 of the JSON structure.
6763 If a selector is numeric, it must apply to a JSON array; the (zero-based)
6764 nunbered array element is selected.
6765 Otherwise it must apply to a JSON object; the named element is selected.
6766 The final resulting element can be a simple JSON type or a JSON object
6767 or array; for the latter two a string-representation os the JSON
6769 For elements of type string, the returned value is de-quoted.
6772 .cindex "linear search"
6773 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6774 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6775 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6776 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6777 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6778 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6779 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6780 in the file is used.
6782 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6783 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6784 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6785 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6786 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6791 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6792 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6793 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6794 wildcarding of any kind.
6796 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6797 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6798 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6799 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6800 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6801 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6802 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6803 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6804 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6807 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6808 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6809 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6810 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6811 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6812 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6813 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6814 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6817 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6818 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6819 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6820 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6821 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6822 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6823 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6824 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6825 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6827 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6828 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6829 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6830 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6832 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6833 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6836 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6838 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6839 *fish data for anythingfish
6842 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6843 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6845 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6847 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6848 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6849 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6851 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6853 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6854 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6855 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6857 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6860 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6861 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6862 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6863 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6864 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6866 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6867 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6868 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6869 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6870 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6873 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6874 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6875 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6878 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6880 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6883 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6884 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6885 be followed by optional colons.
6887 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6888 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6889 lookup types support only literal keys.
6892 .cindex "lookup" "spf"
6893 If Exim is built with SPF support, manual lookups can be done
6894 (as opposed to the standard ACL condition method.
6895 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
6899 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
6900 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6901 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6902 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6903 many of them are given in later sections.
6906 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6907 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6908 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6909 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6910 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6912 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6913 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6914 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6916 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6917 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6918 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6919 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6920 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6921 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6922 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6924 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6925 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6926 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6927 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6929 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6930 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6931 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6932 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6934 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6935 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6936 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6937 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6939 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6940 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6941 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6942 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6943 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6944 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6945 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6946 password value. For example:
6948 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6951 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6952 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6953 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6954 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6957 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
6958 .cindex lookup Redis
6959 &(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
6960 passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6963 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6964 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6965 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a filename followed by an SQL statement
6966 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6969 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6970 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6972 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6973 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6974 . --- still http:-only, 2018-09-07
6975 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6976 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6977 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6978 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6979 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6980 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6981 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6983 require condition = \
6984 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6986 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6987 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6988 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6989 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6994 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6995 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6996 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6997 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6998 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6999 options such as a list of local domains.
7001 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
7002 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
7003 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
7004 or may give up altogether.
7008 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
7009 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7010 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
7011 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7012 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
7013 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
7014 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
7015 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
7017 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
7018 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
7019 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
7021 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
7022 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
7023 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
7025 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
7026 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
7027 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
7028 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
7029 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
7030 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
7031 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
7032 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
7033 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
7034 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
7036 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
7038 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
7039 looks up these keys, in this order:
7045 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
7046 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
7047 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
7048 Exim move on to try the next key.
7052 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
7053 .cindex "partial matching"
7054 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7055 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
7056 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7057 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
7058 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
7059 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
7060 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
7061 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
7062 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
7063 a key in a DBM file is
7065 *.dates.fict.example
7067 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
7068 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
7069 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
7072 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
7073 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
7074 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
7076 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
7077 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
7078 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
7079 partial matching keys
7080 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
7081 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
7082 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
7084 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
7085 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
7086 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
7087 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
7088 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
7089 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
7092 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
7093 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
7094 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
7095 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
7096 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
7097 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
7099 2250.dates.fict.example
7100 *.2250.dates.fict.example
7101 *.dates.fict.example
7104 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
7107 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
7108 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
7109 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
7110 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
7111 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
7112 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
7114 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
7116 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7117 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
7118 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
7119 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
7121 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
7123 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7124 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
7126 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
7127 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
7128 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
7131 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
7133 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
7134 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
7136 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
7137 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
7138 for &"*"& on its own.
7140 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
7144 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
7145 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
7146 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
7147 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
7148 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
7149 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
7150 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
7152 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
7153 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
7154 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
7155 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
7156 subject key is always followed by a dot.
7161 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
7162 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
7163 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
7164 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
7165 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
7166 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
7167 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
7169 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
7170 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
7171 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
7172 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
7173 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
7174 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
7176 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
7177 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
7183 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
7184 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
7185 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
7186 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
7187 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
7188 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
7192 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
7193 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
7195 [name="$local_part"]
7197 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
7198 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
7199 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
7200 of the following form is provided:
7202 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7204 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
7206 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7208 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7209 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7210 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7215 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7216 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7217 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7218 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7219 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7220 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7221 an expansion string could contain:
7223 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7225 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7226 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7227 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7228 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7230 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7231 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7232 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7234 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7235 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7236 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7237 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7238 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7240 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7242 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7243 white space is ignored.
7244 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7245 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7246 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7248 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7249 When the type is PTR,
7250 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7251 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7253 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7255 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7256 altered and nothing is added.
7258 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7259 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7260 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7261 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7262 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7263 The field separator can be modified as above.
7265 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7266 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7267 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7268 unless a field separator is specified.
7269 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7271 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7273 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7274 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7275 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7277 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7278 white space is ignored.
7280 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7281 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7282 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7283 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7286 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7289 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7290 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7291 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7292 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7293 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7294 each followed by a comma,
7295 that may appear before the record type.
7297 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7298 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7299 a defer-option modifier.
7300 The possible keywords are
7301 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7302 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7303 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7304 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7305 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7306 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7307 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7309 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7310 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7312 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7313 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7315 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7316 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7317 The possible keywords are
7318 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7319 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7321 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7322 is not labelled as authenticated data
7323 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7324 The default is &"never"&.
7326 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7328 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7329 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7330 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7331 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7333 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7335 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7336 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7337 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7339 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7340 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7342 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7343 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7344 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7347 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7348 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7349 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7350 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7351 the pseudo-type MXH:
7353 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7355 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7358 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7359 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7360 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7361 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7362 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7363 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7364 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7365 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7367 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7368 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7370 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7371 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7372 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7374 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7375 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7376 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7377 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7378 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7381 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7382 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7383 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7384 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7385 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7386 result of a successful lookup such as:
7388 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7390 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7391 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7392 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7394 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7395 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7396 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7397 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7399 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7403 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7404 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7405 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7406 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7407 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7409 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7410 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7411 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7413 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7414 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7415 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7416 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7418 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7419 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7420 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7425 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7426 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7427 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7428 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7429 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7430 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7431 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7432 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7433 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7434 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7435 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7436 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7438 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7439 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7440 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7441 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7442 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7444 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7445 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7447 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7448 the way they handle the results of a query:
7451 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7454 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7455 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7457 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7458 from all of them are returned.
7462 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7463 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7464 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7465 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7468 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7469 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7470 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7471 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7473 data = ${lookup ldap \
7474 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7475 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7477 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7478 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7479 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7480 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7482 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7483 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7484 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7486 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7487 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7488 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7489 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7490 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7491 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7492 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7493 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7497 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7498 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7499 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7500 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7501 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7502 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7504 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7505 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7513 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7514 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7518 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7520 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7524 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7526 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7528 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7530 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7531 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7532 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7536 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7537 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7538 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7540 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7544 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7546 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7548 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7550 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7551 authentication below.
7554 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7555 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7556 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7557 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7558 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7561 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7563 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7564 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7565 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7566 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7567 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7568 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7569 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7570 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7571 failures, and timeouts.
7573 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7574 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7575 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7576 doubled. For example
7578 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7580 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7581 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7582 the local host) is used.
7584 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7585 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7586 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7587 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7590 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7591 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7592 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7593 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7595 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7597 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7598 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7600 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7602 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7603 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7604 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7605 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7606 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7607 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7608 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7611 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7612 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7613 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7616 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7619 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7623 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7624 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7628 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7629 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7630 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7631 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7632 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7633 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7634 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7635 them. The following names are recognized:
7637 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7638 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7639 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7640 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7641 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7642 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7643 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7644 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7646 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7647 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7648 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7649 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7651 .cindex LDAP timeout
7652 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7653 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7654 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7655 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7656 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7657 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7658 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7659 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7660 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7661 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7663 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7664 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7666 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7667 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7668 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7669 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7670 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7671 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7672 alternate list (colon-separated).
7674 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7675 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7678 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7679 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7682 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7683 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7684 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7685 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7687 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7688 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7689 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7691 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7692 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7693 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7694 quoting has two advantages:
7697 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7698 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7700 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7703 For example, a setting such as
7705 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7707 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7709 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7710 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7711 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7712 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7716 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7717 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7722 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7723 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7724 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7725 as a sequence of values, for example
7727 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7729 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7730 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7731 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7732 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7733 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7736 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7737 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7738 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7739 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7741 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7742 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7743 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7744 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7745 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7746 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7747 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7748 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7749 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7751 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7752 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7753 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7754 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7755 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7758 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7761 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7764 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7765 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7767 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7768 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7770 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7771 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7774 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7775 results of LDAP lookups.
7776 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7777 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7778 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7779 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7780 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7781 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7786 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7787 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7788 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7789 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7790 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7791 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7792 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7793 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7795 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7797 might return the string
7799 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7800 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7802 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7804 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7810 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7811 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7812 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7816 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7817 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7818 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7819 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7820 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7821 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7822 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7823 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7824 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7825 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7826 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7827 .cindex lookup Redis
7828 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7830 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7833 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7836 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7837 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7839 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7844 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7846 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7847 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7848 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7852 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7853 with a newline between the data for each row.
7856 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7857 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7858 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7859 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7860 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7861 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7862 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7863 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7864 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7865 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7866 .cindex lookup Redis
7867 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7868 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7869 or &%redis_servers%&
7870 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7872 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7873 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7874 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7876 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7877 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7878 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7879 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7881 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7883 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7884 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7885 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7887 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7888 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7890 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7891 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7892 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7893 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7894 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7895 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7897 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7898 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7899 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7901 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7902 host, database number, and password.
7904 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7905 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7906 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7908 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7910 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7913 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7914 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7915 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7916 itself are escaped with backslashes.
7918 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7919 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7921 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7922 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7923 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7924 done by starting the query with
7926 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7928 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7930 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7931 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7932 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7935 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7937 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7938 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7939 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7941 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7942 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7943 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7946 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7950 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7952 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7954 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7955 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7956 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7958 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7962 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7963 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7964 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7965 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
7966 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
7967 the default value is &"exim"&.
7968 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7970 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
7971 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7973 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7974 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7976 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7979 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7980 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7982 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7983 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7984 is zero because no rows are affected.
7987 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7988 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7989 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7990 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7991 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7994 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7996 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7997 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7998 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
8000 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
8001 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
8004 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
8005 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
8006 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
8007 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a filename is required in
8008 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
8009 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
8010 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
8011 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
8012 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
8014 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
8015 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
8017 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
8019 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
8020 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
8022 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
8023 quote, which it doubles.
8025 .cindex timeout SQLite
8026 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
8027 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
8028 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
8029 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
8030 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
8031 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
8032 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
8035 .section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
8036 .cindex "lookup" "Redis"
8037 .cindex "redis lookup type"
8038 Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
8041 ${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
8042 ${lookup redis{get keyname}}
8045 As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
8046 Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
8047 of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
8048 master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
8051 When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, Exim does not
8052 immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
8053 to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
8060 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8061 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8063 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
8064 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
8065 "Domain, host, and address lists"
8066 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
8067 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
8068 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
8069 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
8070 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
8071 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
8073 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
8074 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
8075 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
8076 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
8078 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
8079 support all the complexity available in
8080 domain, host, address and local part lists.
8084 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
8085 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
8086 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
8088 &'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
8089 splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
8092 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
8093 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
8094 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
8095 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
8096 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
8099 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
8100 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
8101 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
8103 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
8104 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
8105 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
8106 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
8107 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
8109 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
8110 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
8112 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
8113 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
8114 senders based on the receiving domain.
8119 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
8120 .cindex "list" "negation"
8121 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
8122 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
8123 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
8124 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
8125 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
8126 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
8128 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
8129 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
8130 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
8131 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
8132 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
8134 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
8136 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
8137 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
8138 list is positive. However, if the setting were
8140 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
8142 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
8143 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
8144 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
8146 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
8147 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
8152 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
8153 .cindex "list" "filename in"
8154 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute
8155 filename (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
8156 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
8157 filenames are not allowed,
8158 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
8159 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
8163 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
8164 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
8166 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
8167 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
8168 white space or the start of the line. For example:
8170 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
8174 Putting a filename in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
8175 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
8176 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
8177 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
8179 If a filename is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
8180 within the file is inverted. For example, if
8182 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
8184 and the file contains the lines
8189 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
8190 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
8194 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
8195 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
8196 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
8197 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
8198 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
8199 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
8200 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8201 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8203 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8204 list, just give the filename on its own, without a search type, as described
8205 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8206 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8211 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
8212 .cindex "named lists"
8213 .cindex "list" "named"
8214 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8215 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8216 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8217 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8218 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8219 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8220 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8222 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8224 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8225 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8226 configured with the line
8228 domains = +local_domains
8230 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8231 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8235 domains = ! +local_domains
8236 transport = remote_smtp
8239 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8240 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8241 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8242 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8244 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8245 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8247 A named list may refer to other named lists:
8249 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8250 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8251 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8253 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8254 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8255 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8257 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8258 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8260 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8261 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8262 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8264 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8266 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8267 referenced lists if you can.
8269 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8270 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8271 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8273 domains = +local_domains
8275 on several of your routers
8276 or in several ACL statements,
8277 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8278 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8279 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8280 the same each time they are referenced.
8282 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8283 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8284 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8285 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8289 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8290 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8291 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8292 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8293 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8296 ALIST = host1 : host2
8297 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8299 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8301 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8303 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8306 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8307 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8309 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8311 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8315 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8316 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
8317 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
8318 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8319 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8320 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8321 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8322 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8323 message. For example:
8325 domainlist special_domains = \
8326 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8328 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8329 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8330 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8331 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8332 same list each time.
8334 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8335 cache the result anyway. For example:
8337 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8339 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8340 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8344 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8345 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8346 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8347 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8348 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8351 .cindex "primary host name"
8352 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8353 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8354 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8355 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8356 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8357 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8358 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8359 differ only in their names.
8361 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8362 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8363 .cindex "domain literal"
8364 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8365 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8366 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8367 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8368 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8369 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8372 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8373 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8374 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8375 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8376 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8377 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8378 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8379 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8380 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8381 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8382 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8384 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8385 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8386 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8387 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8388 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8390 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8391 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8392 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8393 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8394 on a router). For example:
8396 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8398 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8399 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8401 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8402 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8403 contain negative items.
8405 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8406 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8407 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8409 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8410 an.other.domain : ...
8412 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8413 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8415 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8416 an.other.domain ? ...
8419 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8420 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8421 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8422 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8423 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8424 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8425 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8426 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8427 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8431 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8432 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8433 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8434 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8435 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8436 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8437 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8438 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8439 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8441 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8442 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8443 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8444 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8445 expression by expansion, of course).
8447 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8448 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8449 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8450 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8451 must be a filename in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8452 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8454 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8456 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8457 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8458 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8459 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8460 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8461 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8462 other statements in the same ACL.
8465 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8466 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8468 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8470 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8471 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8474 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8475 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8476 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8477 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8478 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8479 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8482 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8483 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8484 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8485 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8487 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8488 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8490 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8491 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8492 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8493 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8494 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8496 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8497 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8498 between the pattern and the domain.
8501 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8503 domainlist funny_domains = \
8506 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8507 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8508 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8509 nis;domains.byname : \
8510 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8512 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8513 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8514 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8515 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8516 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8521 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8522 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8523 .cindex "list" "host list"
8524 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8525 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8526 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8527 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8528 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8529 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8530 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8533 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8534 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8535 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8536 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8537 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8538 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8541 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8542 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8543 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8547 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8548 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8549 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8550 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8551 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8552 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8553 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8556 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8557 inspecting its IP address:
8560 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8561 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8562 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8563 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8564 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8565 with the IP address of the subject host.
8567 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8568 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8569 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8570 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8571 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8574 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8575 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8576 domain name, as just described.
8579 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8580 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8581 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8582 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8583 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8584 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8585 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8586 that can never match a client host.
8589 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8590 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8591 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8592 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8594 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8598 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8599 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8600 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8601 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8602 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8603 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8604 significant end of the address.
8606 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8607 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8608 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8609 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8613 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8614 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8617 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8619 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8620 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8622 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8623 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8626 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8628 could make use of a file containing
8633 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8634 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8635 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8637 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8640 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8646 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8647 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8648 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8649 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8650 address, the pattern takes this form:
8652 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8656 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8658 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8659 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8660 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8661 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8662 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8663 returned by the lookup is not used.
8665 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8666 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8667 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8668 patterns of this form:
8670 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8674 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8676 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8677 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8678 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8679 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8680 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8682 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8683 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8684 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8685 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8686 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8687 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8688 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8689 converted using colons and not dots.
8691 In all cases except IPv4-mapped IPv6, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8692 addresses are always used.
8693 The latter are converted to IPv4 addresses, in dotted-quad form.
8696 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8697 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8698 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8701 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8702 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8703 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8704 case the IP address is used on its own.
8708 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8709 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8710 .cindex "unknown host name"
8711 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8712 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8713 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8714 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8715 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8718 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8719 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8720 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8721 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8722 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8723 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8724 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8726 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8727 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8729 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8730 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8731 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8732 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8733 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8734 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8735 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8736 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8737 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8739 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8740 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8742 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8743 .cindex "alias for host"
8744 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8745 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8748 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8749 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8750 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8751 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8752 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8755 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8756 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8757 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8758 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8759 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8760 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8761 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8766 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8767 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8768 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8769 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8770 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8772 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8774 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8775 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8776 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8783 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8784 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8785 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8786 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8787 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8788 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8790 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8791 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8793 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8794 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8795 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8796 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8797 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8798 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8799 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8800 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8801 not recognized in an indirected file).
8804 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8805 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8807 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8809 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8810 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8813 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8814 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8817 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8820 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8821 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8822 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8825 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8826 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8829 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8831 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8833 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8834 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8835 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8838 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8839 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8840 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8842 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8844 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8845 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8846 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8847 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8848 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8849 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8850 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8853 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8854 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8856 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8857 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8859 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8860 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8861 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8866 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8868 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8869 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8870 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8871 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8872 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8873 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8874 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8875 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8876 host lists such as whitelists.
8880 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8881 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8882 .cindex "unknown host name"
8883 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8884 If a pattern is of the form
8886 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8890 dbm;/host/accept/list
8892 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8893 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8896 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8897 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8898 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8899 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8900 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8901 lookup, both using the same file.
8905 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8906 If a pattern is of the form
8908 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8910 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8911 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8912 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8914 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8915 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8917 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8918 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8919 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8922 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8923 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8924 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8926 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8927 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8928 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8929 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8930 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8931 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8937 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8938 .cindex "list" "address list"
8939 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8940 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8941 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8942 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8943 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8944 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8945 using this option setting:
8949 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8950 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8951 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8952 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8954 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8957 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8959 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8960 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8961 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8962 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8963 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8964 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8965 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8967 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8968 *@+hostile_domains:\
8969 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8970 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8972 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8973 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8974 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8975 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8976 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8978 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8979 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8980 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8981 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8982 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8984 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8987 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8988 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8992 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8993 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8994 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8995 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8996 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8997 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8998 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9000 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
9001 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
9003 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
9004 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
9007 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
9008 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
9009 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
9012 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
9013 mysql;select address from blocked where \
9014 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
9016 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
9017 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
9018 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
9019 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
9021 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
9022 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
9024 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
9025 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
9026 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
9027 default. For example, with this lookup:
9029 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
9031 the file could contains lines like this:
9033 user1@domain1.example
9036 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
9039 nimrod@jaeger.example
9043 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
9044 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
9046 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
9048 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
9049 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
9051 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
9052 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
9053 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
9057 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
9058 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
9063 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
9064 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
9065 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
9066 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
9067 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
9068 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
9069 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
9070 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
9071 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
9073 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
9074 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
9075 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
9076 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
9077 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
9080 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
9082 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
9084 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
9086 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
9088 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9089 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
9090 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
9091 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
9092 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
9093 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
9095 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
9098 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
9101 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
9102 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
9103 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
9104 might have entries like
9106 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
9107 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
9110 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
9111 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
9112 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
9113 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
9115 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
9116 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
9117 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
9120 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
9121 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
9122 can only return a single list of local parts.
9125 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
9126 in these two examples:
9129 senders = *@+my_list
9131 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
9132 example it is a named domain list.
9137 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
9138 .cindex "case of local parts"
9139 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
9140 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
9141 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
9142 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
9143 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
9144 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
9145 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
9146 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
9149 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
9150 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
9151 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
9152 the address list itself, in files included as plain filenames, and in any file
9153 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
9154 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
9155 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
9158 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
9159 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
9160 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
9161 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
9162 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
9163 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
9164 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
9165 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
9169 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
9170 .cindex "list" "local part list"
9171 .cindex "local part" "list"
9172 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
9173 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
9174 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
9175 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
9176 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
9177 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
9178 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
9179 option is case-sensitive from the start.
9181 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
9182 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
9183 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
9184 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
9185 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
9186 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
9187 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
9189 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
9194 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9195 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9197 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
9198 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
9199 Many strings in Exim's runtime configuration are expanded before use. Some of
9200 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
9202 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
9203 .cindex expansion "string concatenation"
9204 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
9205 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9206 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9207 escape character, as described in the following section.
9209 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9210 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9211 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with † after
9212 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9213 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9218 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9219 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9220 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9221 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9222 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9223 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9224 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9225 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9227 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9228 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9229 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9230 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9232 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9234 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9235 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9240 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9241 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9242 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9243 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9244 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9245 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9246 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9249 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9250 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9251 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9254 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9255 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
9256 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9258 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9259 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9260 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9261 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9262 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9263 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9264 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9267 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9268 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9269 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9272 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9273 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9274 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a filename. The file is
9275 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9277 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9279 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9280 Exim message identifier. For example:
9282 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9284 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9285 is therefore restricted to admin users.
9288 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9289 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9290 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9291 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9292 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9293 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9294 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9295 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9296 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9297 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9298 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9299 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9305 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9306 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9307 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9308 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9309 white space is significant.
9312 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9313 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
9314 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9319 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9320 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9321 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9322 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9323 given, the expansion fails.
9325 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9326 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9327 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9328 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9332 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9333 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9334 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9335 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9336 string easier to understand.
9338 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9339 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9340 expansion item below.
9343 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9344 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9345 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9346 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9347 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9348 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9349 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9350 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9351 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9352 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9353 the result of the expansion.
9354 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9355 the expansion result is an empty string.
9356 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9359 .vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9360 .cindex authentication "results header"
9361 .cindex headers "authentication-results:"
9362 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
9363 This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9364 &'Authentication-Results"'&
9366 The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9367 will be a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9368 Methods that might be present in the result include:
9377 Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9379 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9381 This is safe even if no authentication results are available.
9384 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9385 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9386 .cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9387 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9388 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9389 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9390 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9391 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9395 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9396 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9401 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9405 If the field is found,
9406 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9407 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9408 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9409 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9411 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9412 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9415 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9417 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9418 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9420 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9421 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9422 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9423 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9424 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9425 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9426 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9427 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9429 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9430 take an optional modifier of "int"
9431 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9432 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9433 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9435 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9436 newline-separated by default,
9437 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9438 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9439 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9441 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9442 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9443 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9444 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9445 if so the element tags are omitted.
9447 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9449 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9450 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9452 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9453 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9457 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9458 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9459 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9461 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9462 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9463 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9464 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9465 must have the following type:
9467 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9469 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9470 function should return one of the following values:
9472 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9473 into the expanded string that is being built.
9475 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9476 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9478 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9479 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9481 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9483 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9484 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9485 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9488 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9489 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9490 .cindex "environment" "values from"
9491 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9493 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9494 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9495 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9497 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9498 appear, for example:
9500 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9502 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9503 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9505 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9507 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9510 The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9511 &%add_environment%& main section options.
9514 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9515 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9516 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9517 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9518 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9519 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9520 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9521 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9523 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9526 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9527 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9528 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9529 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9530 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9531 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9532 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9533 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9534 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9536 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9537 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9538 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9541 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9542 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9544 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9545 appear, for example:
9547 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9549 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9550 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9552 .vitem "&*${extract json{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9553 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9554 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9555 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9556 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON object"
9557 .cindex JSON expansions
9558 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9559 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9560 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9561 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9563 { <&'"key1"'&> : <&'value1'&> , <&'"key2"'&> , <&'value2'&> ... }
9566 The braces, commas and colons, and the quoting of the member name are required;
9567 the spaces are optional.
9568 Matching of the key against the member names is done case-sensitively.
9569 For the &"json"& variant,
9570 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9573 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9574 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9576 . XXX should be a UTF-8 compare
9578 The results of matching are handled as above.
9581 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9582 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9583 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9584 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9585 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9586 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9587 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9588 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9589 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9590 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9591 <&'string3'&> as before.
9593 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9594 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9595 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9596 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9597 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9598 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9599 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9600 provided. For example:
9602 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9606 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9608 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9609 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9612 .vitem "&*${extract json {*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9613 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9614 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9615 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9616 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON array"
9617 .cindex JSON expansions
9618 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9619 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9621 Field selection and result handling is as above;
9622 there is no choice of field separator.
9623 For the &"json"& variant,
9624 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9627 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9628 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9632 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9633 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9634 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9636 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9637 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9639 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9640 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9641 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9642 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9643 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9645 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
9647 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9648 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9651 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9652 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9653 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9654 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9655 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9656 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9658 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9659 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9660 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9661 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9663 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9665 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9666 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9667 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9668 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9669 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9671 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9673 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9674 letters appear. For example:
9676 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9677 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9678 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9681 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9682 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9683 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9684 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9685 "&*$lheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9686 &*$lh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9687 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9688 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9689 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9690 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9691 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9692 .vindex "&$lheader_$&"
9693 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9694 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9695 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9696 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9697 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9701 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9702 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9703 lines) may be present.
9705 The difference between the four pairs of expansions is in the way
9706 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9709 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9710 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9711 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9714 .cindex "list" "of header lines"
9715 &%lheader%& gives a colon-separated list, one element per header when there
9716 are multiple headers with a given name.
9717 Any embedded colon characters within an element are doubled, so normal Exim
9718 list-processing facilities can be used.
9719 The terminating newline of each element is removed; in other respects
9720 the content is &"raw"&.
9723 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9724 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9725 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9726 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9727 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9728 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9729 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9730 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9733 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9734 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9735 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9736 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9737 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9738 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9741 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9742 command of the following form:
9744 headers charset "UTF-8"
9746 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9747 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9748 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9749 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9750 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9753 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9754 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9755 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9756 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9758 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9759 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9760 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9761 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9762 router or transport are not accessible.
9764 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
9765 ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
9766 because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
9767 They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
9768 Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9769 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9770 point they are added.
9771 When any of the above ACLs ar
9772 running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
9774 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9775 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9776 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9777 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9778 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9779 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9780 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9783 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9784 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9785 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9786 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9787 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9788 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9789 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9790 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9793 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9794 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9796 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9797 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9798 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9799 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9800 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9801 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9802 present. For example:
9804 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9806 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9809 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9811 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9812 an Exim configuration:
9814 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9816 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9819 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9820 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9821 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9823 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9824 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9825 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9826 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9827 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example, by using the
9828 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9831 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9832 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9833 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9834 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9835 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9836 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9838 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9840 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9841 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9842 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9843 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9844 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9846 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9847 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9848 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9850 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9854 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9859 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9860 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
9861 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9862 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9863 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9864 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9868 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9869 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9870 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9871 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9872 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9873 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9874 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9877 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9879 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> bytes or the whole
9880 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9881 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9882 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
9885 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9886 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9887 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9888 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9889 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9890 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9891 apart from an optional leading minus,
9892 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9894 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9895 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9897 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9898 If the number is negative, the fields are
9899 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9900 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9901 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9903 If the modulus of the
9904 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9905 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9909 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9913 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9915 yields &"result: 42"&.
9917 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9918 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9920 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9923 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9924 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9925 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9926 described in the next item.
9928 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9929 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9930 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9931 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9932 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9933 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9934 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9935 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9936 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9938 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9939 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9940 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9941 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9942 out by the system administrator.
9945 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9946 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9947 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9948 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9949 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9950 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9951 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9952 original lookup fails.
9954 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9955 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9956 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9957 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9958 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9959 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9960 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9961 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9963 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9964 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9965 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9966 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9968 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9969 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9970 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9971 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9973 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9975 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9977 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9978 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9980 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9985 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9986 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9988 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9989 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9991 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9992 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9993 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9994 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9996 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9998 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9999 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
10000 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
10002 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10003 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10004 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10005 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10006 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10007 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10008 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10010 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10012 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
10013 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
10014 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
10015 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
10018 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
10020 returns the string &"6/33"&.
10024 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
10025 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
10026 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
10027 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
10028 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
10029 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
10030 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
10031 name of the subroutine, is nine.
10033 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
10034 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
10035 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
10036 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
10037 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
10040 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
10041 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
10042 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
10044 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
10045 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10048 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
10049 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
10050 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
10051 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
10052 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
10053 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
10054 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
10055 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10057 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
10058 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
10059 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
10060 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
10061 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
10062 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
10063 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
10064 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
10065 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
10066 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
10068 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
10069 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
10070 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
10071 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
10073 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
10074 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
10075 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
10076 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
10077 is the expansion of the third argument.
10079 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
10080 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
10081 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10083 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
10084 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
10085 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
10086 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
10087 The filename and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
10088 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
10089 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
10090 newlines are left in the string.
10091 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
10092 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
10093 the string expansion fails.
10095 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
10096 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10100 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
10101 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
10102 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
10103 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
10104 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
10105 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
10106 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
10109 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
10110 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
10112 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
10113 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
10114 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
10115 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
10116 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
10119 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
10121 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
10122 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
10123 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
10124 unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
10125 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
10126 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
10127 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
10129 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
10132 The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
10133 and must be present if the argument is given.
10134 Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
10135 Two option types is currently recognised: shutdown and tls.
10136 The first defines whether (the default)
10137 or not a shutdown is done on the connection after sending the request.
10138 Example, to not do so (preferred, eg. by some webservers):
10140 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
10142 The second, tls, controls the use of TLS on the connection. Example:
10144 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:tls=yes}}
10146 The default is to not use TLS.
10147 If it is enabled, a shutdown as descripbed above is never done.
10149 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
10150 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
10151 turns them into spaces:
10153 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
10155 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
10156 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
10157 addition, the following errors can occur:
10160 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
10162 Failure to connect the socket;
10164 Failure to write the request string;
10166 Timeout on reading from the socket.
10169 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
10170 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
10171 errors occurs. For example:
10173 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
10176 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
10177 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
10178 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
10179 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
10180 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
10182 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
10183 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10186 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10187 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
10188 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
10189 .vindex "&$value$&"
10191 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
10192 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
10193 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10194 Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
10195 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
10196 list is assigned to &$item$&, in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
10197 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
10198 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
10199 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
10200 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
10202 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
10204 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
10207 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
10209 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
10210 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
10213 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
10214 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
10215 expansion item in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
10217 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
10218 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10219 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
10220 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
10221 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
10222 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
10223 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
10224 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
10225 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
10227 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
10228 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
10229 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
10230 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
10231 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
10232 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
10233 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
10234 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
10235 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
10238 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
10239 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
10240 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
10241 .vindex "&$value$&"
10242 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
10243 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
10244 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
10245 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
10246 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
10249 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
10250 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
10251 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
10252 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
10254 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
10255 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
10256 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
10259 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
10260 log_message = Output of id: $value
10262 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
10263 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
10265 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
10268 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
10269 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
10270 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
10272 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
10273 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10277 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10278 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10281 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10282 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10283 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10284 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10286 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10287 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10290 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10291 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10292 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10293 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10294 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10295 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10296 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10297 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10299 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10301 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10302 if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10303 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10305 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10307 yields &"defabc"&, and
10309 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10311 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10312 the regular expression from string expansion.
10314 The regular expression is compiled in 8-bit mode, working against bytes
10315 rather than any Unicode-aware character handling.
10318 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10319 .cindex sorting "a list"
10320 .cindex list sorting
10321 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
10322 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10323 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10324 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10325 of a two-argument expansion condition.
10326 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10327 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10328 if the first value should sort before the second value.
10329 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10330 the element being placed in &$item$&,
10331 to give values for comparison.
10333 The item result is a sorted list,
10334 with the original list separator,
10335 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10339 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10341 sorts a list of numbers, and
10343 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10345 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10348 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10349 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10350 .cindex "substring extraction"
10351 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10352 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10353 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10354 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10355 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10357 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10359 The second number is optional (in both notations).
10360 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10363 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10364 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10365 length required. For example
10367 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10369 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10370 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10371 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10372 given offset. The first byte (character) in the string has offset zero.
10374 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10375 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last byte (character) is offset -1,
10376 the second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10378 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10380 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10381 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10382 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10384 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10386 yields an empty string, but
10388 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10392 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10393 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all bytes (characters) in the
10394 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10395 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10398 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10400 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10402 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10406 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10407 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10408 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10409 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10410 This item does single-character (in bytes) translation on its subject string. The second
10411 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10412 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10413 replacement list. For example
10415 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10417 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10418 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10419 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10422 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10428 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10429 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
10430 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10431 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10432 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10433 following operations can be performed:
10436 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10437 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10438 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10439 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10440 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10441 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10443 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10446 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10447 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10448 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10449 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
10450 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10451 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10452 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10453 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10454 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10456 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10457 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10458 character. For example:
10460 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10462 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10463 first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10464 separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10465 separator explicitly:
10467 ${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10470 Compare the &*address*& (singular)
10471 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10472 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
10475 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10476 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10477 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10478 email address separator. For the example header line:
10480 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10482 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10483 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10484 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10485 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10486 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10487 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10488 quoted. The fourth example shows SMTPUTF8 handling.
10490 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10491 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10493 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10494 Last:user@example.com
10495 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10497 # exim -be '${addresses:フィル <フィリップ@example.jp>}'
10501 .vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10502 .cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10503 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10504 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10505 base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10506 Only lowercase letters are used.
10508 .vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10509 .cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10510 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10511 The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10512 The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10514 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10515 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10516 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10517 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10518 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10519 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10520 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive
10521 filenames), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just
10522 to be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10524 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10525 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10526 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10527 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10528 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10529 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10532 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10533 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10534 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10535 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10536 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10537 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10539 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10540 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10543 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10544 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10545 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10546 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10547 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10550 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10551 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
10552 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10553 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10554 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10557 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10558 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10559 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10560 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10561 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10562 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10563 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10565 .vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10566 .cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10567 .cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10568 If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10569 they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10570 Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10573 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10574 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10575 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10576 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10577 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10578 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10579 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10580 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10581 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10582 C programming language):
10584 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10585 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10586 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10587 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10588 .irow "" "and (&&)"
10590 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10592 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10593 space is permitted before or after operators.
10595 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10596 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10597 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10598 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10599 times, which often do have leading zeros.
10601 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10603 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10604 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10607 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10608 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10609 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10610 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10611 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
10612 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10613 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10614 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10615 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10616 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
10617 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10620 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10622 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10625 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10628 {$recipients_count} \
10629 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10633 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10634 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10637 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10638 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10639 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10642 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10644 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10645 and then re-expands what it has found.
10648 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10650 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10651 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10652 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10653 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10654 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10655 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10656 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10657 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10658 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10660 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10661 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10662 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10663 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10664 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10665 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10666 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10669 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10670 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10671 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10672 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10673 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10674 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10676 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10678 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10679 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10683 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10684 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10685 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10686 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10687 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10688 be useful for processing the output of the various hashing functions.
10692 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10693 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10694 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10695 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10696 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10697 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example, a
10698 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10701 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10702 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10703 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10704 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10705 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10706 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10707 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10709 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10710 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10711 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10712 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10713 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10714 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10715 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10716 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10717 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10720 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10721 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10722 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10723 .cindex "lower casing"
10724 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10725 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10726 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10730 Case is defined per the system C locale.
10732 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10733 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10734 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10735 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10736 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10737 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10739 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10741 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10742 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10743 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10744 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10747 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10748 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10749 .cindex "list" "item count"
10750 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10751 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10752 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10755 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10756 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10757 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10758 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10759 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10760 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10761 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10762 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10763 matching list is returned.
10766 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10767 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10768 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10769 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10770 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10772 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10775 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10776 .cindex "masked IP address"
10777 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10778 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10779 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10780 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10781 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10782 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10783 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10784 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10785 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10787 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10789 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10790 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10791 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10792 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10794 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10798 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10800 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10803 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10805 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10806 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10807 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10808 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10809 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10811 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10812 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10815 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10816 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10817 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10818 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10819 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10820 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10822 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10824 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10827 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10828 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10829 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10830 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10831 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10832 is an empty string or
10833 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10834 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10835 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10836 respectively For example,
10844 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10845 variable or a message header.
10847 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10848 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10849 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10850 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10851 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10852 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10853 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10855 This quoting determination is not SMTPUTF8-aware, thus quoting non-ASCII data
10856 will likely use the quoting form.
10857 Thus &'${quote_local_part:フィル}'& will always become &'"フィル"'&.
10860 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10861 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10862 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10863 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10864 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10866 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10872 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10873 yields an unchanged string.
10876 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10877 .cindex "random number"
10878 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10879 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10880 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10881 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10882 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10883 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10884 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10885 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10889 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10890 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10891 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10892 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10893 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10894 for DNS. For example,
10896 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10897 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10902 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10906 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10907 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10908 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10909 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10910 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10911 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10912 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10913 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10914 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10917 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10919 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10920 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10924 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10925 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10926 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10927 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10928 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10929 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10930 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10931 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10933 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10934 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10935 to use this operator as well.
10939 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10940 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10941 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10942 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10943 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10944 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10945 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10948 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10949 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10950 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10951 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10952 .cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
10953 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10954 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10956 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10957 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10960 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10961 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10962 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10963 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10964 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10965 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
10967 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10969 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10970 returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10973 .vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10974 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10975 .cindex "SHA3 hash"
10976 .cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
10977 .cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
10978 The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
10980 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10982 If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
10983 the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
10984 with 256 being the default.
10986 The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
10987 compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
10988 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
10989 The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
10992 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10993 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10994 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10995 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10996 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10997 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10998 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10999 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
11000 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
11001 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
11002 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
11003 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
11004 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
11006 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
11007 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
11008 systems for files larger than 2GB.
11010 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11011 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
11012 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
11016 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11017 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
11018 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
11019 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
11020 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
11021 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
11022 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11025 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11026 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
11027 .cindex "substring extraction"
11028 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
11029 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
11030 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
11031 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11033 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
11035 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
11036 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
11037 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11039 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11040 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
11041 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
11042 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
11045 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11046 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
11047 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
11048 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
11049 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
11050 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
11053 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11054 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
11055 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
11056 .cindex "upper casing"
11057 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11058 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
11059 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
11060 Case is defined per the system C locale.
11062 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11063 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
11064 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
11065 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
11066 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
11067 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
11068 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
11069 In versions of Exim before 4.92, this did not correctly do so for a truncated
11070 final codepoint's encoding, and the character would be silently dropped.
11071 If you must handle detection of this scenario across both sets of Exim behavior,
11072 the complexity will depend upon the task.
11073 For instance, to detect if the first character is multibyte and a 1-byte
11074 extraction can be successfully used as a path component (as is common for
11075 dividing up delivery folders), you might use:
11077 condition = ${if inlist{${utf8clean:${length_1:$local_part}}}{:?}{yes}{no}}
11079 (which will false-positive if the first character of the local part is a
11080 literal question mark).
11082 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11083 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11084 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11085 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
11086 .cindex expansion UTF-8
11087 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
11089 .cindex internationalisation
11090 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11091 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11092 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11093 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11094 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
11095 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
11103 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
11104 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
11105 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
11106 while expanding strings:
11109 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
11110 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
11111 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
11112 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
11115 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11116 .cindex "numeric comparison"
11117 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
11118 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
11124 &`>= `& greater or equal
11126 &`<= `& less or equal
11130 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
11132 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
11133 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
11134 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
11135 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
11136 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
11139 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
11140 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
11141 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
11144 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
11145 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
11146 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
11147 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
11148 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
11149 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
11150 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
11151 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
11152 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
11153 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
11154 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
11155 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
11156 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
11157 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
11159 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11160 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11161 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
11162 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
11163 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
11164 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
11166 An empty string is treated as false.
11167 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
11168 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
11169 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
11171 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
11172 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
11175 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
11179 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11180 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11181 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
11182 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
11183 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
11184 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
11185 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
11186 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
11188 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
11190 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11191 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
11192 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
11193 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
11194 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
11195 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
11196 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
11197 included in the binary.
11199 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
11200 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
11201 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
11202 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
11203 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
11204 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
11205 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
11206 string in LDAP form is:
11208 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
11210 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
11211 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
11213 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
11215 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
11220 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
11221 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11222 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11223 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
11224 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
11225 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
11229 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11230 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11231 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11232 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
11233 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
11234 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
11237 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
11238 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
11239 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
11240 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
11241 whatever its length.
11244 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
11245 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
11246 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
11247 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
11249 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
11250 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
11251 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
11252 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
11253 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
11254 support &[crypt16()]&.
11256 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
11257 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
11258 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
11259 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
11260 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
11262 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
11263 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
11264 Exim is seen as very low priority.
11266 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
11267 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
11268 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
11269 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
11270 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
11272 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
11273 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
11274 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
11275 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
11276 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
11277 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
11279 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
11281 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
11282 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
11284 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
11285 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
11286 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
11287 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
11288 exists in the message. For example,
11290 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
11292 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
11293 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
11295 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11296 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11297 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11298 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11299 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
11300 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
11301 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
11302 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
11303 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent, where
11304 case is defined per the system C locale.
11306 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
11307 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
11308 .cindex "file" "existence test"
11309 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11310 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11311 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11312 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11313 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11315 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
11316 .cindex "delivery" "first"
11317 .cindex "first delivery"
11318 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11319 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11320 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11321 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11324 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11325 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11326 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11327 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11328 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11330 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11331 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11332 the normal method (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
11333 The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11334 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11335 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11337 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11338 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11339 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11341 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11342 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11343 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11345 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11346 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11347 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
11348 list separator is changed to a comma:
11350 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11352 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
11353 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11355 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11358 .vitem "&*forall_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11359 "&*forany_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11360 "&*forall_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11361 "&*forany_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11362 .cindex JSON "iterative conditions"
11363 .cindex JSON expansions
11364 .cindex expansion "&*forall_json*& condition"
11365 .cindex expansion "&*forany_json*& condition"
11366 .cindex expansion "&*forall_jsons*& condition"
11367 .cindex expansion "&*forany_jsons*& condition"
11368 As for the above, except that the first argument must, after expansion,
11370 The array separator is not changeable.
11371 For the &"jsons"& variants the elements are expected to be JSON strings
11372 and have their quotes removed before the evaluation of the condition.
11377 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11378 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11379 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11380 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11381 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11382 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11383 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11384 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11385 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11387 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11389 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11390 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11391 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11392 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11393 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11394 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11395 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11396 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11397 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11399 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11401 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11402 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11403 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11404 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11405 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11406 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11408 For the case-independent &%inlisti%& condition, case is defined per the system C locale.
11410 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11411 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11413 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11414 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11415 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11416 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11419 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11420 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11421 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11422 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11423 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11424 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11425 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11426 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11427 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11428 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11429 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11431 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11432 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11433 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11434 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11435 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11437 &*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11438 values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11440 This is no longer the case.
11442 The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11443 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11445 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11447 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11449 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11450 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11451 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11452 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11453 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11454 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11455 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11456 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11457 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11458 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11459 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11460 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11461 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11465 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11466 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11467 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11468 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11469 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11470 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11471 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11472 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11473 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11475 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11477 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11478 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11479 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11480 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11481 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11482 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11483 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11484 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11485 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11487 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11490 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11491 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11492 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11493 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11494 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11495 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11496 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11497 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11498 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11499 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11500 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11503 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11505 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11506 backslashes is also required.
11508 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11509 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11510 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11511 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11512 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11513 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11514 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware,
11515 but we might change this in a future Exim release.
11517 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11518 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11519 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11520 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11521 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11522 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11523 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11524 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11526 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11527 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11528 See &*match_local_part*&.
11530 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11531 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11532 See &*match_local_part*&.
11534 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11535 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11536 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11537 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11538 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11539 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11541 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11543 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11546 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11548 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11550 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11551 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11552 in a single test such as
11553 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11554 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11555 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11556 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11558 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11560 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11562 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11564 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11565 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11566 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11567 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11568 masks. For example:
11570 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11572 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11573 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11574 address mask, for example:
11576 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11578 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11579 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11581 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11585 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11586 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11588 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11590 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11591 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11592 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11593 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11594 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11595 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11596 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11597 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11600 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11602 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11603 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
11604 is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11605 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11607 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11609 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11610 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11611 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11612 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11615 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11616 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11618 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11619 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11620 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11621 matched using &%match_ip%&.
11623 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11624 .cindex "PAM authentication"
11625 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11626 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11627 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11628 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11629 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11630 (&url(https://mirrors.edge.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11631 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11632 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11633 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11637 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11638 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11640 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11641 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11642 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11643 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11644 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11645 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11646 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11648 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11649 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11650 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11651 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11652 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11654 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11656 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11658 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11660 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11661 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11662 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11663 . --- 2018-09-07: the pam_exim modified variant has gone, removed claims re using Exim via that
11666 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11667 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11669 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11670 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11671 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11672 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11673 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11674 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11676 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11677 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11678 building Exim. For example:
11680 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11682 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11683 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11684 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11685 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11687 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11688 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11689 configuration, you might have this:
11691 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11693 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11695 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11697 .vitem &*queue_running*&
11698 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11699 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11700 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11701 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11702 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11705 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11707 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11708 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11709 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11710 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11711 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11714 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11715 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11716 this library, you need to set
11718 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11720 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11721 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11723 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11725 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11726 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11727 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11729 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11730 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11731 the authentication is successful. For example:
11733 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11737 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11738 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11739 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11741 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11742 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11743 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11744 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11745 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11746 by a process that is not running as root.
11748 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11749 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11750 building Exim. For example:
11752 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11754 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11755 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11756 from the Cyrus SASL library.
11758 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11759 two are mandatory. For example:
11761 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11763 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11764 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11765 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11770 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11771 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11772 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11773 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11774 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11775 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11776 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11780 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11781 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11782 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11783 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11784 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11787 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11789 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11790 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11791 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11793 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11794 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11795 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11796 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11797 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11798 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11799 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11800 parsed but not evaluated.
11802 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11807 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11808 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11809 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11810 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11811 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11814 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11815 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11816 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11817 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11818 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11819 In the expansion condition case
11820 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11821 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11822 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11823 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11824 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11825 matching condition.
11827 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11828 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11829 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11830 any unused variables being made empty.
11832 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11833 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11834 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11835 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11836 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11837 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11838 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11839 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11840 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11841 during subsequent delivery.
11843 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11844 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11845 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11846 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11847 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11848 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11849 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11850 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11853 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11854 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11855 this variable has the number of arguments.
11857 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11858 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11859 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11860 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11861 be preserved by coding like this:
11863 warn !verify = sender
11864 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11866 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11867 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11870 .vitem &$address_data$&
11871 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11872 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11873 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11874 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11875 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11876 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11879 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11880 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11881 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11882 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11883 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11884 from the child's routing.
11886 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11887 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11888 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11891 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11892 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11893 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11895 .vitem &$address_file$&
11896 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11897 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11898 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11899 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11900 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11902 /home/r2d2/savemail
11904 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11905 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11906 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11907 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11908 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11909 to the relevant file.
11911 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11912 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11913 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11914 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11916 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11917 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11918 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11919 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11921 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11922 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11923 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11924 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11925 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11926 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11927 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11928 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11929 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11931 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11932 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11933 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11934 command line option.
11935 This second case also sets up information used by the
11936 &$authresults$& expansion item.
11938 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11939 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11940 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11941 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11942 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11943 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11944 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11945 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11946 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11950 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11951 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11952 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11953 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11954 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11955 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11956 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11957 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11958 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11959 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11960 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11962 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11963 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11964 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11965 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11966 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11969 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11970 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
11971 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11972 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11973 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11974 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11975 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11976 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11977 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11978 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11979 an undefined mechanism.
11981 .vitem &$av_failed$&
11982 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11983 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11984 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11985 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11986 the ACL malware condition.
11988 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
11989 .cindex "message body" "line count"
11990 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
11991 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11992 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11993 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11995 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11996 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11997 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11998 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11999 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
12000 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12001 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
12003 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
12004 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
12005 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
12006 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
12007 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12009 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
12010 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
12011 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
12012 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
12013 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12015 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
12016 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
12017 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12018 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12019 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
12020 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12021 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
12023 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
12024 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
12025 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12026 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12027 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
12028 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12029 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
12031 .vitem &$callout_address$&
12032 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
12033 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
12034 address that was connected to.
12036 .vitem &$compile_number$&
12037 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
12038 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
12039 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
12040 compilations of the same version of Exim.
12042 .vitem &$config_dir$&
12043 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
12044 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
12045 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
12046 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
12047 &$config_dir$& is ".".
12049 .vitem &$config_file$&
12050 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
12051 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
12053 .vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
12054 Results of DKIM verification.
12055 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12057 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
12058 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
12059 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
12060 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
12061 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
12063 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
12064 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
12065 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
12066 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
12067 &$dkim_created$& &&&
12068 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
12069 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
12070 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
12071 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
12072 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
12073 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
12074 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
12075 &$dkim_key_length$&
12076 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
12077 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12079 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
12080 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
12081 When a message has been received this variable contains
12082 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
12083 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12085 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
12086 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
12087 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
12089 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
12090 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
12091 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
12092 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
12093 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
12094 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
12095 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
12096 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
12097 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
12100 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12101 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
12102 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
12103 case for &$domain$&.
12105 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12106 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
12107 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
12108 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
12110 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
12111 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
12112 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
12113 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
12114 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
12115 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
12117 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
12118 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
12119 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
12121 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
12124 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
12125 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
12126 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
12127 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
12128 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
12129 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
12130 the &(smtp)& transport.
12133 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12134 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
12135 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
12136 rewrite domains by file lookup.
12139 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
12140 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
12141 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
12142 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
12143 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
12144 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
12147 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
12148 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
12149 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
12150 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
12154 .vitem &$domain_data$&
12155 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
12156 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
12157 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
12158 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
12159 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
12160 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
12163 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
12164 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
12165 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
12168 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
12169 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
12170 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
12172 .vitem &$exim_path$&
12173 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
12174 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
12176 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
12177 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
12178 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
12180 .vitem &$exim_version$&
12181 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
12182 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
12183 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
12184 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
12185 There may be other characters following the minor version.
12186 This value may be overridden by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
12188 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
12189 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
12190 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
12191 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
12192 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
12193 See the full description in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
12195 .vitem &$headers_added$&
12196 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
12197 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
12198 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
12199 The headers are a newline-separated list.
12203 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
12204 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
12205 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
12206 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
12207 by a setting on the transport itself.
12209 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
12210 of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
12211 &%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
12215 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
12216 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
12217 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
12218 to local and remote transports.
12220 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12221 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12222 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
12223 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
12224 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
12225 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
12226 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
12229 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
12230 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
12231 client is connected.
12234 .vitem &$host_address$&
12235 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
12236 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
12237 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
12238 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
12240 .vitem &$host_data$&
12241 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
12242 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
12243 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
12244 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
12246 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
12247 message = $host_data
12249 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12250 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
12251 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12252 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
12253 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
12254 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
12255 variables is set to &"1"&.
12258 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
12259 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12262 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
12263 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
12264 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
12267 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
12268 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
12269 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
12270 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
12271 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
12272 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
12273 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
12274 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
12275 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
12276 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
12278 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
12279 Performing these checks sets up information used by the
12280 &$authresults$& expansion item.
12283 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
12284 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12285 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
12287 .vitem &$host_port$&
12288 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
12289 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
12290 for an outbound connection.
12292 .vitem &$initial_cwd$&
12293 .vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
12294 This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
12295 directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
12296 working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
12297 to &$spool_directory$& later.
12300 .vindex "&$inode$&"
12301 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
12302 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
12303 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
12304 a unique name for the file.
12306 .vitem &$interface_address$&
12307 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
12308 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
12310 .vitem &$interface_port$&
12311 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
12312 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
12316 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
12317 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
12318 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
12322 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
12323 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
12324 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
12327 .vitem &$load_average$&
12328 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
12329 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
12330 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
12331 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
12333 .vitem &$local_part$&
12334 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12335 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
12336 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
12337 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
12338 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
12340 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12341 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
12342 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
12343 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12346 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12347 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12348 .cindex affix variables
12349 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
12350 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
12351 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
12352 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
12354 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
12355 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
12356 the parent address, not to the filename or command (see &$address_file$& and
12359 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12360 local part of the recipient address.
12362 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12363 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12364 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12366 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12369 "abc:xyz"@test.example
12370 abc\:xyz@test.example
12372 the value of &$local_part$& is
12376 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12377 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12380 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12382 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12383 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12384 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12386 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
12387 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12388 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
12389 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
12390 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
12391 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
12392 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
12394 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
12395 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
12396 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
12397 variable expands to nothing.
12399 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
12400 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12401 .cindex affix variables
12402 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12403 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12404 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12406 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
12407 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12408 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12409 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12410 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12412 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12413 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12414 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12415 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12417 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12418 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12419 See &$local_user_uid$&.
12421 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12422 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12423 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12424 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12425 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12426 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12427 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12428 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12430 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
12431 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12432 This contains the expanded value of the
12433 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12436 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
12437 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12438 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12439 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12440 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12441 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12443 .vitem &$log_space$&
12444 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
12445 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12446 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12447 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12448 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12449 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12452 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12453 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12454 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12455 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12456 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12457 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12458 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12459 and &"yes"& if it was.
12460 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12461 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12462 as authenticated data.
12464 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12465 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12466 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12467 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12468 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12469 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12470 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12473 .vitem &$malware_name$&
12474 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12475 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12476 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12477 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12479 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12480 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12481 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
12482 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
12483 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12484 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12486 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12488 .vitem &$message_age$&
12489 .cindex "message" "age of"
12490 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
12491 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12492 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12495 .vitem &$message_body$&
12496 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12497 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12498 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12499 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
12500 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12501 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12502 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12503 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12504 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12506 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12507 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12508 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12509 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12510 zeros are always converted into spaces.
12512 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
12513 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12514 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12515 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12516 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12517 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12520 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
12521 .cindex "body of message" "size"
12522 .cindex "message body" "size"
12523 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12524 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12525 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12526 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12527 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12529 If the spool file is wireformat
12530 (see the &%spool_files_wireformat%& main option)
12531 the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
12533 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12534 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12535 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12536 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12537 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12538 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12539 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12540 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12542 .vitem &$message_headers$&
12543 .vindex &$message_headers$&
12544 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12545 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12546 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12547 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12549 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12550 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12551 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12552 contents of header lines is done.
12554 .vitem &$message_id$&
12555 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12557 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
12558 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12559 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12560 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12561 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12562 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12563 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12564 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12565 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12566 from the body is not counted.
12568 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12569 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12570 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12571 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12572 header and the body).
12574 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12576 deny message = Too many lines in message header
12578 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12580 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12581 message has not yet been received.
12583 This variable is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12585 .vitem &$message_size$&
12586 .cindex "size" "of message"
12587 .cindex "message" "size"
12588 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
12589 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12590 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12591 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12592 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12593 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12594 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12595 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12596 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12598 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12599 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12600 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12601 value may not, of course, be truthful.
12603 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12604 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12605 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12606 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12608 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12609 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12610 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12612 .vitem &$original_domain$&
12613 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12614 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12615 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12616 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12617 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12618 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12619 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12620 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12621 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12623 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12624 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12625 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12627 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
12628 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12629 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12630 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12631 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12632 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12633 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12634 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12635 the original address.
12637 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12638 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12639 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12640 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12641 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12643 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12644 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12645 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12647 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
12648 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12649 .cindex "sender" "gid"
12650 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12651 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12652 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12653 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12654 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12655 normally the gid of the Exim user.
12657 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
12658 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12659 .cindex "sender" "uid"
12660 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12661 .vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
12662 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12663 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12664 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12667 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
12668 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12669 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12670 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12672 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12673 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12674 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12675 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12678 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12680 This variable contains the current process id.
12682 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12683 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12684 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12685 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12686 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12687 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12688 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12689 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12690 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12691 variable"& error if encountered.
12693 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12694 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12695 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12696 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12697 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12698 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12699 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12702 .vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
12703 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
12704 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
12705 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
12707 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12709 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12711 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12712 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12713 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12714 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12716 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12717 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12718 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12719 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12721 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12722 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12723 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12724 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12726 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12727 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12728 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12729 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12731 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12732 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12733 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12735 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12736 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12737 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12738 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12740 .vitem &$queue_name$&
12741 .vindex &$queue_name$&
12742 .cindex "named queues"
12743 .cindex queues named
12744 The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
12746 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12747 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12748 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12749 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12750 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12752 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12753 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12754 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12755 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12756 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12757 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12759 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12760 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12761 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12762 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12763 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12765 .vitem &$received_count$&
12766 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
12767 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12768 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12769 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12772 .vitem &$received_for$&
12773 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
12774 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12775 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12776 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12777 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12779 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12780 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12781 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12782 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12783 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12784 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12785 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12788 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12789 could be used, for example, to make the filename for a TLS certificate depend
12790 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12791 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12792 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12794 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12796 .vitem &$received_port$&
12797 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
12798 See &$received_ip_address$&.
12800 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
12801 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12802 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12803 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12804 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12805 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12806 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12807 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12808 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12810 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12811 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12812 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12813 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12814 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12815 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12817 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12818 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12819 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12821 .vitem &$received_time$&
12822 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
12823 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12824 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12826 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12827 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12828 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12829 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12830 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12832 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12833 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12835 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12836 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12837 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12838 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12840 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12841 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12842 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12843 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12846 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12847 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12850 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12853 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12854 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12858 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12861 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12864 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12865 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12867 .vitem &$recipients$&
12868 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12869 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12870 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12871 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12872 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12876 In a system filter file.
12878 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12879 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12880 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12881 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12883 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12887 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12888 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12889 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12890 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12891 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12892 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12895 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12896 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12897 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12898 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12900 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12901 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12902 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12903 these variables contain the
12904 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12907 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12908 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12909 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12910 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12911 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12912 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12913 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12915 .vitem &$return_path$&
12916 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12917 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12918 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12919 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12920 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12921 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12922 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12923 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12924 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12925 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12928 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12929 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12930 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12932 .vitem &$router_name$&
12933 .cindex "router" "name"
12934 .cindex "name" "of router"
12935 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
12936 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12939 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12940 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
12941 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12942 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12943 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12944 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12945 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12948 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
12949 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12950 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12951 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12952 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12953 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12954 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12955 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12957 .vitem &$sender_address$&
12958 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12959 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12960 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12961 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12962 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12964 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12965 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12966 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12967 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12968 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12969 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12970 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12971 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12973 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12974 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12975 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12977 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12978 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12979 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12981 .vitem &$sender_data$&
12982 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12983 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12984 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12985 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12988 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12989 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12991 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12992 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12993 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12994 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12996 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12997 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12998 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12999 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
13000 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
13001 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
13002 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
13003 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
13004 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
13005 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
13006 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
13007 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
13008 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
13010 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
13011 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
13012 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
13013 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13014 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
13016 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
13017 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
13018 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
13019 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
13020 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
13021 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
13023 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
13024 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
13025 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
13026 this variable contains that
13027 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
13029 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
13030 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
13031 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
13032 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
13033 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
13034 &$authenticated_id$&.
13036 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
13037 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
13038 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
13039 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
13040 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
13041 resolver library states that both
13042 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
13043 other times, this variable is false.
13045 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13046 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
13047 library, by setting:
13052 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
13053 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
13055 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
13056 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
13058 This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
13059 DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
13060 all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
13061 is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
13064 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
13065 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13066 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13067 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
13068 other means, this variable is empty.
13070 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13071 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
13072 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
13073 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
13074 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
13075 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
13076 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
13078 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
13079 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
13080 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
13081 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
13083 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
13084 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
13085 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
13088 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
13089 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
13090 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
13091 following are true:
13094 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
13096 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
13097 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
13098 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
13100 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
13101 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
13102 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
13104 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
13105 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
13106 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
13108 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
13109 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
13110 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
13111 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
13113 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
13115 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
13116 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
13120 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
13121 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
13122 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
13123 number that was used on the remote host.
13125 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
13126 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
13127 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13128 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
13129 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
13132 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
13133 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
13134 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
13135 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
13137 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
13138 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13139 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13140 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
13141 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
13142 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
13143 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
13144 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
13145 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
13146 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
13147 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
13150 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
13151 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
13152 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
13153 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
13154 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
13156 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
13157 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
13158 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
13159 about the failure. The details are the same as for
13160 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
13162 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
13163 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
13164 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13165 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
13166 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
13167 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
13168 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
13170 .vitem &$sending_port$&
13171 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
13172 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13173 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
13174 connections, see &$received_port$&.
13176 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
13177 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
13178 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
13179 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
13180 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
13181 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
13183 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
13184 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
13185 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
13186 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
13187 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
13192 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
13193 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
13194 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
13195 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
13197 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
13198 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
13199 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
13200 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
13201 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
13202 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
13203 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
13205 .vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
13206 .cindex SMTP "command history"
13207 .vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
13208 A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
13209 received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
13212 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
13213 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
13214 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
13215 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
13216 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
13217 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
13218 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
13219 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
13220 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
13221 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
13222 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
13224 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
13225 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
13226 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
13227 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
13228 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
13229 message is junk mail.
13231 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
13232 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
13233 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
13234 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
13236 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
13237 &$spf_received$& &&&
13239 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
13240 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
13241 These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
13242 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
13244 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
13245 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
13246 The name of Exim's spool directory.
13248 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
13249 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13250 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
13251 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
13252 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
13253 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
13255 .vitem &$spool_space$&
13256 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13257 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
13258 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
13259 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
13260 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
13261 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
13262 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
13264 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
13266 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
13269 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
13270 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
13271 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
13272 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
13273 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
13274 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
13276 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
13277 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
13278 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13279 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
13280 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13281 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13282 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
13283 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
13285 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
13286 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13289 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
13290 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
13291 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13292 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
13293 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13294 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13296 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
13297 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
13298 .cindex certificate variables
13299 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13300 inbound connection when the message was received.
13301 It is only useful as the argument of a
13302 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13303 or a &%def%& condition.
13305 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
13306 when a list of more than one
13307 file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
13309 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
13310 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
13311 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13312 inbound connection when the message was received.
13313 It is only useful as the argument of a
13314 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13315 or a &%def%& condition.
13316 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13317 which is not the leaf.
13319 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
13320 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
13321 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13322 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13323 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13324 or a &%def%& condition.
13326 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
13327 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
13328 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13329 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13330 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13331 or a &%def%& condition.
13332 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13333 which is not the leaf.
13335 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
13336 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
13337 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
13338 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
13340 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
13341 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13344 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
13345 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
13346 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
13347 outbound SMTP connection was made,
13348 and &"0"& otherwise.
13350 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
13351 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13352 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13353 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13354 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
13355 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
13356 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
13357 &$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
13358 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
13360 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
13361 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
13362 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
13365 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher_std$&
13366 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher_std$&"
13367 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13370 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
13371 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
13373 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
13374 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
13375 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
13376 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
13379 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher_std$&
13380 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher_std$&"
13381 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13384 .vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
13385 .vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
13386 DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13388 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
13389 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
13390 When a message is received from a remote client connection
13391 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
13393 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
13394 1 No response to request
13395 2 Response not verified
13396 3 Verification failed
13397 4 Verification succeeded
13400 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
13401 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
13402 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
13403 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
13404 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
13406 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
13407 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
13408 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
13409 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
13410 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13411 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
13412 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13413 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13414 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13415 which is not the leaf.
13417 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
13418 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13421 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
13422 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
13423 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13424 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
13425 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13426 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13427 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13428 which is not the leaf.
13430 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
13431 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
13432 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
13433 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13434 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
13435 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
13436 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
13437 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
13438 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
13439 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
13440 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
13442 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
13443 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13446 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13447 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13448 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13450 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13453 .vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13454 .vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13455 Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13457 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13458 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13459 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13460 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13462 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13463 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13464 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13466 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13467 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13468 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13470 .vitem &$tod_full$&
13471 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13472 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13473 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13474 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13475 values for those that are behind (west).
13478 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13479 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
13480 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13482 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13483 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13484 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13485 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13488 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
13489 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13490 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13493 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13494 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13495 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13496 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13498 .vitem &$transport_name$&
13499 .cindex "transport" "name"
13500 .cindex "name" "of transport"
13501 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13502 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13505 .vindex "&$value$&"
13506 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13507 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13508 &*reduce*& expansion.
13510 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
13511 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13512 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13513 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13516 .vitem &$version_number$&
13517 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
13518 The version number of Exim. Same as &$exim_version$&, may be overridden
13519 by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
13521 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13522 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13523 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13524 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13526 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13527 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13528 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13529 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13535 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13536 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13538 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
13539 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
13540 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
13541 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
13542 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
13543 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
13548 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
13551 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
13552 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
13553 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
13554 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
13555 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
13556 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
13557 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
13558 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
13559 a newly created Perl interpreter.
13561 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
13562 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
13563 should usually be something like
13565 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13567 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13568 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13569 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13570 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13571 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13572 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13573 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13574 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13578 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13579 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13580 a startup when Exim is entered.
13582 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13583 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13586 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13587 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13590 .oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
13591 .cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
13592 To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
13593 interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
13594 taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
13595 option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
13599 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13600 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13601 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13602 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13606 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
13607 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13609 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13610 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13611 with an error message of the form
13613 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13615 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13616 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
13617 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
13618 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
13619 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
13620 that was passed to &%die%&.
13623 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13624 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13625 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13628 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13630 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13631 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13632 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13634 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13635 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13636 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13637 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13639 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13640 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13641 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13642 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13643 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13644 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13645 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13648 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13649 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13650 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13651 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13652 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13653 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13654 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13655 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13656 avoided, but the output is lost.
13658 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13659 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13660 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13661 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13662 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13663 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13664 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13666 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13668 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13669 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13670 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13671 as the first subroutine argument.
13675 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13676 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13678 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13679 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13680 "Starting the daemon"
13681 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
13682 .cindex "interface" "listening"
13683 .cindex "network interface"
13684 .cindex "interface" "network"
13685 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13686 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13687 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13688 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13689 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13690 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13691 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13692 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13693 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13694 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13695 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13698 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13699 and ports to listen on.
13701 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13702 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13703 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13704 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13705 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13706 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13707 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13708 as an error situation.
13710 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13711 for the outgoing connection.
13715 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13716 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13717 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13718 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13719 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13721 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13722 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13723 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13724 chapter describes how they operate.
13726 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13727 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13731 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13732 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13733 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13737 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13739 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13741 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13742 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13745 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13746 described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13747 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13748 colons. For example:
13750 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13753 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13755 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13756 in &%local_interfaces%&:
13759 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13760 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13762 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13763 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13766 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13767 with a colon separator, for example:
13769 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13770 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13774 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13775 default setting contains just one port:
13777 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13779 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13780 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13781 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13782 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13783 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13787 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13788 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13789 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13790 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13791 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13792 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13794 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13796 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13798 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13800 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13804 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13805 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13806 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13807 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13808 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13809 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13812 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13813 changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) if required.
13814 If there are any items that do not
13815 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13816 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13817 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13818 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13822 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13825 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13827 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13828 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13829 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13833 .section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13834 .cindex "submissions protocol"
13835 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13836 .cindex "smtps protocol"
13837 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13838 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13839 Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
13840 &"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
13841 For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
13842 STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
13843 the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
13844 If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
13845 (Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
13848 If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
13849 service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
13850 proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
13852 The common use of this option is expected to be
13854 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13857 There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
13858 to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
13860 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13861 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13862 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13863 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13864 connections via the daemon.)
13869 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13870 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13871 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13872 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13873 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13874 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13875 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13876 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13878 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13880 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13881 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13882 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13883 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13884 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13885 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13887 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13889 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13890 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13891 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13892 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13893 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13895 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13896 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13897 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13898 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13899 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13900 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13901 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13902 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13903 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13904 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13905 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13906 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13908 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13909 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13910 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13911 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13912 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13916 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13917 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13919 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13920 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13922 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13923 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13924 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13925 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13927 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13929 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13931 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13933 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13934 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13936 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13937 IPv4 loopback address only:
13939 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13941 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13943 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13945 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13949 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13950 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13951 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13952 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13955 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13956 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13957 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13958 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13960 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13961 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13962 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13963 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13964 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13965 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13966 used for listening. Consider this example:
13968 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13970 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13972 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13974 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13975 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13978 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13979 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13980 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13981 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13982 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13983 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13984 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13985 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13989 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13990 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13991 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13992 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13993 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13994 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
14000 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14001 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14003 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
14004 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
14005 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
14006 The first part of the runtime configuration file contains three types of item:
14009 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
14010 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
14012 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
14013 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
14014 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
14016 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
14017 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
14018 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
14019 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
14023 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
14024 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
14025 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
14026 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
14027 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
14028 listed in more than one group.
14030 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
14032 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
14033 .row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
14034 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14035 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
14036 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
14037 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
14038 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
14039 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
14040 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
14041 .row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
14042 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
14046 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
14048 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
14049 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14050 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
14051 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
14052 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
14053 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
14058 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
14060 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
14061 .row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
14062 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
14063 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
14064 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14065 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14066 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
14067 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
14068 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
14069 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
14070 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
14071 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
14076 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
14078 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
14079 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
14080 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14081 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
14082 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
14083 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
14084 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
14085 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
14086 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
14087 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
14088 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
14089 .row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
14090 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
14091 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
14092 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
14097 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
14099 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
14100 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
14101 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
14102 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
14107 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
14109 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
14110 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14111 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14112 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
14113 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
14114 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
14115 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
14116 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
14117 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
14118 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
14119 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
14120 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
14121 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
14122 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
14123 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
14128 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
14130 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
14131 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
14136 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
14138 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
14139 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
14140 .row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
14145 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
14147 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
14148 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
14149 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
14150 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
14151 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
14152 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14153 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14158 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
14160 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14161 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
14162 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14163 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
14164 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
14165 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
14166 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14167 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14168 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14169 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14170 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14171 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14172 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14173 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14174 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14175 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14177 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14178 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14179 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14180 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
14181 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14186 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
14188 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
14189 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
14190 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
14191 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
14192 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
14193 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
14194 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
14195 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
14196 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
14197 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
14198 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
14199 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
14200 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
14201 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
14202 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
14203 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
14204 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
14205 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
14206 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
14207 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
14208 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
14209 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14211 .row &%dns_cname_loops%& "follow CNAMEs returned by resolver"
14212 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
14213 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
14214 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14215 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14216 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
14217 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
14218 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
14219 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
14220 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
14221 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14222 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14223 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
14224 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
14225 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
14226 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
14227 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
14228 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14229 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
14230 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
14235 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
14237 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
14239 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
14241 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
14242 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
14243 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
14248 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
14250 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
14251 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
14252 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
14253 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14254 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
14255 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
14256 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
14257 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
14258 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
14259 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
14260 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
14261 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
14262 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
14263 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
14264 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
14265 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
14266 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
14271 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
14273 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
14274 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
14275 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
14276 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
14277 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
14278 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
14279 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
14280 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
14285 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
14287 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14288 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14289 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
14290 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14291 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
14292 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
14293 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
14294 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
14300 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
14302 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
14309 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
14310 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
14313 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
14314 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14315 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14316 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
14317 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
14318 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
14319 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
14320 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
14321 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14322 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14323 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14324 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14325 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14326 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14327 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14329 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14330 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
14331 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
14332 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14333 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14334 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
14335 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
14336 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
14337 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
14338 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
14339 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
14340 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
14341 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
14342 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
14343 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14344 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14349 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
14351 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
14352 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
14353 .row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
14354 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
14355 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
14356 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
14357 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14358 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
14359 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
14360 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14365 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
14367 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
14368 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
14369 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
14370 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14372 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14373 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14374 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
14375 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
14376 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
14377 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
14378 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14379 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
14380 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
14381 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
14386 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
14388 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
14389 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
14391 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
14392 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
14393 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
14394 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
14395 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
14400 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
14402 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14403 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
14404 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
14405 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
14406 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
14407 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
14408 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
14409 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
14410 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
14411 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
14412 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
14413 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
14414 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
14415 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
14416 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
14417 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14418 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
14419 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
14420 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
14421 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
14422 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14423 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
14424 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
14425 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
14430 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
14432 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
14433 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
14434 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
14435 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
14436 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
14437 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
14438 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
14439 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
14440 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
14441 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
14442 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
14443 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
14444 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
14445 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14446 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
14451 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
14452 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
14455 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
14457 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14458 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14459 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
14460 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
14461 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
14462 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
14463 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
14465 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
14466 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
14467 It now defaults to true.
14468 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
14470 &url(https://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
14473 To log received 8BITMIME status use
14475 log_selector = +8bitmime
14478 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14479 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14480 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14481 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14482 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14485 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14486 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14487 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14490 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14491 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14492 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14493 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14494 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14496 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14497 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14498 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14499 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14500 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14502 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14503 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14504 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14505 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14507 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14508 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14509 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14510 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14511 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14513 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
14514 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
14515 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
14516 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
14517 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
14518 This option defines the ACL that,
14519 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
14520 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
14521 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
14522 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14524 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
14525 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
14526 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
14527 (by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
14528 of a received message.
14529 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
14531 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
14532 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
14533 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
14534 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14536 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
14537 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
14538 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
14539 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14541 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
14542 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
14543 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
14544 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
14545 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14548 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
14549 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
14550 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
14551 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14553 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
14554 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
14555 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
14556 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
14557 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
14559 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14560 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
14561 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
14562 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
14563 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
14565 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
14566 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
14567 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
14568 ends without a QUIT command being received.
14569 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14571 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
14572 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
14573 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14576 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
14577 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
14578 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
14579 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14581 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
14582 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
14583 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
14584 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14586 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
14587 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
14588 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
14589 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14591 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14592 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14593 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14594 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14596 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
14597 .cindex "environment" "set values"
14598 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
14599 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use.
14600 See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14602 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14603 .cindex "admin user"
14604 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
14605 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
14606 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
14607 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
14608 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
14609 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
14610 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
14612 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
14613 .cindex "domain literal"
14614 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
14615 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
14616 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
14617 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
14619 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
14620 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
14621 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
14622 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
14623 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
14624 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
14625 the local host's IP addresses.
14628 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
14629 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
14630 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
14631 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
14632 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
14633 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
14634 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
14635 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
14636 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14638 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14639 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14640 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14641 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14642 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14643 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
14644 experiment if they wish.
14646 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14647 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14648 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
14649 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
14650 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14651 suitable setting is:
14653 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14654 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14656 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14658 dns_check_names_pattern =
14660 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14663 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14664 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14665 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14666 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14667 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14668 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14669 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14670 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14671 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14672 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14673 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14675 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14676 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14677 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14678 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14679 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14680 which Exim advertises AUTH.
14682 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14683 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14684 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14685 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14687 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14689 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14690 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14691 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14692 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14695 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
14696 .cindex "thawing messages"
14697 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
14698 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14699 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14700 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14701 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14702 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14704 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14705 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14706 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14709 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
14710 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14711 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14713 sophie:/var/run/sophie
14715 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14716 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14719 .option bi_command main string unset
14721 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14722 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14723 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14724 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14727 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
14728 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14729 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14730 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14731 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14732 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14735 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
14736 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14737 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14738 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14740 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14741 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14742 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14743 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14744 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14745 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14746 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14747 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14748 point at which the error was detected are returned.
14749 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14751 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
14752 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
14753 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
14754 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
14755 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
14756 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
14757 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
14758 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
14759 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
14760 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
14762 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
14763 during reception of a message.
14764 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
14766 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
14769 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14770 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14771 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14772 &%bounce_return_body%&.
14775 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14776 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14777 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14778 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14779 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14780 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14781 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14782 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14783 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14785 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14786 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14787 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14788 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14789 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14792 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14793 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14794 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14795 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14796 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14797 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14798 connection. A typical setting might be:
14800 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14802 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14804 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14806 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14809 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14810 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14811 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14812 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14813 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14814 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14817 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14818 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14819 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14820 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14823 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14824 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14825 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14826 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14829 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14830 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14831 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14832 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14835 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14836 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14837 callout verification. The default value is
14839 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14841 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14844 .option check_log_inodes main integer 100
14845 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14848 .option check_log_space main integer 10M
14849 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14851 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14852 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14853 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14854 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14855 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14856 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14857 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14858 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14859 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14860 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14863 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
14864 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14867 .option check_spool_space main integer 10M
14868 .cindex "checking disk space"
14869 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14870 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14871 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14872 message is accepted.
14874 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14875 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
14876 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14877 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14878 When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14879 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14880 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14881 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14884 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14885 either value is greater than zero, for example:
14887 check_spool_space = 100M
14888 check_spool_inodes = 100
14890 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14891 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14894 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14895 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14896 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14898 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14899 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14900 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14901 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14902 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14903 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14905 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14906 number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
14907 If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14909 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14910 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14911 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14913 There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
14914 Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
14915 high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
14916 may wish to deliberately disable them.
14918 .option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14919 .cindex CHUNKING advertisement
14920 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
14921 The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
14923 Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
14925 .option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
14926 .cindex "restricting access to features"
14927 This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
14928 administrative user.
14929 This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
14931 .option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
14932 .cindex debugging "memory corruption"
14933 .cindex memory debugging
14934 This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
14935 management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
14936 it should normally be left as default.
14938 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14939 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
14940 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14941 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14942 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14943 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14945 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14946 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14947 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14948 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14949 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14950 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14951 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14953 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14954 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14956 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14957 .cindex "warning of delay"
14958 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14959 .cindex "queue" "delay warning"
14960 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14961 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14962 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14963 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14964 message has been in the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14965 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14968 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14970 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14971 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14972 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
14973 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
14977 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
14978 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
14980 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
14982 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
14983 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
14984 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
14986 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
14987 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14988 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14989 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14990 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14991 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14992 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14993 not sent. The default is:
14995 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14996 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14997 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14998 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
15001 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
15002 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
15003 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
15004 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
15006 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
15007 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
15008 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
15009 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
15010 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
15011 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
15012 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
15013 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
15015 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
15016 .cindex "load average"
15017 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
15018 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
15019 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
15020 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
15021 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15024 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
15025 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
15026 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
15027 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15028 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
15029 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
15030 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
15031 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15033 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
15034 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
15035 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
15036 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
15037 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
15038 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
15039 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
15040 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
15042 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
15043 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
15044 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
15045 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
15048 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
15049 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
15050 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
15051 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
15052 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
15053 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
15054 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
15057 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
15058 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
15059 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
15060 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
15061 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
15062 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
15065 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
15066 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
15067 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
15068 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
15069 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
15070 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
15071 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
15072 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
15073 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
15074 by a setting such as this:
15076 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
15078 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
15079 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
15080 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
15081 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
15082 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
15083 options are applied after this global option.
15085 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
15086 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
15087 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
15088 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
15089 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
15090 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
15091 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
15092 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
15093 value of this option. The default pattern is
15095 dns_check_names_pattern = \
15096 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
15098 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
15099 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
15100 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
15101 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
15102 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
15105 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
15106 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
15107 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15109 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
15110 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
15111 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
15112 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15114 .option dns_cname_loops main integer 1
15115 .cindex DNS "CNAME following"
15116 This option controls the following of CNAME chains, needed if the resolver does
15117 not do it internally.
15118 As of 2018 most should, and the default can be left.
15119 If you have an ancient one, a value of 10 is likely needed.
15121 The default value of one CNAME-follow is needed
15122 thanks to the observed return for an MX request,
15123 given no MX presence but a CNAME to an A, of the CNAME.
15126 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
15127 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15128 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15129 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15130 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
15131 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
15133 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
15136 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
15137 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
15138 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
15139 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
15140 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
15141 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
15142 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
15143 domain matches this list.
15145 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
15146 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
15147 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
15150 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
15151 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15152 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
15153 .cindex "DNS" timeout
15154 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
15155 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
15156 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
15157 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
15158 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
15159 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
15160 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
15161 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
15163 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
15166 .option dns_retry main integer 0
15167 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
15170 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
15171 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15172 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15173 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
15174 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
15175 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
15176 match with this expanded domain list.
15178 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
15179 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
15180 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
15181 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
15182 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
15183 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
15185 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
15186 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
15187 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
15189 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
15190 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
15191 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
15192 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
15193 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
15195 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15196 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
15197 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15198 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
15199 .cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
15200 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15201 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
15202 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
15205 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
15207 OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
15208 means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
15209 is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
15212 .option drop_cr main boolean false
15213 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
15214 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
15215 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
15217 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15218 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
15219 .cindex "DSN" "success"
15220 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
15221 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
15222 and accepted from, these hosts.
15223 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
15224 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
15225 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
15226 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
15229 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
15230 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
15231 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
15232 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
15233 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
15234 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
15236 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
15238 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
15239 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
15241 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
15242 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
15243 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
15244 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15245 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
15246 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
15247 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
15248 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
15249 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15252 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
15253 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
15254 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
15255 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
15256 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
15257 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
15258 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
15259 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
15260 must be enclosed in double quotes.
15262 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
15263 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
15264 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
15265 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
15266 are examined. For example:
15268 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
15269 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
15270 postmaster@mydomain.example
15272 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15273 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
15274 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
15275 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
15276 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
15277 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
15278 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
15281 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
15282 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
15283 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
15285 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
15287 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
15288 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
15289 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
15290 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
15291 overrides the default.
15293 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
15294 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
15295 and warning messages. For example:
15297 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
15299 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
15300 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
15301 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
15302 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
15306 .option event_action main string&!! unset
15308 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
15309 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
15312 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
15313 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
15314 .cindex "Exim group"
15315 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15316 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
15317 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
15318 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
15319 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
15323 .option exim_path main string "see below"
15324 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
15325 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
15326 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
15327 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
15328 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
15330 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
15331 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
15332 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
15333 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
15336 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
15337 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
15338 .cindex "Exim user"
15339 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15340 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
15341 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
15342 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
15344 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
15345 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
15346 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
15347 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
15350 .option exim_version main string "current version"
15351 .cindex "Exim version"
15352 .cindex customizing "version number"
15353 .cindex "version number of Exim" override
15354 This option allows to override the &$version_number$&/&$exim_version$& Exim reports in
15355 various places. Use with care, this may fool stupid security scanners.
15358 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
15359 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
15360 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
15361 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
15364 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15365 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15367 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
15368 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
15370 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
15371 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
15372 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
15373 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
15374 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
15375 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
15376 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
15377 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
15378 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
15379 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
15383 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
15384 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
15385 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
15386 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
15387 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
15388 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
15389 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
15390 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
15393 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
15394 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
15395 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
15396 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
15400 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
15401 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
15402 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
15403 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
15404 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
15405 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
15406 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
15407 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
15408 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
15409 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
15410 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
15411 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
15412 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
15413 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
15414 logging that you require.
15417 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
15419 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
15420 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
15421 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
15422 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
15423 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
15424 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
15425 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
15426 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
15428 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
15429 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
15430 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
15433 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
15434 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
15435 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
15436 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
15438 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
15442 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
15443 See &%gecos_name%& above.
15446 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
15447 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
15448 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
15449 implementations of TLS.
15452 .option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
15453 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
15454 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
15457 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
15462 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
15463 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
15464 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
15465 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
15466 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
15467 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
15471 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
15472 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
15473 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
15474 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
15475 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
15476 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
15477 sections are rejected.
15480 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
15481 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
15482 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
15483 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
15484 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
15485 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
15486 zero means &"no limit"&.
15491 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15492 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
15493 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
15494 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
15495 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
15496 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
15497 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
15498 if you want to do semantic checking.
15499 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
15503 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
15504 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
15505 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
15506 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
15507 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
15508 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
15509 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
15511 helo_allow_chars = _
15513 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
15516 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
15517 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15518 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15519 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
15520 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
15521 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
15522 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
15526 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15527 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
15528 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
15529 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
15530 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
15531 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
15532 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
15533 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
15534 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
15535 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
15536 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
15537 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
15539 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
15540 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
15541 EHLO command either:
15544 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
15546 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
15547 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
15548 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
15549 calling host address, or
15551 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
15554 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
15555 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
15556 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
15558 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
15559 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15560 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
15562 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15563 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
15564 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
15565 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
15566 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
15567 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
15568 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
15569 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
15570 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
15573 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15574 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
15575 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
15576 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held in the queue
15577 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
15578 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
15579 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
15580 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
15581 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
15583 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
15584 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
15585 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
15586 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
15587 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
15589 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
15590 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
15591 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
15592 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
15595 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
15596 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
15597 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
15598 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
15599 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
15600 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
15601 default configuration file contains
15605 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
15606 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
15608 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
15609 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
15610 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
15612 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
15613 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
15614 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
15615 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
15616 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
15617 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
15620 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
15621 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
15622 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
15623 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
15624 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
15627 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
15628 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
15629 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
15630 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
15634 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
15635 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
15636 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
15637 as soon as the connection is made.
15638 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
15639 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
15640 connections immediately.
15642 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
15643 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
15644 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
15645 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
15646 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
15649 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
15650 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
15651 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
15652 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
15653 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
15654 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
15655 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
15656 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
15657 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
15659 hosts_connection_nolog = :
15661 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
15665 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
15666 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
15667 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
15668 connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
15671 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
15672 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
15673 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
15674 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
15675 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
15677 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
15678 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
15680 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
15681 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
15682 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
15683 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
15684 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
15685 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
15686 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
15689 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
15690 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
15691 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
15692 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15693 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
15697 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
15698 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
15699 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
15700 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
15701 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
15702 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
15704 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
15705 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
15706 message has been in the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
15707 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
15708 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
15709 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
15710 for frozen messages. For example,
15712 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
15714 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
15715 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
15716 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
15717 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
15718 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
15719 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15722 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15723 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15724 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15725 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15726 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15727 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15728 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15729 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15730 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15731 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15734 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15735 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15737 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
15738 .cindex "environment" "values from"
15739 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
15740 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
15741 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
15742 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
15743 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
15744 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
15745 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
15747 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
15748 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
15750 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
15751 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
15752 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
15753 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
15755 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
15756 &%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
15757 current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
15760 See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
15761 environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
15762 transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
15766 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
15767 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
15768 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
15769 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
15773 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
15774 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
15775 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
15776 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
15777 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15778 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15779 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15780 and constrained to be a directory.
15783 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
15784 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
15785 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15786 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
15787 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15788 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15789 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15790 and constrained to be a file.
15793 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
15794 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
15795 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15796 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
15797 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15798 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
15801 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
15802 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
15803 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
15804 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
15805 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15806 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
15807 identity to be proven.
15810 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
15811 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
15812 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
15813 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
15814 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
15817 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
15818 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
15819 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
15820 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
15821 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
15825 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
15826 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
15827 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
15828 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
15829 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
15830 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
15834 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
15835 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
15836 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
15837 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
15838 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
15840 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
15841 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
15842 This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
15845 .option ldap_version main integer unset
15846 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
15847 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
15848 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
15849 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
15850 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
15851 has been built with LDAP support.
15855 .option local_from_check main boolean true
15856 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
15857 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
15858 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15859 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
15860 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
15861 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
15863 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
15864 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
15865 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15867 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
15868 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
15869 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
15870 and the default qualify domain.
15872 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
15873 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
15874 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
15875 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
15877 .cindex "envelope sender"
15878 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
15879 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
15880 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
15882 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
15883 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
15884 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15889 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
15890 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
15891 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
15892 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
15893 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
15894 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
15895 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
15898 local_from_prefix = *-
15900 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15902 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15904 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15905 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15909 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
15910 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15913 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15914 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
15915 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
15916 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
15917 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
15918 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
15919 &%local_interfaces%& is
15921 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
15923 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
15925 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
15928 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
15929 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
15930 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
15931 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
15932 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
15933 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
15934 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
15935 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
15939 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
15940 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
15941 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15942 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
15943 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
15944 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
15945 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
15946 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15951 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
15952 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
15953 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
15954 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
15955 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
15956 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
15957 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
15958 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
15959 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
15960 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
15961 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
15962 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
15963 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
15964 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
15965 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
15969 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
15970 .cindex "log" "file path for"
15971 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
15972 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
15973 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
15974 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or runtime,
15975 or if the option is unset at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
15976 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
15977 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
15978 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
15979 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
15980 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
15981 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
15982 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
15983 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
15986 .option log_selector main string unset
15987 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15988 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
15989 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
15990 minus characters. For example:
15992 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
15994 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
15995 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
15998 .option log_timezone main boolean false
15999 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
16000 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
16001 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
16002 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
16003 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
16004 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
16005 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
16006 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
16007 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
16008 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
16009 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
16010 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
16013 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
16014 .cindex "too many open files"
16015 .cindex "open files, too many"
16016 .cindex "file" "too many open"
16017 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
16018 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
16019 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
16020 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
16021 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
16022 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
16023 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
16024 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
16025 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
16026 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
16027 &%lookup_open_max%&.
16030 .option max_username_length main integer 0
16031 .cindex "length of login name"
16032 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
16033 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
16034 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
16035 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
16036 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
16037 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
16040 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
16041 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
16042 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
16043 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16044 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16045 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
16046 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
16047 option is set true, this no longer happens.
16050 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
16051 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
16052 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
16053 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16054 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16055 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
16056 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
16059 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
16060 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
16061 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
16062 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
16063 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
16064 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
16065 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
16066 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
16067 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
16068 empty string, the option is ignored.
16071 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
16072 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
16073 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
16074 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
16075 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
16076 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
16077 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
16078 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
16079 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
16080 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
16081 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
16082 colons will become hyphens.
16085 .option message_logs main boolean true
16086 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
16087 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
16088 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
16089 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
16090 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
16091 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
16092 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
16093 which is not affected by this option.
16096 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
16097 .cindex "message" "size limit"
16098 .cindex "limit" "message size"
16099 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
16100 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
16101 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
16102 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
16103 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
16104 optionally followed by K or M.
16106 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
16107 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
16108 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
16109 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
16110 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16112 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
16113 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
16114 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
16115 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
16116 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
16117 message that an individual transport can process.
16119 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
16120 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
16121 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
16122 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
16123 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
16124 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
16125 some problems may result.
16127 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
16128 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
16129 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
16132 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
16133 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
16134 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
16136 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
16138 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
16139 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
16140 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
16141 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
16142 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
16145 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
16146 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
16147 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
16148 contains a full description of this facility.
16152 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
16153 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
16154 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
16155 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
16156 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
16159 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
16160 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
16161 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
16162 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
16163 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
16166 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
16167 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
16168 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
16169 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
16170 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
16172 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
16173 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
16176 never_users = root:daemon:bin
16178 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
16179 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
16183 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +no_sslv3 +single_dh_use +no_ticket"
16184 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
16185 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
16186 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
16187 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
16189 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
16190 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
16191 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
16192 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
16193 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
16194 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
16195 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
16197 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
16198 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
16199 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
16200 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
16201 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
16203 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
16205 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
16206 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
16207 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
16208 some now infamous attacks.
16212 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
16213 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
16214 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
16216 # Disable older protocol versions:
16217 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
16220 Possible options may include:
16224 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
16226 &`cipher_server_preference`&
16228 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
16232 &`legacy_server_connect`&
16234 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
16236 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
16238 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
16240 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
16242 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
16246 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
16260 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
16264 &`single_ecdh_use`&
16266 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
16268 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
16270 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
16274 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
16277 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
16278 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
16279 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
16280 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
16281 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
16282 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
16285 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
16286 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
16287 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
16288 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16289 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
16292 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16293 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
16294 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
16295 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
16296 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
16297 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
16298 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
16299 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
16300 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
16301 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
16304 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
16305 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
16306 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
16307 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
16308 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
16309 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
16310 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
16313 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
16315 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16316 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16319 .option perl_startup main string unset
16321 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16322 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16324 .option perl_startup main boolean false
16326 This Option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
16329 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
16330 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
16331 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
16332 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
16333 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
16334 PostgreSQL support.
16337 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
16338 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
16339 .cindex "pid file, path for"
16340 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
16341 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
16344 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
16346 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
16348 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
16349 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
16350 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
16353 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16354 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
16355 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
16356 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
16357 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
16358 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
16359 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
16360 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
16361 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
16364 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
16365 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
16366 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
16367 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
16368 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
16369 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
16370 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
16371 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
16373 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
16374 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
16375 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
16376 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
16377 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
16378 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
16379 volume of mail. Use with care!
16382 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
16383 .cindex "name" "of local host"
16384 .cindex "host" "name of local"
16385 .cindex "local host" "name of"
16386 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16387 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
16388 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
16389 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
16390 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
16391 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
16393 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
16394 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
16395 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
16396 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
16397 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
16398 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
16401 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
16402 .cindex "printing characters"
16403 .cindex "8-bit characters"
16404 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
16405 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
16406 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
16407 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
16408 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
16411 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
16412 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
16413 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
16414 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
16415 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
16419 .option process_log_path main string unset
16420 .cindex "process log path"
16421 .cindex "log" "process log"
16422 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
16423 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
16424 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
16425 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
16426 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
16427 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
16428 different spool directories.
16431 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
16432 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16436 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
16437 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
16438 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16441 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
16442 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
16443 .cindex "address" "qualification"
16444 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
16445 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
16446 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
16447 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
16448 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
16449 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16451 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
16452 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
16453 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
16454 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
16455 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
16456 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
16457 &%primary_hostname%& value.
16460 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
16461 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
16462 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
16466 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16467 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
16468 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16469 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
16470 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
16471 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
16472 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
16473 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
16476 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
16477 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16479 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
16480 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
16481 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
16482 See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16485 .option queue_only main boolean false
16486 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16487 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
16488 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
16489 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits in the queue for the
16490 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
16491 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
16493 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
16494 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
16495 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
16496 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
16499 .option queue_only_file main string unset
16500 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16501 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
16502 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
16503 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
16504 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
16505 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
16506 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
16507 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
16509 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
16511 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
16512 &_/some/file_& exists.
16515 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
16516 .cindex "load average"
16517 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16518 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
16519 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
16520 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
16521 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
16522 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
16523 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16526 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
16527 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
16528 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
16529 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16532 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
16533 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
16534 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
16535 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
16536 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
16537 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
16538 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
16539 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
16540 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
16541 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16542 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
16543 re-evaluated for each message.
16546 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
16547 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16548 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
16549 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
16550 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
16551 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
16554 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
16555 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
16556 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
16557 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
16558 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
16559 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
16560 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
16561 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
16562 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
16563 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
16564 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
16565 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
16566 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
16570 .option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
16571 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
16572 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
16573 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
16574 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
16575 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
16576 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
16577 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
16578 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
16580 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
16581 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
16582 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
16583 the daemon's command line.
16585 .cindex queues named
16586 .cindex "named queues"
16587 To set limits for different named queues use
16588 an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
16590 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16591 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16592 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
16593 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
16594 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
16595 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
16596 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
16597 message waits in the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
16598 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
16599 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
16600 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
16601 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
16602 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
16606 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
16607 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
16608 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
16609 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
16610 the value is zero, it will wait forever. This setting is overridden by the
16611 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
16612 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
16614 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
16615 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
16616 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
16617 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
16618 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
16619 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
16620 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
16621 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
16622 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
16625 The default setting is:
16628 received_header_text = Received: \
16629 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
16630 {${if def:sender_ident \
16631 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
16632 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
16633 by $primary_hostname \
16634 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol }}\
16635 ${if def:tls_in_cipher_std { tls $tls_in_cipher_std\n\t}}\
16636 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
16637 ${if def:sender_address \
16638 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
16639 id $message_exim_id\
16640 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
16644 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
16645 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
16646 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
16647 header lines such as the following:
16649 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
16650 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
16651 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
16652 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
16653 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
16654 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
16655 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
16657 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
16658 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
16659 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
16660 message was accepted.
16663 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
16664 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
16665 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
16666 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
16667 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
16668 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
16669 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
16670 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
16673 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16674 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16675 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16676 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16677 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
16678 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
16679 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
16680 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
16681 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
16682 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
16683 option was not set.
16686 .option recipients_max main integer 0
16687 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
16688 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
16689 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
16690 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
16691 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
16692 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
16693 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
16696 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
16697 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
16698 RCPT commands in a single message.
16701 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
16702 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
16703 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
16704 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
16705 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
16706 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
16707 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
16710 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
16711 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
16712 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
16713 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
16714 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
16715 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
16716 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
16717 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
16718 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
16719 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
16720 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
16721 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
16722 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
16723 tagged with its process id.
16725 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
16726 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
16727 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
16728 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
16731 .cindex "number of deliveries"
16732 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
16733 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
16734 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
16735 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
16736 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
16737 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
16738 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
16739 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
16740 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
16741 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
16743 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
16744 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
16745 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
16746 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
16749 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16750 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
16751 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
16752 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
16753 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
16755 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
16757 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
16758 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
16761 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
16762 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
16763 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
16764 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
16765 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
16769 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
16770 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
16771 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
16772 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
16773 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
16774 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
16775 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
16779 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
16780 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
16781 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
16782 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
16783 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
16784 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
16785 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
16786 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
16787 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
16788 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
16791 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
16792 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16795 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
16797 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
16798 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
16799 an item in the list.
16800 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
16803 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
16804 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
16805 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
16806 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
16807 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
16810 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16811 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16812 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16813 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16814 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
16815 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
16816 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
16817 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
16818 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
16819 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
16821 .option set_environment main "string list" empty
16822 .cindex "environment"
16823 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
16824 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use. The
16825 default list is empty,
16828 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
16829 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
16830 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
16831 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
16832 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
16833 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
16834 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
16838 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
16839 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
16840 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
16841 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
16842 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
16843 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
16844 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
16845 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
16846 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
16847 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
16848 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
16852 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
16853 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
16854 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16856 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
16857 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
16858 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
16859 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
16860 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
16861 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16863 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
16864 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
16865 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
16866 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
16869 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
16870 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
16871 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
16872 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
16873 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
16874 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
16875 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
16876 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
16878 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
16879 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
16880 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
16881 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
16882 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
16883 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
16884 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
16885 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
16888 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16889 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
16890 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
16891 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
16895 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16896 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16897 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
16898 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
16899 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
16900 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
16901 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
16902 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
16903 . the option name to split.
16905 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
16906 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16907 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
16908 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
16909 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
16910 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
16911 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
16912 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
16913 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
16917 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
16918 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
16919 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
16920 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
16921 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
16922 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
16923 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
16924 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
16925 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
16926 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
16927 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
16929 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
16930 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
16931 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
16932 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
16933 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
16934 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
16938 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
16939 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16940 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16941 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
16942 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
16943 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
16944 in the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
16945 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
16946 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
16947 to all messages received in the same connection.
16949 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
16950 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
16951 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
16952 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
16955 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16957 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
16958 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
16959 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16960 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
16961 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
16962 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
16963 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
16964 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
16965 number, subsequent messages are placed in the queue, but no delivery processes
16966 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
16967 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
16968 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
16969 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
16972 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
16973 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
16974 .cindex "host" "reserved"
16975 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
16976 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
16977 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
16978 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
16979 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
16980 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
16981 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
16982 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
16985 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
16986 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
16987 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
16988 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
16991 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
16992 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
16993 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
16994 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16995 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
16996 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
16997 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
16998 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
16999 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
17001 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
17002 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
17003 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
17004 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
17006 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
17007 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
17008 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
17009 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
17010 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
17013 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
17014 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
17017 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
17018 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
17019 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
17020 &%helo_data%& value.
17022 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
17023 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
17024 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
17025 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
17026 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
17027 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
17028 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
17030 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
17031 $version_number $tod_full
17033 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
17034 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
17035 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
17036 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
17037 multiline response).
17040 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
17041 .cindex "checking disk space"
17042 .cindex "disk space, checking"
17043 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
17044 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
17045 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
17046 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
17047 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
17048 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
17051 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
17052 .cindex "connection backlog"
17053 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
17054 .cindex "backlog of connections"
17055 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
17056 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
17057 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
17058 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
17059 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
17060 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
17061 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
17062 attacks by SYN flooding.
17065 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
17066 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
17067 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
17068 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
17069 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
17070 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
17071 fewer, but they still exist.
17073 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
17074 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
17075 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
17076 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
17077 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
17078 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
17079 does detect many instances.
17081 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
17082 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
17083 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
17084 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
17088 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
17089 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
17090 .vindex "&$domain$&"
17091 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
17092 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
17093 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
17094 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
17095 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
17098 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
17099 $sender_host_address
17101 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
17102 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
17103 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
17104 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
17105 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
17109 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
17110 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
17111 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
17112 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
17113 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
17116 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
17117 .cindex "load average"
17118 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
17119 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
17120 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
17121 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
17122 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
17123 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
17127 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
17128 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
17129 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
17130 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
17131 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
17133 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
17135 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
17136 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
17137 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
17138 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
17139 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
17141 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
17142 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
17143 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
17144 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
17145 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
17146 not count towards the limit.
17150 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
17151 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
17152 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
17153 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
17154 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
17157 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
17158 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
17162 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17163 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
17164 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
17165 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
17166 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
17167 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
17170 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
17171 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
17172 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
17173 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
17175 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
17176 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
17177 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
17178 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
17182 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
17184 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
17185 fractional parts are allowed here.
17187 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
17189 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
17190 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
17193 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
17194 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
17196 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
17197 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
17199 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
17200 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
17201 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
17202 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
17205 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
17206 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17209 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
17210 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17213 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
17214 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
17215 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
17216 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
17217 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
17218 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
17219 the message is abandoned.
17220 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
17222 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
17223 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
17225 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
17226 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
17228 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
17229 expanded before use and may depend on
17230 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
17234 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
17235 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
17236 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
17237 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
17238 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
17241 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17242 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
17243 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
17246 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
17247 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
17248 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
17249 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
17250 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
17251 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
17252 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
17253 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
17254 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
17255 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
17257 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
17258 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
17262 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17263 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
17264 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
17265 the availability thereof is advertised in
17266 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17267 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
17270 .option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
17271 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
17272 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
17273 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
17277 .option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
17278 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
17279 See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
17283 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
17284 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
17285 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
17286 .cindex "directories, multiple"
17287 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
17288 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
17289 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
17290 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
17291 arrival of the message.
17293 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
17294 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
17295 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
17296 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
17297 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
17299 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
17300 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
17301 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
17302 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
17303 automatically deleted.
17305 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
17306 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
17307 trying to deliver each one, in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
17308 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
17309 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
17310 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
17311 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages in the queue. However,
17312 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
17313 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
17316 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
17317 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
17318 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
17319 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
17320 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
17321 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
17322 &$primary_hostname$&.
17324 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
17325 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
17326 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
17327 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
17328 as failures in the configuration file.
17330 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
17331 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
17333 .option spool_wireformat main boolean false
17334 .cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
17335 If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternative format
17336 for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
17337 Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
17338 Currently it is only done for messages received using the ESMTP CHUNKING
17341 The following variables will not have useful values:
17343 $max_received_linelength
17348 Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
17349 and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
17350 (except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
17351 will need to be aware of the different formats potentially available.
17353 Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
17354 (as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
17355 The transmission benefit is maintained.
17357 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
17358 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
17359 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
17360 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
17362 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
17363 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
17364 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
17365 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
17366 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
17367 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
17369 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
17370 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
17371 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
17372 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
17373 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
17374 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
17375 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
17378 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
17379 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
17380 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
17381 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
17382 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
17383 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
17384 domain causes a syntax error.
17385 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
17389 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
17390 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
17391 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
17392 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
17393 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
17394 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
17395 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
17396 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
17397 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
17398 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
17399 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
17400 the LOG_ALERT priority.
17403 .option syslog_facility main string unset
17404 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
17405 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17406 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
17407 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
17408 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17409 details of Exim's logging.
17412 .option syslog_pid main boolean true
17413 .cindex "syslog" "pid"
17414 If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
17415 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
17416 the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
17417 to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
17418 into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17422 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
17423 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
17424 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17425 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
17426 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17430 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
17431 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
17432 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
17433 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17434 details of Exim's logging.
17437 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
17438 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
17439 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
17440 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
17441 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
17442 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
17443 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
17444 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
17445 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
17446 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
17447 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
17448 A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
17451 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
17452 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
17453 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
17454 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
17455 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
17456 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17459 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
17460 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
17461 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
17462 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
17463 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17465 .option system_filter_group main string unset
17466 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
17467 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
17468 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
17469 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
17471 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
17472 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
17473 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
17474 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
17475 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
17476 contains the pipe command.
17479 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
17480 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
17481 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
17482 is used in a system filter.
17485 .option system_filter_user main string unset
17486 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
17487 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
17488 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
17489 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
17490 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
17491 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
17492 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
17493 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
17494 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
17496 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
17497 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
17498 transport option overrides.
17501 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
17502 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
17503 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
17504 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
17505 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
17506 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
17507 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
17508 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
17509 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
17510 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
17511 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
17512 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
17516 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
17517 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
17518 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
17519 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
17520 message of any kind that has been in the queue for longer than the given time
17521 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
17522 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
17523 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
17524 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
17525 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
17527 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
17528 frozen messages remain in the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
17529 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
17532 .option timezone main string unset
17533 .cindex "timezone, setting"
17534 .cindex "environment" "values from"
17535 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
17536 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
17537 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
17538 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
17542 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
17543 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
17544 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
17545 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
17546 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
17547 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
17550 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17551 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
17552 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
17553 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
17554 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
17555 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
17556 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17557 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
17558 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
17559 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
17560 is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
17563 .option tls_certificate main string list&!! unset
17564 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
17565 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
17566 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17567 files which contains the server's certificates. Commonly only one file is
17569 The server's private key is also
17570 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
17571 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17573 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
17574 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
17575 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
17576 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
17578 &*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
17579 separator in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) to avoid confusion under IPv6.
17581 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
17582 when a list of more than one
17583 file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
17585 &*Note*&: OCSP stapling is not usable under OpenSSL
17586 when a list of more than one file is used.
17588 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
17589 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
17590 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
17591 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
17593 If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
17594 generated for every connection.
17596 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
17597 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
17598 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
17599 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
17600 be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
17602 Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
17604 &*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
17605 for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
17606 For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
17608 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17611 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
17612 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
17613 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
17614 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
17615 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
17616 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
17618 The value must be at least 1024.
17620 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
17621 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
17622 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
17624 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
17627 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
17628 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
17629 larger prime than requested.
17632 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
17633 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
17634 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
17635 to be used by Exim.
17637 &*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend using a filename with site-generated
17638 local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
17639 other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
17640 "unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
17642 If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
17643 then it names a file from which DH
17644 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
17645 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
17646 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
17647 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
17648 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
17649 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
17651 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
17654 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
17655 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
17656 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
17657 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
17659 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
17660 a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
17662 In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
17663 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
17664 in IKE is assigned number 23.
17666 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
17667 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
17668 sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
17669 the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
17670 &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17672 The available standard primes are:
17673 &`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
17674 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
17675 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
17676 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
17678 The available additional primes are:
17679 &`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17681 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
17682 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
17683 The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
17684 of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
17685 (the "ffdhe" identifiers).
17687 At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
17688 they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
17689 candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
17691 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
17692 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
17693 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
17694 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
17695 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
17698 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
17699 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
17700 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
17701 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
17702 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
17703 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
17704 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
17707 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
17708 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
17709 This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
17710 It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
17712 After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
17713 &`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
17714 for valid selections.
17716 For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
17717 &`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
17718 &`auto`& tells the library to choose.
17720 If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
17723 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
17724 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
17725 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
17727 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
17728 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
17729 Certificate Authority.
17731 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
17733 For GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
17734 of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
17735 The ordering of the two lists must match.
17738 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
17741 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
17742 operate the SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
17743 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
17744 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
17748 .option tls_privatekey main string list&!! unset
17749 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
17750 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17751 files which contains the server's private keys.
17752 If this option is unset, or if
17753 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
17754 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
17755 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17757 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17760 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
17761 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
17762 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
17763 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
17764 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
17765 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
17769 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
17770 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
17771 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
17772 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
17773 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
17774 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
17775 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
17776 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
17777 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
17778 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
17779 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
17782 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17783 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17784 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17785 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
17788 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
17789 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17790 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17791 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
17793 or the absolute path to
17794 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
17795 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
17797 The "system" value for the option will use a
17798 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
17799 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
17800 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
17803 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
17804 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
17806 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
17808 either by file or directory
17809 are added to those given by the system default location.
17811 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
17812 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
17813 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
17814 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
17815 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
17816 use the explicit directory version.
17818 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17820 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
17824 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17825 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17826 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17827 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
17828 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
17829 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
17830 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
17831 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
17833 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
17834 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
17835 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
17836 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
17837 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
17838 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
17839 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
17841 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
17842 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
17843 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
17844 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
17845 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
17846 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
17847 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
17850 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
17854 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
17855 .cindex "trusted groups"
17856 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
17857 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17858 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
17859 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
17860 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
17861 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
17862 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
17865 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
17866 .cindex "trusted users"
17867 .cindex "user" "trusted"
17868 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17869 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
17870 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
17871 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
17872 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
17873 Exim user are trusted.
17875 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
17876 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
17877 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
17878 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
17879 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
17880 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
17881 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
17882 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
17883 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
17886 .option unknown_username main string unset
17887 See &%unknown_login%&.
17889 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
17890 .cindex "trusted users"
17891 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
17892 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
17893 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
17894 .cindex "envelope sender"
17895 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
17896 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
17897 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
17898 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
17899 is used) is ignored.
17901 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
17902 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
17904 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
17906 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
17907 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
17908 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
17909 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
17910 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
17911 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
17912 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
17913 followed by a hyphen
17914 by a setting like this:
17916 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
17918 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
17919 restriction, you can use
17921 untrusted_set_sender = *
17923 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
17924 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
17925 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
17926 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
17927 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
17928 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
17929 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
17930 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
17932 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
17933 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
17934 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
17935 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
17939 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
17940 .cindex "&""From""& line"
17941 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
17942 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
17943 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
17944 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
17945 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
17946 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
17947 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
17948 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
17950 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
17951 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
17953 The pattern can be seen by running
17955 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
17957 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
17958 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
17959 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
17960 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
17961 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
17962 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
17965 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
17966 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
17969 .option warn_message_file main string unset
17970 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
17971 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
17972 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
17973 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
17974 been in the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
17975 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
17976 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
17979 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
17980 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
17981 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
17982 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
17983 .ecindex IIDconfima
17984 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
17989 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17990 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17992 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
17993 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
17994 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
17995 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
17996 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
17998 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
17999 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
18000 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
18001 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
18002 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
18006 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
18007 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
18008 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
18009 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
18010 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
18011 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
18012 delivery of the address to be deferred.
18014 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18015 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
18016 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
18017 routers, and the eventual transport.
18019 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
18020 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
18021 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
18022 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
18023 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
18025 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
18026 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
18027 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
18028 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
18029 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
18031 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
18032 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
18033 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
18035 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
18037 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
18039 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
18041 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
18042 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
18044 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
18045 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18046 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
18047 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
18048 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
18049 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
18050 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
18054 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
18056 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
18057 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
18058 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
18059 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
18060 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
18065 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
18066 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
18067 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
18068 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
18069 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
18070 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
18071 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
18072 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
18073 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
18074 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
18077 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
18079 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
18082 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
18084 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
18085 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
18086 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
18087 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
18090 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
18091 .cindex "case of local parts"
18092 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
18093 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
18094 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
18095 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
18096 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
18097 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
18098 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
18101 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18102 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
18103 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
18104 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
18105 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
18106 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
18107 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
18108 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
18109 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
18111 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
18112 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
18113 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
18114 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
18118 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
18119 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
18120 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
18121 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
18123 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
18124 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
18125 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
18126 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
18127 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
18128 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
18129 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
18130 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
18131 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
18132 the router is skipped.
18134 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
18135 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
18136 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
18137 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
18138 setting to achieve this. For example:
18140 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
18142 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
18143 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
18144 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
18148 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
18149 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
18150 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
18151 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
18152 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
18153 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
18154 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
18155 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
18157 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
18158 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
18160 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
18161 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
18163 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
18164 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
18165 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
18167 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18169 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
18171 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
18174 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
18176 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18177 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
18181 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
18182 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
18183 be specified using &%condition%&.
18185 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
18186 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
18187 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
18188 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18189 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18190 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
18191 Router rules processing behavior.
18193 This is best illustrated in an example:
18195 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
18196 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
18198 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18201 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18204 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
18205 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
18206 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
18207 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
18208 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
18209 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
18210 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
18211 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
18213 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
18214 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
18215 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
18216 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
18219 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
18220 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
18221 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
18222 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
18223 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
18226 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
18227 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
18228 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
18229 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
18230 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
18231 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
18232 output, and Exim carries on processing.
18233 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
18234 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
18235 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
18236 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
18237 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
18238 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
18239 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
18243 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
18244 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
18245 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
18246 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
18247 transport option of the same name.
18249 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
18250 .cindex "MX record" "security"
18251 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18252 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18253 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18254 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
18255 the dnssec request bit set.
18256 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18258 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
18259 .cindex "MX record" "security"
18260 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18261 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18262 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18263 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
18264 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
18265 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
18266 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18269 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
18270 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
18271 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
18272 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
18273 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
18274 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
18275 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
18276 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
18280 .option driver routers string unset
18281 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
18285 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
18286 .cindex "DSN" "success"
18287 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
18288 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
18289 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
18290 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
18291 Not effective on redirect routers.
18295 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
18296 .cindex "envelope sender"
18297 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
18298 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
18299 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
18300 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
18301 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
18302 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
18303 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
18305 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
18306 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
18307 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
18310 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
18311 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
18312 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
18313 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
18315 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
18316 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
18317 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
18318 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
18324 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
18325 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
18326 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
18327 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
18328 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
18330 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18331 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
18332 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
18333 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
18334 setting &%return_path%&.
18336 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
18337 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
18338 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
18342 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
18343 .cindex "address" "testing"
18344 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
18345 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
18346 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
18347 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
18348 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
18349 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
18350 on for the system alias file.
18351 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18354 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
18355 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
18356 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
18360 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
18361 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
18362 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
18363 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18367 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
18368 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18369 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
18373 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
18374 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18375 verifying a sender, verification fails.
18379 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
18380 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
18381 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
18382 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
18383 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
18384 changed (see section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&), and a port can be specified with
18385 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
18386 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
18387 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
18389 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
18390 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
18391 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
18392 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
18393 transport for further details.
18396 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
18397 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
18398 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18399 .cindex "transport" "local"
18400 .cindex "router" "setting group"
18401 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18402 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
18404 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18405 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18406 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
18407 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
18408 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18412 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
18413 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
18414 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
18415 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18416 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18417 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18418 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18419 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18420 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
18421 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
18422 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
18423 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
18424 &"see"& the added header lines.
18426 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
18427 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
18428 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
18429 failures are treated as configuration errors.
18431 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
18432 for a router; all listed headers are added.
18434 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18435 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18437 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
18438 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
18439 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18440 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
18441 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
18442 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
18443 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
18444 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
18445 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
18446 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18450 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
18451 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
18452 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
18453 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18454 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18455 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18456 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18457 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18458 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
18459 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
18460 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
18461 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
18462 &"see"& the original header lines.
18464 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
18465 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
18466 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
18469 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
18470 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
18472 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18473 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18475 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18476 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
18477 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
18478 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
18480 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
18481 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
18482 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18486 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
18487 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
18488 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
18489 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
18490 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
18491 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
18492 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
18495 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
18499 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
18501 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
18502 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
18503 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
18504 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
18505 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
18506 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
18508 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
18509 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
18511 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
18512 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
18514 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
18515 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
18517 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
18518 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18519 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
18520 domain that is being routed.
18522 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18523 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
18526 .option initgroups routers boolean false
18527 .cindex "additional groups"
18528 .cindex "groups" "additional"
18529 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18530 .cindex "transport" "local"
18531 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
18532 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
18533 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
18534 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
18535 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18539 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
18540 .cindex affix "router precondition"
18541 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
18542 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
18543 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
18544 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
18545 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
18548 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
18549 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
18550 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
18551 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
18552 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
18553 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
18554 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
18555 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
18556 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
18558 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18559 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
18560 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
18561 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
18562 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
18563 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
18564 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
18565 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
18566 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
18567 the relevant transport.
18569 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
18570 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
18571 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
18574 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
18575 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
18576 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
18577 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
18578 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
18582 local_part_prefix = real-
18584 transport = local_delivery
18586 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18587 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18589 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18590 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18593 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
18594 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
18595 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
18596 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
18599 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
18600 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
18604 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
18605 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
18606 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
18607 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
18608 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
18609 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
18610 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
18611 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
18612 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
18616 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
18617 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
18621 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
18622 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
18623 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
18624 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
18625 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18627 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
18628 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
18631 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
18633 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
18634 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
18635 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
18636 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
18637 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
18638 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
18639 each virtual domain:
18643 local_parts = postmaster
18644 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
18648 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
18649 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
18650 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
18651 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
18652 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
18653 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
18654 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
18655 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
18656 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
18657 redirect addresses.
18661 .option more routers boolean&!! true
18662 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18663 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18664 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18665 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
18666 delivery to be deferred.
18668 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
18669 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
18671 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
18672 means of the setting
18676 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
18677 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
18678 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
18680 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
18681 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
18682 controls what happens next.
18685 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
18686 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
18687 .cindex "router" "timeout"
18688 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
18689 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
18690 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
18691 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
18692 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
18694 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
18695 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
18696 applies to all of them.
18700 .option pass_router routers string unset
18701 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
18702 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
18703 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
18704 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
18705 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
18706 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
18707 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
18708 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
18709 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
18710 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
18714 .option redirect_router routers string unset
18715 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
18716 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
18717 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
18718 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
18719 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
18721 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
18722 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
18723 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
18724 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
18728 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
18729 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
18730 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
18731 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
18732 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
18733 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
18734 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
18736 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
18737 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used
18738 (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18739 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
18740 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
18742 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
18743 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
18744 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
18745 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
18746 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
18749 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
18750 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
18753 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
18754 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
18755 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
18756 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
18757 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
18758 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
18759 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
18760 transport (e.g., &_.procmailrc_&).
18762 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
18763 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
18764 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
18765 operates as follows:
18767 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
18768 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
18769 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
18770 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
18773 require_files = mail:/some/file
18774 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
18776 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
18777 &%require_files%& condition fails.
18779 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
18780 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
18781 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
18782 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
18784 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
18785 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
18786 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
18787 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
18788 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
18790 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
18791 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
18792 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
18793 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
18794 check again in that process.
18796 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
18797 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
18798 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
18799 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
18800 not exist. If the filename (or the exclamation mark that precedes the filename
18801 for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
18802 as if the file did not exist. For example:
18804 require_files = +/some/file
18806 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
18807 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
18808 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
18812 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
18813 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18814 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
18815 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
18816 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
18817 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
18818 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
18819 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
18822 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
18823 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
18824 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
18825 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
18826 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
18829 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
18830 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
18831 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
18835 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
18836 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
18837 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
18839 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
18840 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
18841 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
18842 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
18843 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
18844 cause the router to defer.
18846 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
18847 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
18849 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18851 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
18852 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
18854 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
18855 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
18856 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
18857 of these values that is set:
18860 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18862 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18864 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18866 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18869 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
18870 router, but not for the transport.
18874 .option self routers string freeze
18875 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18876 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18877 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
18878 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
18879 and &(manualroute)& routers.
18880 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
18882 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
18883 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
18884 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
18885 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
18886 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18888 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
18889 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
18890 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
18891 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
18892 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
18897 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
18899 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
18900 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
18901 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
18902 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
18904 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
18905 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
18906 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
18911 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
18912 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
18913 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
18914 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
18915 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
18916 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
18922 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
18923 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
18924 be passed to the next router.
18927 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
18930 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
18931 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
18932 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
18933 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
18934 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
18935 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
18940 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
18941 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
18942 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
18943 address matches something on the list.
18944 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18947 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
18948 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
18949 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
18950 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
18951 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
18952 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
18953 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
18957 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
18958 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
18959 .cindex "packet radio"
18960 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
18961 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
18962 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
18963 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
18964 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
18965 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
18966 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
18967 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
18969 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18970 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
18971 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
18972 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
18973 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
18974 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
18975 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
18976 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
18977 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
18978 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
18980 translate_ip_address = \
18981 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
18984 The file would contain lines like
18986 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
18987 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
18989 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
18994 .option transport routers string&!! unset
18995 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
18996 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
18997 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
18998 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
18999 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
19000 delivery is deferred.
19002 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
19003 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
19004 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
19008 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
19009 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
19010 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
19011 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
19012 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
19013 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
19014 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
19015 overridden by a setting on the transport.
19016 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19017 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19018 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
19024 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
19025 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19026 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
19027 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
19028 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
19029 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
19030 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
19031 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
19032 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19033 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19035 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
19036 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
19037 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
19038 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
19039 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
19041 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
19047 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
19048 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
19049 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
19050 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
19051 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
19052 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
19053 delivery to be deferred.
19055 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
19056 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
19057 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
19058 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
19059 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
19060 sometimes true and sometimes false).
19062 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
19063 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
19064 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
19065 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
19066 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
19067 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
19068 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
19069 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
19071 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
19072 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
19073 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
19074 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
19075 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
19076 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
19077 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
19078 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
19079 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
19080 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
19082 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
19083 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
19084 subsequent routers.
19087 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
19088 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19089 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19090 .cindex "transport" "local"
19091 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
19092 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
19093 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
19094 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
19095 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
19096 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
19097 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
19098 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
19099 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
19100 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
19101 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
19102 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19106 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
19107 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
19108 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
19111 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
19112 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
19114 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
19115 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
19116 delivering in cutthrough mode or
19117 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
19118 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
19119 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
19120 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
19122 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
19123 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
19124 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
19128 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
19129 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
19131 delivering in cutthrough mode
19132 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
19133 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19135 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19138 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
19139 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
19140 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
19141 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19143 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19144 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
19145 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
19152 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19153 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19155 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
19156 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
19157 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
19158 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
19159 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
19160 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
19161 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
19162 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
19163 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
19167 domains = mydomain.example
19169 transport = local_delivery
19171 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
19172 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
19173 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
19174 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
19181 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19182 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19184 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
19185 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
19186 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
19187 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
19188 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
19189 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
19191 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
19192 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
19193 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
19194 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
19197 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
19198 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
19199 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
19200 except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
19201 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
19202 generic option, the router declines.
19204 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
19205 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
19206 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
19208 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19209 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19210 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
19211 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
19212 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
19213 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
19216 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
19217 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
19218 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
19219 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
19220 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
19221 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
19223 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
19224 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
19225 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
19226 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
19227 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
19228 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
19229 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
19230 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
19231 case routing fails.
19234 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
19235 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
19236 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
19237 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
19238 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
19240 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
19241 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
19243 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
19245 The domain does not exist in DNS
19247 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
19248 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
19249 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
19251 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
19253 MX record points to a non-existent host.
19255 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
19256 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
19258 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
19259 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
19261 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
19262 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
19264 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
19265 not be found in the MX records (see below)
19271 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
19272 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
19273 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
19275 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
19276 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
19277 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
19278 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
19279 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
19280 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
19281 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19284 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
19285 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
19286 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
19287 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
19288 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
19289 required. For example,
19293 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
19294 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
19295 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
19296 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
19297 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
19300 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
19301 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
19302 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
19303 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
19304 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
19305 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
19307 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
19308 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
19309 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
19310 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
19311 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
19312 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
19313 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
19314 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
19316 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
19317 when there is a DNS lookup error.
19322 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19323 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
19324 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
19325 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
19326 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
19327 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
19328 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
19329 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
19333 .option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
19334 .cindex IPv6 disabling
19335 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
19336 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19337 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19338 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19339 only A records are used.
19341 .option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
19342 .cindex IPv4 preference
19343 .cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
19344 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19345 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19346 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19347 A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
19349 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19350 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
19351 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
19352 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
19353 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
19354 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
19355 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
19358 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
19360 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
19361 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
19362 the address record.
19365 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19366 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19367 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
19368 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19373 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
19374 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19375 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
19376 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
19377 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
19378 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
19379 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
19380 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
19381 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
19386 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
19387 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
19388 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
19389 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
19390 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
19391 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
19392 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
19393 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
19394 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
19395 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
19396 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
19398 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
19399 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
19402 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
19403 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
19404 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
19405 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
19406 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
19410 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
19411 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19412 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
19413 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
19414 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19415 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19416 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19417 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19419 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19420 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
19421 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19422 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
19423 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
19424 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
19425 without processing them independently,
19426 provided the following conditions are met:
19429 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
19430 &%headers_remove%&.
19432 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
19439 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
19440 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19441 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
19442 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
19443 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
19444 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
19445 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
19446 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
19447 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
19448 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
19450 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
19451 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
19456 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19457 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19458 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
19459 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19464 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
19465 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
19466 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
19467 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
19470 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
19472 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
19473 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
19474 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
19475 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
19476 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
19477 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
19480 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
19481 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
19482 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
19483 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
19484 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
19486 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
19487 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
19488 such as that implied by
19492 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
19493 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
19494 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
19495 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
19505 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19506 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19508 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
19509 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
19510 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
19511 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
19512 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
19513 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
19514 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
19515 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
19516 router handles the address
19520 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
19521 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
19522 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
19524 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
19526 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
19527 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
19529 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
19530 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
19531 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
19532 &%self%& option determines what happens.
19534 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
19535 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
19536 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
19537 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
19541 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19542 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19544 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
19545 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
19546 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
19547 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
19548 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
19549 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
19552 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
19554 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
19556 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
19557 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
19558 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
19559 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
19560 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
19561 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
19562 must not be specified for it.
19564 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
19565 .option hosts iplookup string unset
19566 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
19567 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
19568 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
19569 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
19570 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
19573 .option optional iplookup boolean false
19574 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
19575 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
19576 delivery to the address is deferred.
19579 .option port iplookup integer 0
19580 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
19581 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
19585 .option protocol iplookup string udp
19586 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
19587 protocols is to be used.
19590 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
19591 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
19594 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
19596 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
19597 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
19600 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
19601 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
19602 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
19603 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
19604 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
19605 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
19606 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
19607 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
19610 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
19611 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
19612 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
19613 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
19614 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
19615 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
19616 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
19617 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
19618 following could be used:
19620 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
19621 reroute = $local_part@$1
19624 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
19625 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
19626 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
19627 call. It does not apply to UDP.
19632 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19633 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19635 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
19636 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
19637 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
19638 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
19639 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
19640 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
19641 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
19642 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
19643 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
19644 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
19646 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
19647 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
19648 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
19649 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
19650 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
19651 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
19652 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
19655 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
19656 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
19657 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
19658 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
19659 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
19660 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
19661 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
19664 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
19665 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
19666 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
19667 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
19668 below, following the list of private options.
19671 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
19673 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
19674 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
19676 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
19677 See &%host_find_failed%&.
19679 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
19680 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
19681 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
19682 of the following values:
19691 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
19692 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
19693 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
19696 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
19697 router only if &%more%& is true.
19699 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
19700 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
19701 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
19702 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
19704 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
19705 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
19706 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
19709 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
19710 .cindex "randomized host list"
19711 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
19712 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
19713 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
19714 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
19715 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
19716 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
19717 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
19718 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
19720 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
19721 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
19722 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
19723 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
19725 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
19727 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
19728 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
19729 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
19730 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
19731 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
19734 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
19735 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
19736 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
19739 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
19741 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
19742 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
19746 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
19747 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
19748 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
19749 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
19752 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
19753 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19754 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
19755 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
19756 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19757 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19758 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19759 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19761 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19762 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
19763 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19764 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
19765 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
19766 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
19767 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
19768 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
19773 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
19774 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
19775 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
19776 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
19777 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19778 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
19780 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
19782 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
19786 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
19787 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19789 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
19790 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
19791 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
19792 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
19793 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
19794 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
19795 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
19796 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
19797 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
19798 in a &%route_list%&).
19800 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
19801 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
19802 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
19803 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
19807 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
19808 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
19809 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
19810 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
19811 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
19812 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
19813 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
19816 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
19817 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19819 This data can be accessed by setting
19821 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
19823 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
19824 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
19825 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
19826 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
19827 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
19832 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
19833 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
19834 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
19835 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
19836 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports.
19837 If the list is written with spaces, it must be protected with quotes.
19838 The format of each item
19839 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
19840 as described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&.
19842 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
19843 variables are set during its expansion:
19846 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19847 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
19848 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
19850 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
19853 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
19855 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
19858 .vindex "&$value$&"
19859 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
19860 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
19862 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
19866 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
19867 semicolon is the default route list separator.
19871 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
19872 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
19873 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
19874 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
19875 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
19876 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
19879 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
19880 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
19881 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
19883 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
19884 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
19887 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
19888 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
19889 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
19890 number follows. For example:
19892 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
19896 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
19897 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
19898 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
19899 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
19900 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
19903 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
19904 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
19905 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
19906 records in the DNS. For example:
19908 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
19910 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
19913 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
19915 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
19916 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
19917 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
19918 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
19919 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
19920 happens is controlled by the
19921 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19922 &%self%& option of the router.
19924 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
19925 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
19926 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
19927 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
19928 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
19929 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
19930 defined by MX preferences.
19932 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
19933 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
19934 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
19936 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
19937 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
19938 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
19939 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
19941 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
19942 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
19945 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
19946 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
19947 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
19949 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
19950 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
19954 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
19955 The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
19956 One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
19957 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
19958 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
19959 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
19960 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
19963 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
19964 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19966 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
19967 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19969 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
19970 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
19971 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
19973 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
19974 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
19975 timeout), delivery is deferred.
19977 &%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
19979 &%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
19984 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
19985 domain2 host4:host5
19987 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
19988 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
19989 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
19990 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
19993 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
19994 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
19995 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
19996 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
19999 &*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
20000 inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
20005 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
20006 &%host_find_failed%& option.
20009 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
20010 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
20014 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
20015 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
20016 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
20019 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
20020 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
20021 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
20022 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
20024 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
20026 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
20027 your first router something like this:
20030 driver = manualroute
20031 domains = !+local_domains
20032 transport = remote_smtp
20033 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
20035 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
20036 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
20037 they are tried in order
20038 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
20039 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
20042 driver = manualroute
20043 transport = remote_smtp
20044 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
20046 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
20047 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
20048 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
20049 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
20050 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
20051 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
20052 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
20053 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
20056 .cindex "mail hub example"
20057 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
20058 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
20059 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
20060 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
20061 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
20062 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
20063 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
20064 lookup is easier to manage.
20066 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
20067 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
20071 driver = manualroute
20072 transport = remote_smtp
20073 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
20075 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
20076 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
20077 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
20078 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
20079 domain can be used to find the host:
20082 driver = manualroute
20083 transport = remote_smtp
20084 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
20086 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
20087 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
20088 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
20092 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
20093 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
20094 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
20095 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
20096 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
20097 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
20100 driver = manualroute
20101 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
20102 route_list = saved.domain.example
20104 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
20105 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
20106 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
20109 driver = manualroute
20111 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
20112 *.saved.domain2.example \
20113 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
20116 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20118 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
20119 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
20120 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
20121 the address if the lookup fails.
20124 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
20125 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
20126 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
20127 one way it can be done:
20133 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
20134 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
20135 return_fail_output = true
20140 driver = manualroute
20142 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
20144 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
20146 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
20148 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
20149 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
20150 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
20152 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
20153 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
20162 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20163 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20165 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
20166 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
20167 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
20168 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
20169 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
20170 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
20171 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
20172 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
20173 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
20174 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
20176 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
20178 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
20179 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
20180 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
20181 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
20182 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
20185 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
20186 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
20187 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
20188 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
20189 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
20190 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
20193 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
20194 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
20195 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
20196 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
20197 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
20198 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
20199 not set, a value for the gid also.
20201 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
20202 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
20203 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
20204 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
20205 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
20206 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
20210 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
20211 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
20212 before running the command.
20215 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
20216 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
20217 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
20221 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
20222 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
20223 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
20224 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
20225 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
20228 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
20231 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
20232 &%no_more%& is set.
20234 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
20235 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
20236 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
20237 included in the SMTP response.
20239 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
20240 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
20241 included in any SMTP response.
20243 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
20245 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
20246 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
20248 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
20249 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
20250 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
20253 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
20254 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
20257 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
20258 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
20260 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
20261 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
20262 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
20263 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
20265 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
20266 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
20267 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
20268 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
20269 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
20271 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
20272 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
20273 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
20274 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
20275 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
20277 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
20278 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
20279 variable. For example, this return line
20281 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
20283 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
20284 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
20285 .ecindex IIDquerou1
20286 .ecindex IIDquerou2
20291 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20292 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20294 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
20295 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
20296 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
20297 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
20298 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
20299 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
20300 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
20301 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
20302 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
20303 redirected in several different ways:
20306 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
20309 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
20311 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
20313 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
20315 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
20317 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
20319 It can be discarded.
20322 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
20323 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
20324 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
20325 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
20327 If success DSNs have been requested
20328 .cindex "DSN" "success"
20329 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
20330 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
20334 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
20335 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
20336 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
20337 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
20338 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
20339 aliases, in a configuration like this:
20343 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
20345 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
20346 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
20347 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
20348 cause delivery to be deferred.
20350 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
20351 &_.forward_& files, like this:
20356 file = $home/.forward
20359 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
20360 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
20361 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
20362 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
20367 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
20368 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
20369 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
20370 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
20373 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
20374 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
20375 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
20376 practice the router may not be able to operate.
20378 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
20379 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
20380 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
20381 saves some resources.
20389 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
20390 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20391 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20392 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
20393 can be interpreted in two different ways:
20396 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
20397 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
20398 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
20399 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
20400 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
20401 document is intended for use by end users.
20403 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
20404 described in the next section.
20407 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the filename given
20408 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
20409 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
20410 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
20411 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
20415 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
20416 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
20417 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
20418 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
20419 addresses, filenames, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
20420 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
20421 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
20422 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
20423 commas or newlines.
20424 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
20427 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
20428 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
20429 next newline character is ignored.
20431 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
20432 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
20433 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
20434 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
20437 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20438 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
20439 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
20440 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
20441 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
20442 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
20445 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
20449 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
20450 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
20451 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
20452 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
20453 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
20454 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
20455 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
20456 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
20457 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
20458 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
20459 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
20461 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
20462 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
20463 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
20464 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
20465 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
20467 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
20469 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
20470 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
20471 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
20472 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
20473 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
20476 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
20477 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
20478 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
20479 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
20480 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
20482 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
20483 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
20488 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
20489 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
20492 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20494 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
20495 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
20496 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
20497 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
20498 should really contain
20500 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20502 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
20503 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
20504 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
20508 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
20509 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
20510 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
20513 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
20514 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
20515 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
20516 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
20517 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
20518 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20519 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20521 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
20522 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
20523 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
20524 in double quotes, for example:
20526 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
20528 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
20529 quote just the command. An item such as
20531 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
20533 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
20535 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
20536 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
20537 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
20538 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
20539 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
20540 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
20541 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
20542 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
20543 an &%accept%& router.
20546 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
20547 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
20548 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
20549 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
20551 /home/world/minbari
20553 is treated as a filename, but
20555 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
20557 is treated as an address. For a filename, a transport must be specified using
20558 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
20559 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
20560 filename, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
20562 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20563 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20565 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
20566 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
20567 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
20568 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
20571 .cindex "included address list"
20572 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
20573 If an item is of the form
20575 :include:<path name>
20577 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
20578 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
20579 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
20580 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
20581 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
20582 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
20584 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
20586 It must be given as
20588 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
20591 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
20592 .cindex "delivery" "discard"
20593 .cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
20594 .cindex "black hole"
20595 .cindex "abandoning mail"
20596 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
20597 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
20598 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
20602 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
20603 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
20604 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
20606 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
20607 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
20608 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
20609 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
20613 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
20614 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
20615 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
20616 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
20617 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
20618 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
20619 redirection items of the form
20624 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
20625 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
20626 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
20627 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
20629 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
20631 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
20633 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
20634 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
20636 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
20637 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
20638 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
20640 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20641 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
20642 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
20643 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
20644 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
20645 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
20646 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
20647 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
20648 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
20651 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
20652 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
20653 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
20654 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
20656 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
20657 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
20658 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
20659 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
20660 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
20662 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
20663 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
20664 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain in the queue so that a
20665 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
20666 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
20670 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
20671 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
20672 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
20673 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
20674 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
20675 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
20676 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
20680 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
20681 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
20682 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
20683 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
20684 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
20685 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
20686 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
20687 aliasing scheme of the type
20689 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
20693 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
20694 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
20695 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
20698 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
20699 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
20701 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
20702 the pipes are distinct.
20706 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
20707 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
20708 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
20709 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
20710 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
20711 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
20712 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
20713 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
20714 can be used to avoid this.
20717 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
20718 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
20719 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
20720 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
20721 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
20722 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
20723 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
20727 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
20729 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
20730 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
20733 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
20734 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
20735 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
20738 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
20739 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
20740 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
20741 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
20744 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
20745 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
20746 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
20747 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
20748 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
20749 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
20750 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
20752 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
20753 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
20756 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
20757 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
20758 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
20759 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
20760 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
20764 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
20765 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
20766 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
20767 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
20768 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
20769 let ordinary users do.
20773 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
20774 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
20775 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
20776 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
20777 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
20778 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
20780 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
20781 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
20782 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
20783 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
20784 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
20785 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
20787 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
20789 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
20790 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
20791 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
20792 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
20793 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
20794 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
20795 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
20796 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
20799 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
20800 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
20801 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
20802 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
20803 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
20804 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
20805 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
20806 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
20810 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
20811 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
20812 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
20813 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
20814 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
20815 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
20818 .option data redirect string&!! unset
20819 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
20820 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
20821 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
20822 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
20823 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
20825 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
20826 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
20827 terminated with newline characters. For example:
20829 data = #Exim filter\n\
20830 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
20832 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
20833 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
20834 choice into a newline.
20837 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
20838 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
20839 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20840 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20841 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
20844 .option file redirect string&!! unset
20845 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
20846 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
20847 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
20848 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
20849 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
20850 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
20851 entirely of comments), the router declines.
20853 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
20854 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
20855 runs a check on the containing directory,
20856 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
20857 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
20858 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
20859 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
20860 not, the router declines.
20863 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
20864 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
20865 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
20866 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20867 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20868 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
20869 it is running, the filename is in &$address_file$&.
20872 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
20873 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
20874 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
20875 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
20876 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
20879 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
20880 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20881 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20882 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
20886 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
20887 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20888 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20889 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
20890 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20895 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
20896 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20897 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
20898 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20899 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
20900 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
20901 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
20902 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
20903 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
20904 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
20905 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
20908 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
20909 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20910 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20911 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20912 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
20915 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
20916 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20917 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20918 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
20919 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20920 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
20922 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
20923 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20924 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20925 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
20926 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
20927 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
20928 &_.forward_& files).
20931 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
20932 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20933 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20934 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20935 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
20938 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
20939 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20940 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20941 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
20942 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
20943 of the embedded Perl support.
20946 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
20947 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20948 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20949 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20950 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
20953 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
20954 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20955 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20956 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20957 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
20960 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
20961 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20962 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20963 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
20964 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
20965 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
20966 &%one_time%& is set.
20969 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
20970 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20971 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20972 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20973 to make use of &%run%& items.
20976 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
20977 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20978 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20979 If this option is true, items of the form
20981 :include:<path name>
20983 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
20986 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
20987 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20988 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20989 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
20990 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
20991 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
20992 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
20995 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
20996 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20997 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20998 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
20999 &%allow_filter%& is true.
21002 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
21003 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
21004 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
21005 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
21006 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
21011 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
21012 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
21013 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
21014 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
21015 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
21016 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
21017 bounce may well quote the generated address.
21020 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
21022 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21023 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
21024 file did not exist.
21027 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
21029 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21030 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
21031 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
21033 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
21034 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
21035 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
21036 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
21037 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
21038 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
21039 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
21040 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
21044 .option include_directory redirect string unset
21045 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
21046 redirection list must start with this directory.
21049 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
21050 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
21051 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
21054 .option one_time redirect boolean false
21055 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
21056 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
21057 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
21058 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
21059 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
21060 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
21061 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
21062 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
21063 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
21064 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
21065 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
21066 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
21067 before they subscribed.
21069 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
21070 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
21071 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
21072 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
21075 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
21076 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
21077 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
21078 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
21080 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
21081 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
21082 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
21084 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
21087 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
21088 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
21089 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
21090 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
21091 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
21095 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
21096 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
21097 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
21098 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
21099 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
21100 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
21101 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
21102 See &%check_owner%& above.
21105 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
21106 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
21107 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
21108 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
21111 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
21112 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
21113 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
21114 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
21115 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
21116 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
21117 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
21120 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
21121 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
21122 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
21123 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
21124 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
21125 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
21126 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
21127 &$qualify_recipient$&.
21129 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
21130 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
21131 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
21134 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
21135 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
21136 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
21137 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
21138 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
21139 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
21140 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
21141 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
21142 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
21143 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
21146 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
21147 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
21148 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
21149 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
21150 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
21151 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
21154 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
21155 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
21156 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
21157 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
21158 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
21159 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
21162 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
21163 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
21164 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
21165 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
21166 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
21169 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
21170 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
21171 :subaddress part of an address.
21173 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
21174 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
21175 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
21176 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
21179 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
21180 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
21181 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
21182 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
21183 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
21184 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
21185 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
21189 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
21190 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
21191 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
21192 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
21193 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
21194 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
21195 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
21196 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
21197 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
21198 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
21199 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
21200 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
21201 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
21202 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
21203 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
21204 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
21206 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
21207 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
21208 the following routers.
21210 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
21211 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
21212 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
21213 so it is passed to the following routers.
21215 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
21216 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
21217 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
21218 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
21220 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
21221 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
21222 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
21223 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
21229 file = $home/.forward
21230 file_transport = address_file
21231 pipe_transport = address_pipe
21232 reply_transport = address_reply
21235 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
21236 syntax_errors_text = \
21237 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
21238 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
21239 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
21240 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
21241 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
21242 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
21243 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
21244 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
21245 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
21246 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
21248 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
21249 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
21250 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
21255 local_part_prefix = real-
21256 transport = local_delivery
21258 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
21259 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
21261 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
21262 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
21266 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
21267 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21270 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
21271 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21272 .ecindex IIDredrou1
21273 .ecindex IIDredrou2
21280 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21281 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21283 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
21284 "Environment for local transports"
21285 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
21286 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
21287 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
21288 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
21289 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
21290 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
21291 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
21293 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
21294 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
21295 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
21296 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
21298 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
21299 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
21300 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
21301 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
21302 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
21306 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
21307 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
21308 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
21309 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
21310 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
21311 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
21312 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
21315 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
21316 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
21320 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
21322 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
21323 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
21324 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
21325 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
21330 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
21331 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
21332 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
21333 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
21334 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
21335 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
21336 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
21337 group (set by the transport). For example:
21340 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
21344 transport = group_delivery
21347 # This transport overrides the group
21349 driver = appendfile
21350 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21353 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
21354 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
21355 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
21358 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
21359 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
21360 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
21361 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
21362 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
21363 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
21365 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
21366 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
21367 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
21368 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
21369 original gid is also used.
21371 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
21372 following that is set is used:
21375 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
21377 A &%group%& setting of the router;
21379 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
21380 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
21382 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
21384 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
21385 the uid is the creator's uid;
21387 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
21390 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
21391 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
21392 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
21393 The first of the following that is set is used:
21396 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
21398 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
21400 A &%user%& setting of the router;
21402 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
21407 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
21408 &%never_users%& list.
21414 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
21415 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
21416 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
21417 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
21418 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
21419 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
21420 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
21421 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
21422 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
21423 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21426 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
21428 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
21430 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
21432 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
21435 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21438 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
21440 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
21444 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
21445 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
21446 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
21450 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
21451 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21452 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21453 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
21454 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
21455 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
21456 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
21457 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
21458 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
21459 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
21460 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
21461 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
21462 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
21463 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
21471 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21472 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21474 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
21475 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
21476 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
21477 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
21478 The following generic options apply to all transports:
21481 .option body_only transports boolean false
21482 .cindex "transport" "body only"
21483 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
21484 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
21485 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
21486 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
21487 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
21488 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
21489 automatically suppress them.
21492 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
21493 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
21494 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
21495 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
21496 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
21497 logged, and delivery is deferred.
21500 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
21501 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
21502 deliveries by the transport or for any
21503 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
21504 what you are doing.
21507 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
21508 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
21509 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
21510 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
21512 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
21513 output, and Exim carries on processing.
21514 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
21515 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
21516 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
21517 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
21519 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
21520 transport and the router that called it.
21522 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
21523 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
21524 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
21525 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
21526 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
21527 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
21528 safely be resent to other recipients.
21531 .option driver transports string unset
21532 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
21533 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
21536 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
21537 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21538 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
21539 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
21540 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
21541 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
21542 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
21543 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
21544 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
21545 resent to other recipients.
21548 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
21550 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
21551 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
21554 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
21555 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
21556 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
21557 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
21558 &%user%& (see below).
21561 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
21562 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
21563 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
21564 This option specifies a list of text headers,
21565 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
21566 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
21567 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
21568 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
21569 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21570 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21571 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21573 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
21574 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
21577 .option headers_only transports boolean false
21578 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
21579 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
21580 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
21581 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
21582 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
21583 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
21584 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
21587 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
21588 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
21589 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
21590 This option specifies a list of header names,
21591 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
21592 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
21593 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
21595 Each list item is separately expanded.
21596 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21597 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21598 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21600 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
21601 for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
21603 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
21604 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
21605 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
21609 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
21610 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
21611 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
21612 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
21613 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
21614 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
21615 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
21616 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
21619 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
21622 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
21623 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
21624 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
21625 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
21626 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
21627 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
21628 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
21629 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
21630 change envelope recipients at this time.
21633 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
21634 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
21636 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
21637 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
21638 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
21639 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
21640 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
21641 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
21642 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
21646 .option initgroups transports boolean false
21647 .cindex "additional groups"
21648 .cindex "groups" "additional"
21649 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
21650 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
21651 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
21652 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
21655 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
21656 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
21657 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
21658 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
21659 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
21660 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
21661 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
21662 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
21664 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
21665 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
21666 incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
21667 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
21668 Obviously there is scope for
21669 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21670 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21672 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
21673 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21674 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21675 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21676 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
21679 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
21680 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
21681 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
21682 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
21683 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
21684 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
21685 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
21686 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
21687 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
21688 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
21689 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
21690 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
21691 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
21696 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
21697 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
21698 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
21699 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
21700 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
21701 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
21702 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
21703 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
21706 local_part_prefix = *-
21708 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
21711 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
21713 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
21714 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
21715 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
21716 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
21717 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
21720 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
21721 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
21722 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
21723 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
21724 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
21725 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
21726 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
21727 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
21728 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
21730 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
21731 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
21732 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
21733 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
21735 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
21736 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
21737 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
21740 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
21741 .cindex "envelope sender"
21742 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
21743 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
21744 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
21745 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
21746 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
21747 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
21748 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
21749 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
21750 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
21752 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
21753 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
21755 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
21756 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
21757 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
21758 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
21759 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
21760 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
21761 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
21763 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
21764 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
21765 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
21766 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
21767 &%errors_to%& in a router.
21771 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
21772 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
21773 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
21774 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
21775 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
21776 have easy access to it.
21778 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
21779 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
21780 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
21781 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
21782 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
21786 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
21787 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
21790 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
21791 .cindex "shadow transport"
21792 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
21793 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
21794 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
21796 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
21797 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
21798 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
21799 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
21800 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
21801 cause a log line to be written.
21803 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
21804 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
21805 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
21806 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
21807 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
21810 ST=<shadow transport name>
21812 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
21813 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
21814 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
21815 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
21816 headers that some sites insist on.
21819 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
21820 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21821 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21822 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
21823 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
21824 individual users or via a system filter.
21825 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
21827 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
21828 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
21829 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
21830 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
21831 command must be specified as an absolute path.
21833 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
21834 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
21835 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
21836 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
21837 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
21838 &(pipe)& transports.
21840 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
21841 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
21842 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
21843 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
21844 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
21846 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
21847 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
21848 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
21849 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
21851 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
21852 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
21853 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
21854 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
21855 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
21856 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
21858 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
21859 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
21860 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
21861 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
21862 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
21863 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
21864 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
21865 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
21867 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21868 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
21869 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
21870 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
21871 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
21872 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
21873 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
21874 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
21875 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
21876 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
21879 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21880 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
21881 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
21882 which the message is being sent. For example:
21884 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
21885 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
21888 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
21889 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
21890 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
21892 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
21893 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
21894 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
21897 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
21899 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
21900 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
21901 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
21902 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
21903 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
21904 Exim tried to expand the first one.
21906 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
21907 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
21908 arguments. Consider this example:
21910 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21911 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21913 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
21914 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
21916 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21917 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21921 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
21922 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
21923 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
21924 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
21925 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
21926 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
21927 bounced from a transport filter.
21929 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
21930 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
21931 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
21934 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
21935 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
21936 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
21937 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
21938 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
21939 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
21940 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
21941 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
21942 becomes a temporary error.
21945 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
21946 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21947 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
21948 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
21949 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
21950 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
21951 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
21954 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
21955 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
21956 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
21958 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
21959 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
21960 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
21961 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
21963 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
21964 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
21965 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
21972 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21973 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21975 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
21977 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
21978 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
21979 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
21980 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
21981 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
21982 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
21983 copy of the message is delivered each time.
21985 .cindex "batched local delivery"
21986 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
21987 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
21988 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
21989 local transport, for example:
21992 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
21993 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
21994 recipients saves space.
21996 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
21997 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
21999 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
22000 to a scanner program or
22001 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
22005 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
22006 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
22007 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
22009 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
22010 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
22011 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
22012 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
22013 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
22014 to certain conditions:
22017 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22018 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
22019 batching is possible.
22021 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22022 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
22023 addresses with the same domain are batched.
22025 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
22026 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
22027 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
22028 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
22029 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
22032 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
22033 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
22034 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
22038 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
22039 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
22040 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
22041 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
22042 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
22043 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
22044 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
22047 escape_string = ".."
22049 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
22050 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
22051 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
22053 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
22054 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
22055 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
22056 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
22057 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
22058 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
22060 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
22061 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22062 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
22063 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
22064 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
22065 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
22066 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
22067 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
22068 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
22073 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22074 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22076 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
22077 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
22078 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
22079 .cindex "directory creation"
22080 .cindex "creating directories"
22081 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
22082 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
22083 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
22084 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
22085 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
22086 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
22087 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
22088 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
22089 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
22090 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
22092 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
22093 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
22094 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
22097 .cindex "quota" "system"
22098 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
22099 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
22100 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
22102 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
22103 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
22104 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
22105 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
22107 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
22108 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
22111 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
22112 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
22113 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
22114 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
22119 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
22120 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
22121 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
22122 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
22123 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
22125 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
22126 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22127 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
22128 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
22129 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
22130 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
22131 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
22132 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
22133 operation. There are two cases:
22136 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
22137 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
22138 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
22139 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
22140 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
22141 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
22142 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
22144 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
22145 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
22146 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
22150 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
22151 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
22152 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
22153 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
22158 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
22160 require "fileinto";
22161 fileinto "folder23";
22163 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
22164 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute filename. In the
22165 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
22166 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
22167 way of handling this requirement:
22169 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
22170 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
22171 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
22173 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
22177 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
22178 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
22179 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
22181 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
22182 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
22183 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
22184 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
22185 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
22186 path to the transport.
22188 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
22189 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
22194 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
22195 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
22199 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
22200 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
22201 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
22202 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
22203 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
22204 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
22205 delivery is deferred.
22208 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
22209 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22210 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22211 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
22212 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
22213 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
22214 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
22215 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
22218 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
22219 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22220 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
22221 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
22225 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
22226 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22229 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
22230 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
22231 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
22232 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
22233 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
22236 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
22237 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
22238 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
22239 process is running.
22242 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
22243 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22244 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
22245 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
22246 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
22247 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
22248 contains is significant.
22250 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
22251 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
22252 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
22253 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
22254 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
22256 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
22257 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
22258 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
22259 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
22260 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
22261 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
22263 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22264 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
22265 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22266 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22268 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
22269 .cindex "directory creation"
22270 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
22271 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
22272 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
22274 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
22275 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
22276 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
22277 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
22278 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
22282 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
22283 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
22284 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
22285 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
22286 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
22289 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
22290 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
22291 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit filename is
22292 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when filenames
22293 are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
22294 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
22295 &%file_must_exist%&.
22298 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
22299 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
22300 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
22301 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
22303 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
22304 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
22305 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
22306 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
22307 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
22310 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
22312 .vindex "&$inode$&"
22313 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
22314 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
22315 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
22317 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
22319 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
22320 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
22324 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
22325 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
22326 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
22329 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
22330 See &%check_string%& above.
22333 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
22334 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
22335 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
22336 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
22337 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
22338 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
22341 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22342 .cindex "locking files"
22343 .cindex "lock files"
22344 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
22345 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
22347 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
22348 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
22351 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
22352 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
22355 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
22356 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
22357 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
22358 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
22359 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
22360 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
22364 .option file_format appendfile string unset
22365 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
22366 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
22367 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
22368 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
22369 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
22370 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
22371 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
22372 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
22375 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
22376 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
22378 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
22379 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
22380 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
22381 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
22382 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
22383 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
22384 delivery is deferred.
22387 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
22388 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
22389 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
22390 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
22393 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
22394 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22395 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
22396 .cindex "locking files"
22397 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
22398 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
22399 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
22400 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
22401 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
22402 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
22403 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
22404 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
22406 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
22407 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
22408 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
22409 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
22411 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
22412 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
22415 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
22417 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
22418 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
22419 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
22421 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
22422 local deliveries because of errors of the form
22424 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
22427 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
22428 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
22429 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
22430 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
22433 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
22434 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
22435 for details of locking.
22438 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
22439 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
22440 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
22443 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22444 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
22445 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
22448 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
22449 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22450 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
22451 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
22452 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
22455 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
22456 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22457 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22458 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22459 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
22460 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
22461 external source that maintains the data.
22464 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
22465 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22466 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22467 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22468 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
22469 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
22470 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
22471 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
22475 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
22476 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
22477 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
22478 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
22479 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
22480 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
22481 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
22482 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
22483 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
22484 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22487 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
22488 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
22489 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
22490 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
22491 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
22492 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
22493 calculation. The default value is:
22495 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
22497 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
22498 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
22500 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
22502 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
22504 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
22505 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
22506 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
22507 directly into that directory.
22510 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
22511 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
22512 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22515 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
22516 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
22517 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22520 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
22521 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22522 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
22523 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
22524 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
22525 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
22526 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
22527 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22529 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
22530 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
22531 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
22532 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
22533 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
22534 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
22535 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
22536 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
22537 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
22538 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
22541 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
22542 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
22543 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
22544 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
22545 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
22546 below for further details.
22549 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
22550 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22551 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22554 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
22555 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22556 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22559 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
22560 .cindex "locking files"
22561 .cindex "file" "locking"
22562 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
22563 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
22564 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22565 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
22566 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
22567 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
22568 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
22570 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
22571 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
22572 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
22579 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
22580 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
22581 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
22582 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
22583 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
22584 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
22585 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
22586 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
22588 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
22589 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
22590 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
22591 append messages to it.
22594 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22595 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22596 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22597 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22598 in which case it is:
22600 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
22601 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
22603 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22604 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22606 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22607 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22608 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22609 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
22614 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22615 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22617 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22618 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
22619 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
22620 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
22621 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
22622 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
22623 value, and this option is ignored.
22626 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
22627 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
22628 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
22629 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
22630 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
22633 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
22634 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
22635 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
22636 on users about incoming mail.
22639 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
22640 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
22641 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
22642 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
22643 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
22644 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
22645 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
22646 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
22647 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
22649 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
22650 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
22651 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
22653 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
22654 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
22655 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
22656 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
22657 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
22658 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
22660 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
22661 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
22662 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
22663 and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
22664 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
22667 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22668 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22670 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
22672 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
22673 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
22674 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
22675 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
22676 system quota failures.
22678 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
22679 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
22680 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
22681 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
22682 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
22683 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
22684 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
22685 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
22686 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
22687 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
22690 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
22691 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
22692 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
22693 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
22694 delivery directory.
22697 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
22698 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
22699 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
22700 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
22701 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
22704 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22705 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22707 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
22708 See &%quota%& above.
22711 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
22712 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
22713 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
22714 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
22715 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the filename, and it
22716 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
22717 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
22719 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
22720 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
22721 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
22722 the file length to the filename. For example:
22724 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
22725 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
22727 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
22728 number of lines in the message.
22730 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
22731 filename (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
22732 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message filenames.
22734 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
22737 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
22738 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
22739 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
22741 quota_warn_message = "\
22742 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
22743 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
22744 This message is automatically created \
22745 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
22746 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
22747 a warning threshold that is\n\
22748 set by the system administrator.\n"
22752 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
22753 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
22754 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
22755 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22756 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
22757 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
22758 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
22759 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
22760 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
22764 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
22766 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
22767 percent sign is ignored.
22769 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
22770 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
22771 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
22772 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
22773 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
22774 &'From:'& line, the default is:
22776 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
22778 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
22779 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
22782 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
22783 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
22787 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
22788 .cindex "envelope sender"
22789 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
22790 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
22791 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
22792 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
22793 for details of batch SMTP.
22796 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
22797 .cindex "carriage return"
22799 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22800 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22801 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
22802 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22804 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
22805 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
22806 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
22807 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
22808 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
22809 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22812 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22813 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
22814 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
22815 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
22816 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22817 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
22820 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
22821 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
22822 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
22823 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
22824 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
22826 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
22827 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
22828 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
22829 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
22831 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
22832 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
22833 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
22834 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
22835 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
22838 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
22839 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
22842 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
22843 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
22844 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
22845 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
22846 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
22847 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
22848 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
22850 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22851 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
22852 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
22853 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
22856 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
22857 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
22858 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
22861 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22862 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22863 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
22864 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
22865 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
22866 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
22867 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
22868 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
22869 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
22871 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22872 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
22873 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
22874 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
22879 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
22880 .cindex "appending to a file"
22881 .cindex "file" "appending"
22882 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
22885 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
22889 .cindex "directory creation"
22890 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
22891 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
22892 &%directory_mode%& option.
22895 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
22896 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
22900 .cindex "file" "locking"
22901 .cindex "locking files"
22902 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22903 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
22904 reliably over NFS, as follows:
22907 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
22908 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
22909 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
22911 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock filename.
22913 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
22914 Unlink the hitching post name.
22916 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
22917 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
22918 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
22919 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
22921 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
22922 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
22923 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
22924 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
22925 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
22926 it before trying again.
22930 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
22931 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
22932 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
22935 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22936 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22937 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
22938 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
22939 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
22940 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
22941 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
22942 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
22943 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
22947 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
22948 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
22949 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
22950 delivery is deferred.
22953 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
22954 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
22955 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
22959 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
22960 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
22961 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
22964 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
22965 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
22966 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
22969 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
22970 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
22971 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
22972 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
22973 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
22974 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
22975 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
22976 that prevents link following.
22979 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
22980 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
22981 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
22982 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
22983 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
22986 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
22989 .cindex "file" "locking"
22990 .cindex "locking files"
22991 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
22992 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
22993 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
22994 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
22995 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
22997 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
22999 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
23000 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
23001 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
23003 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
23004 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
23005 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
23007 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
23008 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
23009 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
23010 delivery is deferred.
23012 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
23013 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
23014 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
23015 immediately. It retries up to
23017 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
23019 times (rounded up).
23022 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
23023 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
23026 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
23027 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
23028 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23029 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
23030 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
23031 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
23032 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
23033 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
23034 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
23035 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
23037 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
23038 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
23039 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
23040 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
23041 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
23042 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
23043 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
23045 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
23046 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
23047 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
23048 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
23051 .cindex "maildir format"
23052 .cindex "mailstore format"
23053 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
23054 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
23055 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
23056 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
23057 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
23059 .cindex "directory creation"
23060 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
23061 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
23062 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
23063 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
23064 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
23065 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
23070 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
23071 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
23072 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
23073 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
23074 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
23075 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
23076 &_new_& subdirectory.
23078 In the filename, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
23079 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
23080 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
23081 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
23082 filename. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
23083 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
23084 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
23086 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
23087 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
23088 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
23089 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
23090 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
23091 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
23092 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
23093 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
23095 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
23096 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
23097 folders. Consider this example:
23099 maildir_format = true
23100 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
23101 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
23102 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
23103 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
23105 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
23106 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
23107 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
23108 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
23109 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
23110 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
23112 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
23113 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
23114 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
23115 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
23116 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
23118 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
23119 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
23120 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
23122 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23123 .cindex "maildir++"
23124 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
23125 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
23126 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
23127 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
23128 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
23129 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
23130 amount of space used.
23132 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
23133 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
23134 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
23135 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
23136 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
23137 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
23142 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
23143 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
23144 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
23145 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
23146 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
23147 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
23150 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
23151 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
23152 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
23153 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
23154 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
23155 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
23156 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
23157 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
23158 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
23159 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
23160 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
23161 backwards compatibility).
23163 For one common implementation, you might set:
23165 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
23167 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
23169 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
23170 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
23171 &[stat()]& each message file.
23174 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
23175 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23176 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
23177 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
23178 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
23179 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
23180 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
23181 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
23182 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
23184 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
23185 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
23186 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
23187 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
23188 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
23189 need to know the quota.
23191 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
23192 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
23194 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
23195 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
23196 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
23200 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
23201 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
23202 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
23203 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
23204 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
23205 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
23206 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
23207 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
23209 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
23210 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
23211 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
23212 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
23213 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
23214 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
23216 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
23217 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
23218 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
23219 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
23220 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
23221 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
23223 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
23224 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
23225 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
23226 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
23229 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
23230 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
23231 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
23232 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
23233 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
23235 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
23237 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
23238 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
23239 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
23240 .ecindex IIDapptra1
23241 .ecindex IIDapptra2
23248 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23249 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23251 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
23252 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
23253 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
23254 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
23255 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
23256 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
23257 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
23258 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
23260 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
23261 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
23262 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
23263 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
23264 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
23267 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
23268 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
23269 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
23270 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
23271 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
23273 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
23274 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
23275 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
23276 transport is run as a consequence of a
23278 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
23279 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
23280 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
23281 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
23282 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
23283 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
23285 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
23286 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
23287 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
23288 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
23290 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
23291 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
23292 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
23293 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
23294 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
23295 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
23296 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
23298 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
23299 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
23300 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
23301 the transport defers.
23302 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
23303 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
23305 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
23306 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
23307 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
23308 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
23310 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23311 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
23312 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
23313 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
23314 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
23315 problems. They are just discarded.
23319 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
23320 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
23322 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
23323 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
23324 message when the message is specified by the transport.
23327 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
23328 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
23329 when the message is specified by the transport.
23332 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
23333 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
23334 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
23335 string comes first.
23338 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
23339 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
23340 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
23343 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
23344 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
23345 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
23348 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
23349 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
23350 specified by the transport.
23353 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
23354 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
23355 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
23356 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
23359 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
23360 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
23361 the message is specified by the transport.
23364 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
23365 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
23369 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
23370 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
23371 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
23372 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
23373 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
23377 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
23378 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
23379 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
23380 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
23382 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
23383 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty filename, the message
23384 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
23385 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
23386 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
23387 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
23388 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
23391 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
23392 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
23393 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
23394 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
23395 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
23397 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
23398 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
23399 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
23400 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
23401 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
23402 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
23405 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
23406 See &%once%& above.
23409 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
23410 See &%once%& above.
23411 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
23414 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
23415 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
23416 specified by the transport.
23419 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
23420 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
23421 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
23422 configuration option.
23425 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
23426 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
23427 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
23428 automatic responses. For example:
23430 subject = Re: $h_subject:
23432 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
23433 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
23434 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
23435 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
23440 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
23441 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
23442 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
23443 the text comes first.
23446 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
23447 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
23448 when the message is specified by the transport.
23449 .ecindex IIDauttra1
23450 .ecindex IIDauttra2
23455 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23456 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23458 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
23459 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
23460 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
23461 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
23462 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
23463 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
23465 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
23466 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
23467 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
23468 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
23469 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
23470 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
23474 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
23475 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
23476 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
23479 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
23480 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23483 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
23484 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23485 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
23486 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
23487 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23490 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
23491 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
23492 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
23493 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
23494 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
23495 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
23498 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
23499 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23500 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
23501 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
23502 in its response to the LHLO command.
23504 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
23505 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
23506 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
23507 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
23510 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
23511 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
23512 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
23513 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
23518 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
23522 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
23523 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
23527 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23528 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23530 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
23531 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
23532 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
23533 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
23534 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
23535 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
23536 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
23537 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
23541 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23542 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
23543 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
23544 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
23545 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
23547 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23548 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
23549 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
23550 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
23551 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
23552 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
23553 that are routed to the transport.
23555 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
23556 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
23557 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
23558 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
23559 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
23560 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
23561 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
23565 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
23566 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
23567 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
23569 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
23570 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
23571 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
23572 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
23573 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
23574 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
23575 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
23578 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
23579 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
23580 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
23581 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
23582 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
23583 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
23584 of "1" to enforce serialization.
23589 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
23590 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
23591 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
23592 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
23593 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
23594 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
23595 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
23596 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
23597 &"local delivery failed"&.
23599 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
23600 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
23601 will be sent as normal.
23603 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
23604 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
23605 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
23606 apply in this case.
23608 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
23609 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
23610 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
23611 a non-existent command may be the problem.
23613 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
23614 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
23615 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
23616 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
23617 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
23618 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
23619 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
23624 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
23625 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
23626 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
23627 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
23628 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
23631 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
23632 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
23633 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
23634 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
23636 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
23637 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
23638 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
23639 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
23640 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
23642 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
23644 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
23645 arguments. You have to write
23647 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
23649 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
23650 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
23651 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
23652 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
23653 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
23654 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
23657 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
23660 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23661 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23662 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23663 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
23664 &`$pipe_addresses`& (no quotes).
23665 This is not a general expansion variable; the only
23666 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
23667 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
23668 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
23669 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
23670 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
23672 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
23673 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
23674 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
23675 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
23676 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
23677 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
23678 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
23679 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
23681 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
23682 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
23683 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
23684 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
23685 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
23686 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
23687 control what is done with it.
23689 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
23690 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
23691 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
23692 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
23693 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
23694 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
23695 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
23696 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
23697 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
23698 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
23699 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
23703 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
23704 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23705 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23706 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
23707 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
23708 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
23709 environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
23710 to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
23712 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
23713 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
23714 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
23715 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
23716 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
23717 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
23718 &`LOGNAME `& see below
23719 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
23720 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
23721 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
23722 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
23723 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
23724 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
23725 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
23726 &`USER `& see below
23728 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
23729 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
23730 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
23731 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
23732 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
23733 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
23734 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
23737 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
23738 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
23739 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
23743 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
23744 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
23745 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
23746 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
23749 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
23750 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
23754 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
23755 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
23756 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23757 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
23758 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
23759 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
23760 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
23761 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
23762 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
23763 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
23764 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
23767 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
23769 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
23770 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
23771 &%use_shell%& is set.
23774 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
23775 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23778 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
23779 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23780 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23783 .option check_string pipe string unset
23784 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
23785 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
23786 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
23787 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
23788 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
23789 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
23790 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
23794 .option command pipe string&!! unset
23795 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
23796 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
23797 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
23798 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
23799 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
23800 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
23803 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
23804 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23805 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23806 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
23807 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
23808 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23809 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
23812 .option escape_string pipe string unset
23813 See &%check_string%& above.
23816 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
23817 .cindex "exec failure"
23818 .cindex "failure of exec"
23819 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
23820 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
23821 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
23822 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
23823 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
23826 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
23827 .cindex "signal exit"
23828 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
23829 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
23830 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
23831 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
23834 .option force_command pipe boolean false
23835 .cindex "force command"
23836 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
23837 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
23838 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
23839 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
23840 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
23841 command. For example:
23843 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
23847 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
23848 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
23849 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
23852 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
23853 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
23854 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
23855 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
23856 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
23857 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
23859 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
23860 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
23863 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
23864 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
23865 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
23866 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
23867 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
23868 written to the main log.
23871 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
23872 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
23873 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
23874 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
23875 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
23876 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
23880 .option log_output pipe boolean false
23881 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
23882 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
23883 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
23884 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23887 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
23888 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
23889 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
23890 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
23891 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
23892 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
23893 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
23894 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
23897 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
23898 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23899 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
23902 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
23906 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
23907 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23908 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
23909 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
23910 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
23915 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23916 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
23919 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
23920 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
23921 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
23922 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
23926 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23927 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
23930 .option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
23931 This option is expanded and
23932 specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
23933 variable of the subprocess.
23934 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
23935 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
23936 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
23939 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
23940 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
23941 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
23942 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
23943 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
23944 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
23945 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
23946 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
23947 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
23950 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
23951 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
23952 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
23953 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
23954 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
23955 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
23956 accept the message is used.
23959 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
23960 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
23961 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
23962 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
23963 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
23964 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
23967 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
23968 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
23969 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
23970 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
23971 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
23972 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
23973 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23977 .option return_output pipe boolean false
23978 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
23979 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
23980 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
23981 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
23982 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
23983 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
23984 of them may be set.
23988 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
23989 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
23990 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
23991 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
23992 and &%return_output%& is not set,
23993 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
23994 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
23995 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
23996 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
23997 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
23998 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
23999 and 73, respectively.
24002 .option timeout pipe time 1h
24003 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
24004 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
24005 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
24006 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
24007 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
24008 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
24010 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
24011 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
24012 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
24013 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
24014 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
24015 delivery to be deferred.
24017 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
24018 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
24021 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
24022 .cindex "envelope sender"
24023 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
24024 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
24025 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
24026 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
24027 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
24029 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
24030 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
24031 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
24032 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
24033 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
24034 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
24038 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
24039 .cindex "carriage return"
24041 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
24042 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
24043 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
24044 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
24046 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
24047 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
24048 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
24049 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
24050 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
24053 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
24054 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24055 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
24056 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
24057 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
24058 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
24059 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
24060 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
24061 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
24066 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
24067 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
24068 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
24069 .cindex "external local delivery"
24070 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
24071 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
24072 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
24073 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
24074 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
24075 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
24076 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
24077 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
24078 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
24079 configuration for &%procmail%&:
24084 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
24088 check_string = "From "
24089 escape_string = ">From "
24098 transport = procmail_pipe
24100 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
24101 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
24102 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
24103 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
24104 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
24105 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
24107 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
24111 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
24112 use a shell to run pipe commands.
24115 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
24116 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
24119 local_delivery_cyrus:
24121 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
24122 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
24134 local_part_suffix = .*
24135 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
24137 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
24138 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
24140 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
24141 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
24144 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24145 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24147 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
24148 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
24149 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
24150 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
24151 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
24152 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
24153 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
24154 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
24157 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
24158 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
24162 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
24163 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
24164 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
24165 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
24166 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
24167 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
24168 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
24170 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
24171 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
24172 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
24173 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
24174 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
24175 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
24180 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
24181 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
24182 no further messages are sent over that connection.
24186 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
24188 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24189 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
24190 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
24191 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
24192 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
24193 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
24194 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
24195 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
24198 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
24199 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
24200 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
24201 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
24202 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
24203 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
24204 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
24205 are the values that were set when the message was received.
24206 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
24207 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
24208 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
24209 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
24210 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
24211 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
24213 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
24214 and will be removed in a future release.
24217 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
24218 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
24219 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
24222 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
24223 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
24224 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
24225 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
24226 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
24227 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
24228 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
24229 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
24231 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
24232 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
24233 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24234 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
24235 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
24236 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
24237 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
24238 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
24239 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
24242 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
24244 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
24245 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
24246 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
24247 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
24248 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
24251 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
24252 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
24253 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
24254 particular connection.
24256 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
24257 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
24258 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
24259 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
24261 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
24262 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
24263 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
24265 authenticated_sender = $local_part
24267 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
24268 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
24270 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
24271 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
24275 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
24276 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
24277 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
24278 authenticated as a client.
24281 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
24282 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
24283 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
24284 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
24287 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
24288 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
24289 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
24290 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
24291 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
24292 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
24293 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
24296 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
24297 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
24298 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
24299 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24300 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
24301 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
24302 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
24306 .option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24307 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
24308 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24309 .cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
24310 This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
24311 where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
24312 If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
24313 Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
24314 configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
24315 been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
24316 TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
24317 counter-intuitively decreasing it.
24318 If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
24319 be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
24322 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
24323 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
24324 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
24325 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
24328 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
24329 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
24330 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
24331 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
24332 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
24333 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
24334 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
24335 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
24336 .option dkim_timestamps smtp string&!! unset
24337 DKIM signing options. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24340 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
24341 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
24342 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
24343 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
24344 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
24347 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
24348 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
24349 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
24350 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
24351 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
24352 unhappy at this prospect, so...
24354 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24355 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
24356 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24357 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
24358 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
24359 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
24360 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
24361 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
24365 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
24366 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
24367 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
24368 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
24369 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
24372 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
24373 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
24374 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
24375 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
24379 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24380 .cindex "MX record" "security"
24381 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24382 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24383 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24384 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
24385 the dnssec request bit set.
24386 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
24390 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24391 .cindex "MX record" "security"
24392 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24393 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24394 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24395 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
24396 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
24397 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
24398 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
24402 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
24403 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
24404 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
24405 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
24406 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
24407 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
24408 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
24410 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
24411 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
24412 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
24413 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
24414 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
24417 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
24418 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24419 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
24420 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
24421 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
24422 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24423 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24424 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
24426 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
24427 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
24428 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
24429 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
24430 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
24431 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
24433 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
24434 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
24435 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
24436 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
24437 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
24439 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
24440 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
24441 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
24442 copy of the message is sent.
24444 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
24445 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
24446 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
24447 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
24451 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
24452 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
24453 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
24456 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
24457 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
24458 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
24459 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
24460 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
24461 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
24463 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
24464 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
24465 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
24466 implementations of TLS.
24468 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
24469 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
24470 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
24471 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
24472 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
24473 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
24474 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
24479 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
24480 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
24481 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
24482 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
24483 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
24484 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
24485 interface address, you could use this:
24487 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
24488 {$primary_hostname}}
24490 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
24493 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
24494 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
24495 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
24496 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
24497 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
24498 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
24500 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
24501 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
24502 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
24503 &%hosts_override%& is set.
24505 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
24506 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
24507 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
24508 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24509 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24510 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
24511 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
24513 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
24514 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
24515 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
24516 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
24517 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
24518 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
24519 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
24522 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
24523 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
24526 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24527 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
24528 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
24529 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
24530 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24531 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
24532 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
24533 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
24534 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
24535 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
24538 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
24539 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24540 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
24541 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
24544 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24545 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24546 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24547 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24549 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24550 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24551 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
24552 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
24553 to any host that matches this list.
24556 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
24557 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24558 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
24559 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
24560 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
24561 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
24562 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
24563 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
24566 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
24567 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
24568 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
24573 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24574 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24575 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24576 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24577 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
24578 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24579 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
24580 explanation of when this might be needed.
24582 .option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" *
24583 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24584 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24585 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24586 For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
24587 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24588 message on the same session.
24590 The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
24591 process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
24592 sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
24593 instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
24594 the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
24595 The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
24600 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
24601 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
24602 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
24603 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
24604 &%fallback_hosts%&.
24607 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
24608 .cindex "randomized host list"
24609 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
24610 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
24611 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
24612 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
24613 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
24614 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
24615 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
24616 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
24618 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
24619 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
24620 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
24621 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
24623 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
24625 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
24626 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
24627 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
24629 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24630 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
24631 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
24632 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
24633 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
24634 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
24635 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
24636 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
24637 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24640 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
24641 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24642 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
24643 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24644 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24646 .option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24647 .cindex DANE "transport options"
24648 .cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
24649 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
24650 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
24651 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made.
24652 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24653 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24655 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24656 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24657 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
24658 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24659 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24661 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24662 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24663 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24664 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24665 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
24666 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
24668 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24669 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
24670 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24671 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
24672 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
24673 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
24674 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24676 .option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
24677 .cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
24678 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
24679 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
24680 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24681 CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
24682 BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
24684 .option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24685 .cindex DANE "transport options"
24686 .cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
24687 If built with DANE support, Exim will lookup a
24688 TLSA record for any host matching the list.
24689 If found and verified by DNSSEC,
24690 a DANE-verified TLS connection is made to that host;
24691 there will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24692 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24694 .option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" unset
24695 .cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
24696 .cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
24697 .cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
24698 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
24699 the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
24700 perform a TCP Fast Open.
24701 No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
24702 supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
24703 the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
24705 The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
24706 as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
24708 On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
24709 in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
24710 There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
24711 it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
24712 such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
24714 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
24715 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
24716 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24717 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
24718 for multi-recipient messages.
24719 The option can usually be left as default.
24721 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
24722 .cindex "bind IP address"
24723 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
24725 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24726 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
24727 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
24728 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
24729 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
24730 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
24731 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
24732 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
24735 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
24736 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
24737 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
24738 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
24739 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
24740 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
24743 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
24745 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
24746 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
24747 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
24748 interface to use if the host has more than one.
24751 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
24752 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
24753 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
24754 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
24755 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
24756 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
24757 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
24758 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
24759 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
24760 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
24764 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
24765 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24766 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
24767 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
24768 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
24770 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
24771 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
24772 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
24773 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
24774 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
24778 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
24779 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24780 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
24781 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
24782 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
24783 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
24784 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
24785 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
24787 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
24788 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
24789 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
24791 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
24792 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
24793 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
24794 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
24795 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
24796 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
24797 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
24798 variable that contains an outgoing port.
24800 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
24801 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
24803 but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"& the default is &"lmtp"&
24804 and if &%protocol%& is set to &"smtps"& the default is &"smtps"&.
24805 If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
24808 Note that at least one Linux distribution has been seen failing
24809 to put &"smtps"& in its &"/etc/services"& file, resulting is such deferrals.
24813 .option protocol smtp string smtp
24814 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
24815 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
24816 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
24818 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
24819 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
24820 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
24821 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
24822 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
24824 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
24825 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
24826 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
24827 The Internet standards bodies used to strongly discourage use of this mode,
24828 but as of RFC 8314 it is perferred over STARTTLS for message submission
24829 (as distinct from MTA-MTA communication).
24832 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
24833 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
24834 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
24835 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
24836 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
24837 addresses is not affected.
24839 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
24840 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
24841 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
24842 Exim to use only the host name.
24843 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
24846 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24847 .cindex "serializing connections"
24848 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
24849 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
24850 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
24851 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
24852 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
24853 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
24854 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
24856 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
24857 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
24858 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
24859 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
24860 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
24861 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
24863 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
24864 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
24865 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
24866 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
24867 are used for ETRN serialization.
24869 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
24872 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
24873 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
24874 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
24875 .cindex "size" "of message"
24876 .cindex "transport" "filter"
24877 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
24878 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
24879 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
24880 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
24881 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
24882 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
24883 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
24885 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
24886 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
24889 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
24890 .cindex proxy SOCKS
24891 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
24892 transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
24895 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
24896 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
24897 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
24899 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24900 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24901 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
24902 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
24903 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
24906 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
24907 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
24908 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
24909 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
24913 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
24914 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
24915 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
24916 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
24917 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
24920 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
24921 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
24922 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
24923 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
24924 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
24925 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
24928 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
24931 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
24932 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
24934 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24935 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24936 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
24937 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
24938 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24939 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
24940 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
24941 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24944 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24945 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
24946 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24948 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24949 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
24950 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
24951 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
24952 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24953 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
24954 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
24955 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
24956 ciphers is a preference order.
24960 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
24961 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
24962 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
24963 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
24964 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
24965 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
24966 certificate and private key for the session.
24968 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
24970 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
24976 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
24977 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
24978 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
24979 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
24980 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
24981 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
24982 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
24983 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
24984 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
24985 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
24989 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
24990 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24991 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24992 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24993 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
24994 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24995 Note that unless the host is in this list
24996 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
24997 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
24998 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
24999 certificate verification succeeds.
25002 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
25003 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
25004 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25005 This option give a list of hosts for which,
25006 while verifying the server certificate,
25007 checks will be included on the host name
25008 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
25009 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
25010 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
25012 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
25015 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
25016 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25017 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25019 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25020 The value of this option must be either the
25022 or the absolute path to
25023 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
25024 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
25026 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
25027 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
25028 is taken as empty and an explicit location
25031 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
25032 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
25034 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
25036 either by file or directory
25037 are added to those given by the system default location.
25039 The values of &$host$& and
25040 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25041 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25043 For back-compatibility,
25044 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
25045 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
25046 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
25049 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25050 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25051 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25052 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25053 certificate verification must succeed.
25054 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25055 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
25056 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
25058 .option utf8_downconvert smtp integer!! unset
25059 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
25060 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
25061 If built with internationalization support,
25062 this option controls conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
25064 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
25069 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
25071 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
25072 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
25073 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
25074 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
25075 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
25078 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
25079 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
25080 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
25081 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
25084 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
25085 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
25086 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
25088 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
25089 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
25090 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
25091 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
25092 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
25094 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
25095 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
25096 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
25097 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
25098 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
25099 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
25100 see below for an exception).
25102 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
25103 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
25104 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
25105 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
25106 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
25108 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
25109 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
25110 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
25111 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
25112 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
25113 reached their retry times.
25115 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
25116 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
25117 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
25118 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
25119 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
25120 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
25121 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
25122 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
25123 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
25124 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
25127 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
25128 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
25129 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
25130 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
25131 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
25132 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
25134 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
25135 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
25136 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
25137 possible IP addresses have been tried.
25138 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
25139 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
25145 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25146 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25148 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
25149 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
25150 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
25151 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
25152 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
25153 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
25155 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
25156 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
25157 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
25158 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
25159 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
25160 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
25161 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
25163 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
25164 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
25165 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
25166 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
25169 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
25170 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
25171 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
25172 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
25174 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
25175 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
25176 facility; you do not have to use it.
25178 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
25179 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
25180 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
25181 address to which it applies.
25183 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
25184 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
25185 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
25186 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
25187 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
25188 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
25191 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
25192 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
25193 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
25194 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
25197 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
25198 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
25199 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
25200 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
25201 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
25204 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
25205 illustrated by these examples:
25208 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
25209 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
25210 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
25211 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
25213 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
25214 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
25219 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
25220 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
25221 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
25222 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
25223 message's processing.
25225 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25226 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
25227 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
25228 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
25229 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
25230 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
25231 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
25232 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
25233 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
25235 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25236 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25237 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
25238 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
25239 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
25240 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
25241 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
25242 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
25243 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
25244 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
25246 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
25247 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
25248 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
25249 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
25250 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
25251 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
25253 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
25254 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
25255 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
25257 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
25258 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
25259 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
25260 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
25261 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
25262 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
25263 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
25264 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
25265 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
25267 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
25268 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
25274 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
25275 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
25276 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
25277 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the runtime
25278 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
25279 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
25280 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
25281 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
25282 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
25283 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
25285 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
25287 might produce the output
25289 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25290 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25291 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25292 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25293 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25294 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25295 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25296 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25298 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
25299 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
25300 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
25301 set for a particular transport.
25304 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
25305 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
25306 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
25309 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
25311 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
25312 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
25313 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
25314 any colons must be doubled, of course).
25316 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
25317 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
25318 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
25319 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
25322 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
25323 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
25324 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
25326 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
25327 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
25328 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
25329 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
25330 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
25331 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
25332 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
25334 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25335 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25336 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
25337 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
25338 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
25342 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
25343 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25346 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
25347 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
25348 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
25349 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
25350 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
25351 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
25352 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
25353 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
25354 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
25356 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
25357 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
25358 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
25360 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
25361 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
25362 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
25363 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
25364 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
25365 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
25366 of pattern they are set as follows:
25369 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
25370 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
25371 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
25374 *queen@*.fict.example
25376 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
25378 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
25382 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
25383 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
25386 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
25387 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
25388 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
25389 rewriting rule of the form
25391 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
25393 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
25399 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
25400 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
25401 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
25402 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
25403 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
25407 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
25408 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
25409 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
25410 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
25411 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
25413 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
25415 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
25418 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25419 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25420 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
25421 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
25422 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25423 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
25424 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
25425 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
25426 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
25427 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
25428 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
25429 entry written to the panic log.
25433 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
25434 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
25437 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
25440 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
25442 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
25445 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
25446 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
25450 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
25452 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
25453 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
25454 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
25455 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
25456 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
25457 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
25459 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
25460 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
25461 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
25462 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
25463 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
25464 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
25465 &`h`& rewrite all headers
25466 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
25467 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
25468 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
25470 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
25471 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
25472 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
25474 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
25475 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
25478 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
25479 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
25480 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
25481 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
25482 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
25483 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
25484 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
25485 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
25486 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
25488 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25489 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25490 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
25491 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
25492 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
25493 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
25494 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
25495 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
25498 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
25499 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
25500 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
25501 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
25504 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
25505 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
25506 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
25508 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
25509 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
25510 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
25511 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
25513 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
25514 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
25515 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
25517 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
25518 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
25519 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
25520 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
25522 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
25526 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
25529 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
25530 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
25531 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
25532 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
25533 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
25534 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
25535 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
25536 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
25538 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
25539 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
25543 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
25544 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
25546 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
25547 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
25548 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
25550 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
25551 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
25552 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
25553 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
25554 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
25555 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
25556 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
25557 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
25559 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
25560 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
25562 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
25564 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
25565 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
25567 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
25568 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
25569 messages that originate outside the local host:
25571 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
25572 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
25574 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
25577 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
25578 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
25579 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
25580 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
25581 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
25582 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
25583 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
25584 components. For example, the rule
25586 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
25588 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
25589 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
25590 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
25591 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
25592 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
25593 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
25594 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
25601 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25602 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25604 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
25605 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
25606 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
25607 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
25608 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
25609 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
25610 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
25611 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
25612 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
25613 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
25614 address, domain and error.
25616 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
25617 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
25618 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
25619 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
25620 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
25621 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
25622 log selector is set, the message
25623 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
25624 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
25625 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
25626 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
25628 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
25629 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
25630 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
25631 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
25632 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
25633 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
25634 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
25635 domain are maintained independently.
25637 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
25638 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
25639 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
25640 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
25641 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
25642 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
25643 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
25644 the local address is reached.
25646 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
25647 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
25648 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
25649 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
25650 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
25652 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
25653 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
25654 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
25655 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
25656 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
25657 messages that it should now be retaining.
25661 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
25662 .cindex "retry" "rules"
25663 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
25664 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
25665 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
25666 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
25667 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
25668 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
25669 message's sender, respectively.
25672 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
25673 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
25674 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
25675 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
25676 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
25677 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
25680 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25682 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
25685 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25687 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
25688 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
25691 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
25692 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
25693 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
25694 expressions work in address lists.
25696 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
25697 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
25701 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
25702 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
25703 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
25704 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
25705 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
25706 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
25707 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
25708 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
25709 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
25711 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
25712 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
25713 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
25714 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
25717 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
25718 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
25719 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
25720 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
25721 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
25722 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
25723 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
25724 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
25725 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
25726 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
25731 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
25733 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
25734 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
25735 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
25736 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
25737 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
25738 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
25740 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
25744 and the retry rules are
25746 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
25747 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
25749 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
25750 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
25751 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
25752 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
25753 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
25754 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
25756 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
25757 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
25758 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
25759 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
25761 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
25762 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
25763 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
25765 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
25767 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
25768 textual form of the IP address.
25770 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
25771 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
25772 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
25773 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
25776 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
25777 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
25778 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
25780 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
25781 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
25782 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
25784 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
25785 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
25787 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
25788 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
25791 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
25792 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
25793 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
25794 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
25795 retry rule of this form:
25797 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
25799 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
25800 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
25803 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
25804 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
25805 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
25806 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
25809 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
25810 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
25811 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
25812 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
25813 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
25815 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
25816 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
25818 .vitem &%refused_A%&
25819 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
25822 A connection was refused.
25824 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
25825 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
25827 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
25828 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
25830 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
25831 A connection attempt timed out.
25833 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
25834 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
25835 obtained from an MX record.
25837 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
25838 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
25839 obtained from an MX record.
25842 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
25844 .vitem &%tls_required%&
25845 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
25846 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
25847 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
25850 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25853 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
25854 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
25855 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
25856 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25857 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
25858 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
25862 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
25863 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
25864 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
25865 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
25866 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
25870 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
25871 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
25872 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
25874 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
25875 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
25876 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
25877 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
25878 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
25879 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
25880 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
25882 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
25883 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
25886 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
25887 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
25888 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
25893 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
25894 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
25895 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
25896 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
25897 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
25900 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
25902 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
25904 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
25906 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
25907 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
25910 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
25912 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
25913 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
25914 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
25915 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
25916 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
25918 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
25919 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
25921 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
25923 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
25924 list is never matched.
25930 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
25931 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
25932 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
25933 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
25935 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
25937 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
25938 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
25939 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
25940 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
25941 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
25943 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
25944 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
25945 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
25946 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
25947 The available algorithms are:
25950 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
25953 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
25954 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
25955 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
25957 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
25958 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
25959 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
25960 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
25961 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
25962 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
25963 queue processing times.
25966 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
25967 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
25968 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
25969 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
25970 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
25971 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
25972 interval is found. The main configuration variable
25973 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
25974 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
25975 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
25976 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
25977 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
25979 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
25980 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
25981 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
25982 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
25983 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
25984 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
25987 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
25988 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
25989 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
25990 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
25991 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
25992 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
25993 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
25994 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
25995 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
25996 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
25997 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
25998 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
26000 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
26001 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
26002 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
26003 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
26004 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
26005 deliveries that have been deferred.
26008 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
26009 Here are some example retry rules:
26011 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
26012 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
26013 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
26014 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26015 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
26016 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
26018 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
26019 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
26020 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
26021 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
26022 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
26023 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
26024 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
26027 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
26028 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
26029 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
26030 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
26031 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
26033 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
26034 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
26035 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
26036 were not obtained from an MX record.
26038 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
26039 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
26040 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
26041 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
26042 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
26046 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
26047 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
26048 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
26049 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
26050 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
26051 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
26052 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
26053 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
26054 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
26055 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
26056 failing for the first time.
26058 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
26059 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
26060 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
26061 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
26063 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
26064 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
26065 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
26070 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
26071 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
26072 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
26073 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
26074 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
26075 default retry rule:
26077 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
26079 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
26080 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
26081 failure for the recipient address that counts.
26083 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
26084 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
26085 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
26086 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
26087 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
26089 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
26090 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
26091 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
26093 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
26094 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
26095 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
26096 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
26097 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
26098 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses,
26099 as set by the &%retry_data_expire%& option, is
26100 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
26101 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
26102 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
26103 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
26105 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
26106 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
26107 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
26108 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
26109 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
26112 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
26113 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
26114 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
26115 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
26116 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
26117 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
26118 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
26119 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
26120 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
26123 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
26124 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
26125 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
26126 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
26127 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
26128 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
26129 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
26130 failing messages remain in the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
26133 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
26134 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
26135 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
26136 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
26137 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
26138 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
26139 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
26140 time out the address.
26142 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
26143 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
26144 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
26145 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
26146 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
26147 considered immediately.
26148 .ecindex IIDretconf1
26149 .ecindex IIDregconf2
26156 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26157 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26159 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
26160 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
26161 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
26162 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's runtime configuration is concerned
26163 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
26164 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
26165 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
26166 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
26167 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
26170 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
26171 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
26174 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
26175 the client's EHLO command.
26177 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
26178 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
26180 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
26181 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
26182 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
26183 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
26184 with the AUTH command.
26186 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
26188 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
26189 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
26190 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
26193 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
26194 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
26195 unauthenticated connection.
26198 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
26199 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
26200 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
26201 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
26203 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
26204 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
26205 &`Connected to server.example.`&
26206 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
26207 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
26208 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
26209 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
26210 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
26215 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
26216 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
26217 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
26218 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
26219 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
26220 included by setting
26223 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
26227 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
26232 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
26233 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
26234 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
26235 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
26236 work via a socket interface.
26238 The fourth provides for negotiation of authentication done via non-SMTP means,
26239 as defined by RFC 4422 Appendix A.
26241 The fifth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
26242 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
26243 The sixth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
26244 supporting setting a server keytab.
26245 The seventh can be configured to support
26246 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
26247 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs.
26248 The eighth authenticator
26249 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
26250 The last is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
26251 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
26253 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
26254 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
26255 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
26256 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
26257 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
26258 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
26259 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
26261 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
26262 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
26263 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
26264 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
26265 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
26266 both sets of options, is required. For example:
26270 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26271 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
26273 client_secret = secret2
26275 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
26276 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
26278 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
26279 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
26280 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
26283 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
26284 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
26285 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
26286 authenticating data.
26288 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
26289 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
26290 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
26291 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
26292 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
26293 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
26294 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
26295 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
26296 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
26297 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
26300 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
26301 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
26302 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
26303 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
26307 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
26308 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
26309 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
26311 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26312 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
26313 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
26314 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
26315 encrypted by a setting such as:
26317 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
26321 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26322 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
26323 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
26324 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
26327 .option driver authenticators string unset
26328 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
26329 authenticators is to be used.
26332 .option public_name authenticators string unset
26333 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
26334 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
26335 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
26336 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
26337 defaults to the driver's instance name.
26340 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26341 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
26342 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
26343 mechanism is not advertised.
26344 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
26345 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
26346 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
26349 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26350 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
26351 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
26354 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
26355 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
26357 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
26358 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
26359 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
26360 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
26361 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
26362 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
26363 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26364 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
26365 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
26369 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
26370 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
26371 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
26372 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
26373 out the values of variables.
26374 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
26375 output, and Exim carries on processing.
26378 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26379 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26380 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
26381 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
26382 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
26383 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
26384 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
26385 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
26386 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
26387 On a failing authentication the expansion result is instead saved in
26388 the &$authenticated_fail_id$& variable.
26389 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
26392 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26393 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
26394 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
26395 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
26396 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
26397 remembered for later use.
26398 How it is used is described in the following section.
26404 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
26405 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
26406 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26407 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
26408 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
26412 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
26413 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
26415 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
26417 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
26418 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
26419 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
26420 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
26421 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
26422 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
26423 given for the MAIL command.
26425 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
26426 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
26429 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
26430 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
26431 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
26432 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
26433 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
26434 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
26435 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
26440 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
26441 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
26442 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
26443 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
26445 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26446 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
26447 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
26448 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
26449 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
26454 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
26455 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
26456 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
26457 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
26461 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
26463 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
26464 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
26467 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
26468 the mechanisms are advertised.
26470 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
26471 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
26472 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
26473 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
26474 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
26475 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
26476 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
26478 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
26480 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
26482 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
26483 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
26484 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
26487 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
26489 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26490 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
26491 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
26493 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
26494 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
26495 command. This is the case if
26498 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
26500 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
26502 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
26503 server authenticators.
26507 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
26508 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
26509 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
26511 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
26512 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
26513 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
26514 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
26515 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
26516 rejected with a 504 error.
26518 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
26519 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
26520 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
26521 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
26522 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
26523 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
26524 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
26525 no successful authentication.
26527 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
26528 Successful authentication sets up information used by the
26529 &$authresults$& expansion item.
26534 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
26535 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
26536 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
26537 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
26538 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
26539 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
26540 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
26544 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
26546 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
26547 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
26548 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
26549 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
26550 command line to run this script on such data might be
26552 encode '\0user\0password'
26554 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
26555 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
26556 whose code value is zero.
26558 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
26559 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
26560 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
26561 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
26563 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
26564 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
26565 example, a command such as
26567 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
26569 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
26571 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
26572 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
26574 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
26576 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
26577 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
26578 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
26579 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
26583 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
26584 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
26585 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
26586 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
26587 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
26588 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
26591 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
26592 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
26593 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
26594 of the authenticator.
26597 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26598 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
26599 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
26600 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
26601 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
26602 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
26603 delivery to be deferred.
26605 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
26606 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
26607 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
26610 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
26611 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
26612 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
26613 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
26614 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
26615 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
26616 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
26617 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
26618 deliver the message unauthenticated.
26621 Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
26622 confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
26623 upon and the time that the transport runs. For example, with a manualroute
26624 router given a host name, and with DNS "round-robin" used by that name: if
26625 the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
26626 running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
26627 check which does not match the connection peer IP.
26628 No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
26630 For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
26632 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26633 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
26634 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
26635 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
26636 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
26637 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
26638 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
26639 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
26640 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
26641 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
26642 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
26643 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
26644 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
26651 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26652 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26654 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
26655 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
26656 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
26657 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
26658 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
26659 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
26660 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
26661 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
26662 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
26663 connections as you do for login accounts.
26665 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
26666 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
26667 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
26669 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26670 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
26671 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
26673 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
26674 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
26675 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
26678 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
26679 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26680 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26681 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
26682 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26683 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26684 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26686 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
26687 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
26688 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
26689 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
26690 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
26691 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
26692 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
26694 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
26695 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
26696 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
26697 string expansions that also use them for other things.
26699 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
26700 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
26701 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
26703 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26704 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
26705 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
26706 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
26707 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
26708 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26709 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
26710 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
26711 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
26712 string as the error text.
26714 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
26715 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
26716 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
26720 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
26721 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
26722 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
26723 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26724 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
26725 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
26726 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
26727 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
26729 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
26730 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
26731 configured as follows:
26735 public_name = PLAIN
26737 server_condition = \
26738 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
26739 server_set_id = $auth2
26741 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
26742 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
26743 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
26744 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
26746 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
26747 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
26748 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
26749 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
26753 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
26755 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
26757 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
26758 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
26762 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
26763 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
26765 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
26766 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
26767 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
26768 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
26769 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
26771 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
26772 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
26773 authenticating clients it could make sense.
26775 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
26776 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
26777 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
26778 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
26779 This is an incorrect example:
26781 server_condition = \
26782 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
26784 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
26785 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
26786 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
26787 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
26788 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
26789 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
26790 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
26792 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
26793 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
26795 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
26796 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
26797 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
26798 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
26799 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
26802 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
26803 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
26804 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
26805 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
26806 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
26807 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
26808 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
26812 public_name = LOGIN
26813 server_prompts = User Name : Password
26814 server_condition = \
26815 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
26816 server_set_id = $auth1
26818 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
26819 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
26820 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
26821 strings are used to obtain two data items.
26823 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
26824 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
26825 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
26826 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
26827 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
26831 public_name = LOGIN
26832 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
26833 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
26836 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
26837 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
26838 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
26839 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
26841 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
26842 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
26843 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
26844 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
26845 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
26846 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
26847 uninterpreted string.
26850 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
26851 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
26852 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
26853 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
26854 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
26860 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
26861 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
26862 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
26864 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
26865 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
26866 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
26867 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
26870 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
26871 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
26872 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
26873 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
26874 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
26875 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
26876 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
26877 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
26878 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
26879 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
26880 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
26881 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
26883 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
26884 splitting takes priority and happens first.
26886 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
26887 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
26888 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
26889 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
26892 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
26893 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
26897 public_name = PLAIN
26898 client_send = ^username^mysecret
26900 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
26901 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
26902 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
26906 public_name = LOGIN
26907 client_send = : username : mysecret
26909 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
26910 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
26912 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
26913 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
26918 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26919 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26921 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
26922 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26923 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
26924 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
26925 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
26926 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
26927 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
26928 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
26929 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
26930 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
26931 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
26932 available in plain text at either end.
26935 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
26936 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
26937 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
26938 authenticator as a server:
26940 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26941 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26942 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
26943 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
26944 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
26945 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
26946 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
26947 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
26948 returned to the client.
26950 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
26951 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
26952 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
26953 numeric variables for other things.
26955 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
26956 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
26957 user name, authentication fails.
26961 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26962 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
26963 server_set_id = $auth1
26965 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26966 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
26967 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
26968 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
26972 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26973 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
26975 server_set_id = $auth1
26977 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
26978 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
26980 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
26981 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
26982 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
26987 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26988 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
26989 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26990 server_set_id = $auth1
26993 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
26994 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
26995 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
26999 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
27000 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
27001 computing the response to the server's challenge.
27004 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
27005 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
27006 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
27010 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
27011 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
27012 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
27013 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
27014 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
27015 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
27016 send the message to the current server.
27018 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
27023 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27025 client_secret = secret
27027 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
27028 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
27032 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27033 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27035 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
27036 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
27037 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
27038 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
27040 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick while
27041 at A L Digital Ltd.
27043 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
27044 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
27045 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
27046 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
27047 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
27049 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
27050 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
27051 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
27052 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
27054 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example, in GSSAPI
27055 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
27056 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
27057 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
27058 depending on the driver you are using.
27060 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
27061 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
27062 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
27063 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
27064 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
27067 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
27068 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
27069 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
27070 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
27071 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
27072 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
27073 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
27074 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
27077 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
27078 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
27079 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
27080 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
27081 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
27082 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
27086 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
27087 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27088 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
27089 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
27092 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
27093 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27094 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27095 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27099 driver = cyrus_sasl
27100 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27101 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27102 server_set_id = $auth1
27105 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
27106 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27109 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
27110 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27113 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
27114 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
27115 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
27116 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
27119 driver = cyrus_sasl
27120 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27121 server_set_id = $auth1
27124 driver = cyrus_sasl
27125 public_name = PLAIN
27126 server_set_id = $auth2
27128 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
27129 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
27130 but it is present in many binary distributions.
27131 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
27132 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
27137 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27138 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27139 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
27140 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
27141 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
27142 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
27143 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
27144 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
27145 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
27146 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
27147 authenticator only. There is only one option:
27149 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
27151 This option must specify the UNIX socket that is the interface to Dovecot
27152 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
27153 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
27154 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
27158 public_name = PLAIN
27159 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27160 server_set_id = $auth1
27165 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27166 server_set_id = $auth1
27168 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
27169 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
27170 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
27171 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
27172 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
27173 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
27174 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
27175 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
27178 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27179 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27180 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
27181 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
27182 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
27183 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
27184 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
27185 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27186 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27187 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
27188 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
27189 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
27190 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
27191 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
27192 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
27193 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
27194 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
27195 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
27196 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
27197 without code changes in Exim.
27199 Exim's &(gsasl)& authenticator does not have client-side support at this
27200 time; only the server-side support is implemented. Patches welcome.
27203 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
27204 Do not set this true without consulting a cryptographic engineer.
27206 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
27207 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
27208 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
27209 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
27212 This should have meant that certificate identity and verification becomes a
27213 non-issue, as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and
27214 server to see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
27216 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
27217 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
27218 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
27220 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
27221 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
27222 of Exim might have switched the default to be true.
27224 However, Channel Binding in TLS has proven to be broken in current versions.
27225 Do not plan to rely upon this feature for security, ever, without consulting
27226 with a subject matter expert (a cryptographic engineer).
27229 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
27230 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27231 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27232 Some mechanisms will use this data.
27235 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
27236 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27237 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27238 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27243 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27244 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27245 server_set_id = $auth1
27249 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
27250 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
27251 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
27252 the password itself.
27254 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
27255 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
27256 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
27257 if available, else the empty string.
27258 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
27259 else the empty string.
27261 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
27263 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
27264 option to be simply "true".
27267 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
27268 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27269 Some mechanisms will use this data.
27272 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
27273 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27274 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
27275 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
27278 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
27279 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27280 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
27281 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
27284 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
27285 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27286 Some mechanisms will use this data.
27289 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
27290 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27291 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
27292 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
27294 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
27295 meanings for these variables:
27298 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
27299 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
27301 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
27302 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
27304 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
27305 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
27308 On a per-mechanism basis:
27311 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27312 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
27313 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27315 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27316 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
27317 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27319 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27320 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
27321 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
27322 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27325 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
27326 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
27327 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
27330 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
27331 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
27333 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
27335 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27336 server_realm = imap.example.org
27337 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
27338 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27339 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
27340 server_condition = yes
27344 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27345 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27347 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
27348 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
27349 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
27350 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27351 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
27352 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
27353 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
27356 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
27357 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
27358 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
27359 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27361 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
27362 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
27363 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
27364 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
27366 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
27367 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
27368 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
27372 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
27373 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
27374 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
27375 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
27377 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
27378 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
27379 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
27380 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
27382 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27384 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
27385 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
27387 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
27388 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
27389 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
27394 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27395 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27397 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
27398 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
27399 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
27400 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
27401 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
27402 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
27403 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
27404 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
27405 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
27406 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
27407 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
27408 taken from the Samba project (&url(https://www.samba.org/)). The code for the
27409 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
27413 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
27414 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
27416 The server sends back a challenge.
27418 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
27419 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
27422 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
27426 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
27427 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
27428 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
27430 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
27431 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
27432 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
27433 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
27434 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
27435 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
27436 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
27437 for other things. For example:
27442 server_password = \
27443 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
27445 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27446 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27452 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
27453 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
27454 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
27458 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
27459 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
27462 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
27463 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
27466 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
27467 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
27468 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
27474 client_username = msn/msn_username
27475 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
27476 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
27478 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
27479 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
27485 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27486 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27488 .chapter "The external authenticator" "CHAPexternauth"
27489 .scindex IIDexternauth1 "&(external)& authenticator"
27490 .scindex IIDexternauth2 "authenticators" "&(external)&"
27491 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27492 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
27493 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27494 The &(external)& authenticator provides support for
27495 authentication based on non-SMTP information.
27496 The specification is in RFC 4422 Appendix A
27497 (&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4422)).
27498 It is only a transport and negotiation mechanism;
27499 the process of authentication is entirely controlled
27500 by the server configuration.
27502 The client presents an identity in-clear.
27503 It is probably wise for a server to only advertise,
27504 and for clients to only attempt,
27505 this authentication method on a secure (eg. under TLS) connection.
27507 One possible use, compatible with the
27508 K-9 Mail Andoid client (&url(https://k9mail.github.io/)),
27509 is for using X509 client certificates.
27511 It thus overlaps in function with the TLS authenticator
27512 (see &<<CHAPtlsauth>>&)
27513 but is a full SMTP SASL authenticator
27514 rather than being implicit for TLS-connection carried
27515 client certificates only.
27517 The examples and discussion in this chapter assume that
27518 client-certificate authentication is being done.
27520 The client must present a certificate,
27521 for which it must have been requested via the
27522 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27523 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27524 For authentication to be effective the certificate should be
27525 verifiable against a trust-anchor certificate known to the server.
27527 .section "External options" "SECTexternsoptions"
27528 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (server)"
27529 The &(external)& authenticator has two server options:
27531 .option server_param2 external string&!! unset
27532 .option server_param3 external string&!! unset
27533 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27534 These options are expanded before the &%server_condition%& option
27535 and the result are placed in &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& resectively.
27536 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27537 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27539 They can be used to clarify the coding of a complex &%server_condition%&.
27541 .section "Using external in a server" "SECTexternserver"
27542 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27543 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
27544 "in &(external)& authenticator"
27545 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27546 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27548 When running as a server, &(external)& performs the authentication test by
27549 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
27550 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
27551 values when decoded. The decoded value is treated as
27552 an identity for authentication and
27553 placed in the expansion variable &$auth1$&.
27555 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the value is also placed in
27556 the expansion variable &$1$&. However, the use of this
27557 variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
27558 string expansions that also use them for other things.
27560 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27561 Once an identity has been received,
27562 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
27563 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
27564 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
27565 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
27566 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
27567 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
27568 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
27569 string as the error text.
27573 ext_ccert_san_mail:
27575 public_name = EXTERNAL
27577 server_advertise_condition = $tls_in_certificate_verified
27578 server_param2 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27579 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27580 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth2} \
27581 {eq {$item}{$auth1}}}
27582 server_set_id = $auth1
27584 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27585 of your configured trust-anchors
27586 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27587 and which has a mail-SAN matching the claimed identity sent by the client.
27589 Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
27590 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
27591 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
27593 Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
27596 .section "Using external in a client" "SECTexternclient"
27597 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (client)"
27598 The &(external)& authenticator has one client option:
27600 .option client_send external string&!! unset
27601 This option is expanded and sent with the AUTH command as the
27602 identity being asserted.
27608 public_name = EXTERNAL
27610 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
27611 client_send = myaccount@smarthost.example.net
27615 .ecindex IIDexternauth1
27616 .ecindex IIDexternauth2
27622 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27623 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27625 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
27626 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
27627 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
27628 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27629 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
27630 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27631 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
27632 authentication based on client certificates.
27634 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
27635 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
27636 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
27637 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
27638 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
27639 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
27641 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
27642 for which it must have been requested via the
27643 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27644 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27646 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
27647 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
27648 and can authenticate the connection.
27649 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
27651 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
27654 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
27655 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
27657 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
27658 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
27659 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
27660 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
27661 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27662 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27664 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
27665 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
27666 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
27668 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
27675 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27676 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27677 server_condition = ${if and { {eq{$tls_in_certificate_verified}{1}} \
27680 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
27681 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
27682 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
27684 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
27686 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27687 of your configured trust-anchors
27688 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27689 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
27691 Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
27692 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
27693 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
27695 Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
27697 . An alternative might use
27699 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
27701 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
27702 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
27703 . This would help for per-device use.
27705 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
27706 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
27708 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
27709 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
27712 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
27713 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
27714 a connect- or helo-ACL.
27718 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27719 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27721 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
27722 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
27723 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
27724 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
27725 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
27728 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
27729 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
27730 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
27731 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
27732 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
27733 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
27734 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
27735 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
27736 certificates are used.
27738 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
27739 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
27740 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
27741 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
27742 between them is encrypted.
27744 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
27745 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
27746 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
27747 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
27750 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
27751 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
27752 in order to get TLS to work.
27756 .section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
27758 .cindex "submissions protocol"
27759 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
27760 .cindex "smtps protocol"
27761 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
27762 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
27763 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
27764 The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
27765 contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
27766 allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
27767 instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
27768 by them in preference to STARTTLS.
27770 The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
27771 clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
27772 Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
27774 This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
27775 standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
27776 reassigned for other use.
27777 Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
27779 In practice, a number of mail-clients have only ever supported submissions,
27780 not submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
27781 Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
27783 Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
27784 global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
27785 the most common use is expected to be:
27787 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
27789 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
27790 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
27791 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
27792 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
27793 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
27796 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
27797 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
27804 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
27805 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
27806 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
27807 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
27808 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
27812 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
27816 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
27817 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
27819 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
27822 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
27823 cannot be the path of a directory
27824 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
27825 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
27827 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
27829 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27830 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
27831 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
27832 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
27833 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
27835 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
27836 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
27837 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
27838 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
27839 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
27840 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
27841 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
27844 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
27845 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
27847 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
27848 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
27849 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
27850 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
27852 With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option
27853 main option, it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
27855 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
27856 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
27857 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
27858 implementation, then patches are welcome.
27862 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
27863 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
27864 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
27865 but not the chosen filename.
27866 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
27867 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
27869 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
27870 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
27871 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
27872 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
27874 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
27875 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
27876 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
27877 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
27878 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
27879 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
27880 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
27882 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
27883 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
27884 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
27885 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
27886 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
27888 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
27889 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
27890 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
27891 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
27892 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
27893 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
27895 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
27896 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
27897 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
27899 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
27900 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
27901 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
27902 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
27905 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
27908 # chown exim:exim new-params
27909 # chmod 0600 new-params
27910 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
27911 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
27912 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
27913 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
27914 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
27915 # chmod 0400 new-params
27916 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
27918 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
27919 stalling is removed.
27921 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
27922 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
27923 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
27924 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
27925 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
27926 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
27927 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
27928 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
27929 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
27930 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
27931 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
27933 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
27934 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
27935 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
27936 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
27938 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
27939 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
27940 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
27941 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
27942 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
27945 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
27946 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
27947 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
27948 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
27949 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
27950 are acceptable for TLS versions prior to 1.3.
27951 The list is colon separated and may contain names like
27952 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
27953 directly to this function call.
27954 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
27955 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
27956 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
27957 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
27960 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
27962 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
27963 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
27964 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
27967 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
27968 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
27969 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
27973 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
27976 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
27977 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
27980 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
27981 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
27983 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
27984 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
27987 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
27988 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
27989 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
27990 not be moved to the end of the list.
27993 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
27996 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
27997 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
28000 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28001 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
28002 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
28003 choice of clients used:
28005 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
28006 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28011 This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
28013 tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
28016 For TLS version 1.3 the control available is less fine-grained
28017 and Exim does not provide access to it at present.
28018 The value of the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is ignored when
28019 TLS version 1.3 is negotiated.
28021 As of writing the library default cipher suite list for TLSv1.3 is
28023 TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
28027 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
28029 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
28030 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
28031 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
28032 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
28033 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
28034 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
28035 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
28036 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
28037 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
28038 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
28040 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
28041 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
28043 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
28044 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
28045 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
28046 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
28047 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
28048 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
28050 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
28051 "Priority strings". This is online as
28052 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
28053 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
28054 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
28055 then the example code
28056 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
28057 on that site can be used to test a given string.
28061 # Disable older versions of protocols
28062 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
28065 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
28066 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
28067 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
28069 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28070 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
28071 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
28072 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
28076 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28082 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
28083 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
28084 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
28085 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
28086 but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
28087 that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
28088 this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
28090 If STARTTLS is to be used you
28091 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
28093 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
28094 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
28095 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
28098 554 Security failure
28100 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
28101 rejected with a 554 error code.
28103 To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
28104 must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
28106 If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
28107 meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
28108 You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
28109 from someone able to intercept the communication.
28111 Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
28113 To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
28115 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
28116 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
28118 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
28119 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
28120 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
28121 that goes with it. These files need to be
28122 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
28123 always be given as full path names.
28124 The key must not be password-protected.
28125 They can be the same file if both the
28126 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
28127 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
28128 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
28129 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
28130 the server's certificate.
28132 For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
28133 colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
28134 algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
28135 public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
28136 client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
28137 ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
28139 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
28140 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
28141 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
28143 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
28144 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
28145 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
28148 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
28149 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
28150 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
28152 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
28154 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
28155 with the parameters contained in the file.
28156 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
28161 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
28162 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
28163 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
28164 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
28170 for a way of generating file data.
28172 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
28173 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
28174 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
28175 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
28176 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
28178 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
28179 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28180 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
28181 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
28182 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
28183 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
28184 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
28185 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
28186 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
28188 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
28189 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
28190 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
28191 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
28192 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
28193 documentation for more details.
28195 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
28196 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
28199 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
28200 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
28201 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
28202 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
28203 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
28204 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
28205 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
28206 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
28207 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
28208 expected trust-anchors or certificates.
28209 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
28210 an explicit file or,
28211 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
28212 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
28214 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
28217 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
28218 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
28219 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
28221 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
28223 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
28225 There is no checking of names of the client against the certificate
28226 Subject Name or Subject Alternate Names.
28228 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
28229 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
28230 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
28231 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
28232 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
28233 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
28234 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
28235 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
28236 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
28237 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
28239 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
28240 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
28241 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
28242 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
28244 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28245 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
28246 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
28247 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
28248 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
28249 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
28252 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
28253 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
28254 .cindex "revocation list"
28255 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
28256 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
28257 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
28258 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
28259 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
28260 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
28261 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
28263 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
28264 file from every certificate authority they know of.
28266 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
28267 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
28268 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
28269 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
28270 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
28271 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
28273 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
28274 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
28275 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
28276 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
28278 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
28279 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
28280 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
28281 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
28282 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
28283 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
28284 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
28285 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
28287 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
28288 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
28289 support for OCSP stapling is included.
28291 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28292 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
28293 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
28294 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
28295 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
28297 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
28298 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
28299 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
28300 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
28301 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
28304 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
28305 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
28308 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
28309 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
28310 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
28311 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
28312 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
28313 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28315 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
28316 not any of the chain from CA to it.
28318 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
28321 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
28322 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
28323 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
28325 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
28326 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
28327 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
28333 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECTclientTLS"
28334 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
28335 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28336 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28337 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
28338 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
28339 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
28340 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
28341 within the &(smtp)& transport.
28343 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
28344 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
28345 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
28346 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
28347 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
28349 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
28350 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
28351 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
28352 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
28353 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
28356 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
28357 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
28358 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
28359 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
28360 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
28361 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
28362 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
28363 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
28364 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
28365 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
28368 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
28369 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
28370 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
28371 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
28373 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
28374 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
28376 the system default set (depending on library version),
28378 or (depending on library version) a directory.
28379 The client verifies the server's certificate
28380 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
28381 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
28382 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
28383 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
28385 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
28386 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
28387 or need not succeed respectively.
28389 The &%tls_verify_cert_hostnames%& option lists hosts for which additional
28390 checks are made: that the host name (the one in the DNS A record)
28391 is valid for the certificate.
28392 The option defaults to always checking.
28394 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
28395 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
28396 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
28398 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
28399 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
28400 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
28403 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
28404 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
28405 for OCSP to be relevant.
28408 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
28409 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
28410 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
28411 alternative hosts, if any.
28414 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
28415 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
28416 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
28420 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
28421 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
28422 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
28423 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
28424 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
28426 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
28427 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
28428 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
28429 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
28430 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
28431 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
28432 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
28433 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
28434 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
28435 outgoing connection.
28439 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
28440 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
28441 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
28442 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
28443 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
28444 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
28445 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
28446 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
28447 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
28448 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
28451 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
28452 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
28455 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
28456 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
28457 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
28458 be of limited use in that environment.
28460 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
28461 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
28462 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
28463 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
28464 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
28466 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
28467 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
28468 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
28469 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
28470 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
28472 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
28473 received from a client.
28474 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
28476 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
28477 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
28478 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
28481 &%tls_certificate%&
28487 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
28492 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
28493 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
28494 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
28495 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
28496 Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI is arrived, so
28497 an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
28498 when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
28500 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
28503 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
28504 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
28505 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
28506 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
28508 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
28509 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
28510 built, then you have SNI support).
28514 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
28516 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
28517 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
28518 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
28519 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
28520 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
28521 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
28522 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
28523 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
28524 starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
28525 unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
28527 An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
28528 &%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
28529 this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
28530 shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
28531 before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
28532 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
28533 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
28535 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
28536 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
28537 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
28538 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
28539 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
28540 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
28541 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
28542 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
28543 and delay other deliveries to that host.
28545 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
28546 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
28547 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
28548 information is recorded.
28550 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
28551 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
28552 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
28557 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
28558 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
28559 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
28560 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities.
28561 This is a large topic and an introductory guide is unsuitable for the Exim
28562 reference manual, so instead we provide pointers to existing documentation.
28564 The Apache web-server was for a long time the canonical guide, so their
28565 documentation is a good place to start; their SSL module's Introduction
28566 document is currently at
28568 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_intro.html)
28570 and their FAQ is at
28572 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_faq.html)
28575 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
28576 0-201-61598-3) in 2001, contains both introductory and more in-depth
28578 More recently Ivan Ristić's book &'Bulletproof SSL and TLS'&,
28579 published by Feisty Duck (ISBN 978-1907117046) in 2013 is good.
28580 Ivan is the author of the popular TLS testing tools at
28581 &url(https://www.ssllabs.com/).
28584 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
28585 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
28586 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
28587 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
28588 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
28589 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
28590 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
28591 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
28592 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
28593 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
28594 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
28595 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
28596 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
28598 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
28599 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
28600 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
28601 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
28605 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
28606 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
28607 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
28608 with OpenSSL, like this:
28609 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
28610 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
28612 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
28615 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
28616 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
28617 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
28618 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
28619 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
28620 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
28621 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
28623 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
28624 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
28625 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
28626 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
28627 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
28628 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
28630 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
28631 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
28632 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
28633 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
28634 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
28635 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
28636 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
28637 be a sensible resolution).
28639 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
28640 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
28641 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
28643 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
28644 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
28645 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
28646 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
28647 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
28648 signed with that self-signed certificate.
28650 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
28651 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
28652 Open-source PKI book, available online at
28653 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/ospkibook/).
28654 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
28655 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
28659 .section DANE "SECDANE"
28661 DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
28662 it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
28663 operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
28664 you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
28665 Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
28666 certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
28668 What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
28669 that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
28670 by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
28672 It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
28673 fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
28675 DANE scales better than having to maintain (and side-channel communicate) copies of server certificates
28676 for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
28677 client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
28679 DANE requires a server operator to do three things: 1) run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
28680 that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
28681 to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
28683 2) add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
28684 3) offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
28686 There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
28687 Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
28688 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
28689 If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
28691 The TLSA record for the server may have "certificate usage" of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3).
28692 These are the "Trust Anchor" and "End Entity" variants.
28693 The latter specifies the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server
28694 (and if only DANE-EE is used then it should be the sole one transmitted during the TLS handshake);
28695 this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
28696 DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
28698 A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate (with certain
28699 attributes) which is used to sign server certificates, but running one securely
28700 does require careful arrangement.
28701 With DANE-TA, as implemented in Exim and commonly in other MTAs,
28702 the server TLS handshake must transmit the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate.
28703 DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
28704 all of which point to a single TLSA record.
28705 DANE-TA and DANE-EE can both be used together.
28707 Our recommendation is to use DANE with a certificate from a public CA,
28708 because this enables a variety of strategies for remote clients to verify
28710 You can then publish information both via DANE and another technology,
28711 "MTA-STS", described below.
28713 When you use DANE-TA to publish trust anchor information, you ask entities
28714 outside your administrative control to trust the Certificate Authority for
28715 connections to you.
28716 If using a private CA then you should expect others to still apply the
28717 technical criteria they'd use for a public CA to your certificates.
28718 In particular, you should probably try to follow current best practices for CA
28719 operation around hash algorithms and key sizes.
28720 Do not expect other organizations to lower their security expectations just
28721 because a particular profile might be reasonable for your own internal use.
28723 When this text was last updated, this in practice means to avoid use of SHA-1
28724 and MD5; if using RSA to use key sizes of at least 2048 bits (and no larger
28725 than 4096, for interoperability); to use keyUsage fields correctly; to use
28726 random serial numbers.
28727 The list of requirements is subject to change as best practices evolve.
28728 If you're not already using a private CA, or it doesn't meet these
28729 requirements, then we encourage you to avoid all these issues and use a public
28730 CA such as &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt) instead.
28732 The TLSA record should have a Selector field of SPKI(1) and a Matching Type field of SHA2-512(2).
28734 At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
28735 is useful for quickly generating TLSA records; and commands like
28738 openssl x509 -in -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
28739 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
28744 are workable for 4th-field hashes.
28746 For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
28748 The Certificate issued by the CA published in the DANE-TA model should be
28749 issued using a strong hash algorithm.
28750 Exim, and importantly various other MTAs sending to you, will not
28751 re-enable hash algorithms which have been disabled by default in TLS
28753 This means no MD5 and no SHA-1. SHA2-256 is the minimum for reliable
28754 interoperability (and probably the maximum too, in 2018).
28756 The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
28757 be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
28758 default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
28761 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
28762 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
28766 The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
28767 The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
28768 found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
28769 string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
28770 control the OCSP request.
28772 This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
28773 those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
28776 For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
28777 and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
28778 The require variant will result in failure if the target host is not DNSSEC-secured.
28780 DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
28782 A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using dnssec.
28783 If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
28784 will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
28785 be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
28787 If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
28788 prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
28789 back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
28790 This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
28791 crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
28792 which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
28793 limited to ciphersuite constraints.
28795 If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
28799 tls_try_verify_hosts
28800 tls_verify_certificates
28802 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
28805 If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
28806 verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
28808 Currently the &%dnssec_request_domains%& must be active and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
28810 If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
28812 There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
28813 verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
28814 in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
28815 and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
28817 .cindex DANE reporting
28818 An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
28819 to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
28820 required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
28821 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
28822 The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
28823 Section 4.3 of that document.
28825 Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
28827 DANE is specified in published RFCs and decouples certificate authority trust
28828 selection from a "race to the bottom" of "you must trust everything for mail
28829 to get through". There is an alternative technology called MTA-STS, which
28830 instead publishes MX trust anchor information on an HTTPS website. At the
28831 time this text was last updated, MTA-STS was still a draft, not yet an RFC.
28832 Exim has no support for MTA-STS as a client, but Exim mail server operators
28833 can choose to publish information describing their TLS configuration using
28834 MTA-STS to let those clients who do use that protocol derive trust
28837 The MTA-STS design requires a certificate from a public Certificate Authority
28838 which is recognized by clients sending to you.
28839 That selection of which CAs are trusted by others is outside your control.
28841 The most interoperable course of action is probably to use
28842 &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt), with automated certificate
28843 renewal; to publish the anchor information in DNSSEC-secured DNS via TLSA
28844 records for DANE clients (such as Exim and Postfix) and to publish anchor
28845 information for MTA-STS as well. This is what is done for the &'exim.org'&
28846 domain itself (with caveats around occasionally broken MTA-STS because of
28847 incompatible specification changes prior to reaching RFC status).
28851 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28852 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28854 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
28855 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
28856 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
28857 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
28858 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
28859 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the runtime
28860 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
28861 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
28862 one very small ACL:
28866 accept hosts = one.host.only
28868 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
28869 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
28871 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
28872 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
28873 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
28874 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
28875 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
28876 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
28877 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
28878 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
28881 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
28882 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
28883 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
28886 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
28887 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
28888 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
28889 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
28890 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
28891 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
28892 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
28893 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
28894 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
28895 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
28896 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
28897 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
28898 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
28899 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
28900 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
28901 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
28902 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
28903 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
28904 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
28905 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
28908 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
28909 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
28910 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
28911 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
28912 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
28913 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
28914 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
28915 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
28916 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
28917 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
28918 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
28919 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
28920 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
28921 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
28922 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
28923 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
28924 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
28925 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
28926 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
28927 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
28930 For example, if you set
28932 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
28934 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
28935 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
28936 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
28937 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
28938 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
28939 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
28940 testing as possible at RCPT time.
28943 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
28944 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
28945 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
28946 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
28947 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
28948 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
28949 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
28950 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
28951 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
28952 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
28953 in any of these ACLs.
28955 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
28956 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
28957 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
28958 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
28959 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
28960 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
28961 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
28962 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
28964 control = suppress_local_fixups
28966 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
28967 run, it is too late.
28969 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28970 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28972 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
28973 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
28974 temporary error for these kinds of message.
28977 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
28978 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
28979 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
28980 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
28981 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
28982 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
28983 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
28984 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
28985 &%smtp_banner%& option.
28988 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
28989 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
28990 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
28991 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
28992 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
28993 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
28994 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
28995 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
28996 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
28998 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
28999 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
29000 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
29002 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
29003 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
29004 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
29005 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
29009 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
29010 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
29011 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
29012 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
29013 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
29014 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
29015 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
29016 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
29017 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
29018 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
29020 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
29021 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
29022 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
29023 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
29024 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
29025 associated with the DATA command.
29027 .cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
29028 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
29029 .cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
29030 If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
29031 the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
29032 . XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
29033 The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
29034 the data specified is received.
29036 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
29037 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
29038 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
29039 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
29040 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
29043 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
29044 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
29045 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
29046 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
29048 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
29049 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
29050 enabled (which is the default).
29052 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
29053 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
29054 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
29056 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29058 For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
29061 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
29062 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29063 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29065 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29068 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
29069 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29070 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
29071 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
29072 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
29073 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
29074 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
29077 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
29078 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
29079 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
29080 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
29081 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
29082 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
29083 for some or all recipients.
29085 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
29086 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
29087 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
29088 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
29089 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
29091 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
29092 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
29093 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
29095 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
29096 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
29098 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29099 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
29100 the feature was not requested by the client.
29102 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
29103 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
29104 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
29105 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
29106 does not in fact control any access.
29107 For this reason, it may only accept
29108 or warn as its final result.
29110 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
29111 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
29112 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
29113 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
29115 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
29116 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
29118 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
29119 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
29122 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
29123 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
29124 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
29125 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
29126 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
29129 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
29130 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
29131 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
29132 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
29133 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
29134 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
29135 situation even worse.
29137 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
29138 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
29139 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
29142 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
29143 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
29144 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
29145 connection. The possible values are:
29147 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
29148 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
29149 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
29150 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
29151 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
29152 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
29153 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
29154 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
29155 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
29156 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
29158 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
29159 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
29160 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
29161 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
29162 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
29166 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
29167 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
29168 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
29169 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
29171 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
29172 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
29174 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
29175 providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
29176 an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
29177 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
29178 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
29180 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
29181 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
29182 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
29185 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a filename, and reads its
29186 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
29187 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
29188 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
29189 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
29190 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
29192 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
29193 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
29194 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
29196 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
29197 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
29198 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
29199 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
29201 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
29202 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
29203 matches the string.
29205 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
29206 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
29207 want to have something like
29209 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
29211 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
29212 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
29218 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
29219 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
29220 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
29221 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
29222 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
29223 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
29224 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
29225 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
29226 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
29228 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
29229 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
29230 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
29233 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
29234 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
29235 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
29236 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
29238 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
29239 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
29240 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
29241 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
29242 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
29243 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
29244 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
29246 If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
29247 is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
29250 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
29251 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
29252 recipients; it may create new recipients.
29256 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
29257 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
29258 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
29259 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
29260 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
29261 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
29263 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
29264 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
29265 used to accept or reject anything.
29267 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
29268 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
29269 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
29270 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
29272 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
29273 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
29274 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
29275 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
29276 configuration file.
29281 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
29282 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
29284 .vindex &$local_part$&
29285 .vindex &$sender_address$&
29286 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
29287 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
29288 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
29289 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
29290 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
29291 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
29292 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
29293 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
29295 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
29296 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
29297 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
29300 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
29301 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
29302 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
29303 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
29304 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
29307 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
29308 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
29309 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
29310 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
29311 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
29312 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
29313 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
29314 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
29320 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
29321 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
29322 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
29323 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
29324 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
29325 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
29326 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
29327 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
29328 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
29329 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
29330 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
29331 unencrypted connections.
29334 accept encrypted = *
29335 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
29337 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
29339 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
29340 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
29341 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
29342 option to do this.)
29346 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
29347 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
29348 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
29349 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
29350 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
29351 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
29352 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
29354 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
29355 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
29356 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
29359 deny dnslists = list1.example
29360 dnslists = list2.example
29362 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
29363 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
29364 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
29365 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
29366 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
29369 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
29370 The ACL verbs are as follows:
29373 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
29374 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
29375 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
29376 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
29377 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
29378 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
29379 check a RCPT command:
29381 accept domains = +local_domains
29385 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
29386 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
29387 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
29388 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
29391 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
29392 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
29393 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
29396 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
29397 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
29398 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
29399 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
29400 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
29401 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
29403 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
29404 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
29406 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
29407 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
29408 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
29410 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
29411 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
29412 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
29417 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
29418 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
29419 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
29420 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
29421 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
29422 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
29423 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
29427 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
29428 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
29429 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
29432 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29434 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
29438 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
29439 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
29440 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
29441 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
29442 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
29443 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
29444 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
29445 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
29446 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
29448 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
29449 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
29450 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
29454 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
29455 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
29456 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
29458 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
29459 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
29461 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
29462 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
29465 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
29466 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
29467 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
29468 example, when checking a RCPT command,
29470 require message = Sender did not verify
29473 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
29474 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
29475 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
29476 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
29479 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
29480 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
29481 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
29482 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
29483 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
29484 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
29485 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
29487 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
29488 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
29489 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
29490 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
29491 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29493 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
29494 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
29495 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
29496 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
29497 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
29498 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
29502 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29503 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
29504 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
29505 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
29507 warn !verify = sender
29508 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
29512 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
29514 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
29515 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
29516 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
29517 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
29518 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
29522 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
29523 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
29524 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
29525 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
29526 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
29527 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
29528 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
29529 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
29530 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
29531 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
29533 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
29534 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
29535 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
29536 on the same SMTP connection.
29538 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
29539 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
29540 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
29543 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
29544 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
29545 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
29547 accept hosts = whatever
29548 set acl_m4 = some value
29549 accept authenticated = *
29550 set acl_c_auth = yes
29552 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
29553 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
29554 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
29556 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
29557 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
29558 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
29559 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
29560 error is generated.
29562 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
29563 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
29566 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
29567 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
29568 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
29569 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
29571 deny domains = *.dom.example
29572 !verify = recipient
29574 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
29575 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
29576 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
29577 two statements are equivalent:
29579 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
29580 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
29582 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
29583 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
29585 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
29586 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
29587 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
29589 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
29590 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
29591 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
29592 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
29594 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
29595 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
29596 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
29597 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
29598 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
29599 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
29600 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
29602 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
29603 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
29604 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
29605 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
29606 message is handled.
29608 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
29609 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
29610 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
29611 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
29613 require message = Can't verify sender
29615 message = Can't verify recipient
29617 message = This message cannot be used
29619 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
29620 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
29621 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
29622 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
29623 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
29624 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
29626 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
29627 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
29628 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
29629 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
29632 !senders = *@my.domain.example
29633 message = Invalid sender from client host
29635 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
29636 by which time Exim has set up the message.
29640 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
29641 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
29642 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
29645 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29646 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
29647 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
29648 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29650 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29651 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
29652 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
29653 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
29654 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
29655 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
29656 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
29657 write rather ugly lines like this:
29659 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
29661 Instead, all you need is
29663 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
29666 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29667 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29668 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
29669 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
29670 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
29671 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
29672 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
29673 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
29675 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
29676 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
29677 in several different ways. For example:
29679 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
29680 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
29681 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
29685 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
29687 accept ...some conditions
29688 control = queue_only
29690 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
29691 other words, when the conditions are all true.
29694 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
29696 accept ...some conditions...
29697 control = queue_only
29698 ...some more conditions...
29700 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
29701 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
29702 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
29706 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
29707 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
29710 warn ...some conditions...
29714 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
29715 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
29719 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
29720 &%require%& verb. For example:
29722 require control = no_multiline_responses
29726 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
29727 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
29729 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
29730 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
29731 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
29732 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
29733 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
29734 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
29736 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
29739 deny ...some conditions...
29742 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
29743 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
29746 ...some conditions...
29748 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
29749 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
29751 warn ...some conditions...
29757 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
29758 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
29759 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
29760 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
29761 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
29762 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
29763 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
29767 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
29768 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
29769 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
29770 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
29771 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
29772 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
29773 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
29776 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29777 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
29778 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
29779 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
29781 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
29782 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
29784 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
29787 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
29788 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
29790 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
29791 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
29792 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
29795 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
29796 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
29797 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
29798 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
29799 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
29800 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
29803 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29804 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
29805 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
29808 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
29809 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
29810 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
29811 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
29812 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
29813 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
29815 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
29816 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
29817 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
29818 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
29819 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
29820 logging rejections.
29823 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
29824 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
29825 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
29826 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
29827 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
29828 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
29829 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
29830 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
29832 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
29833 &` log_reject_target =`&
29835 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
29836 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
29840 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29841 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
29842 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
29843 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
29844 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
29845 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
29846 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
29849 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
29850 &` control = freeze`&
29851 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
29853 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
29854 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
29855 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
29858 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
29859 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
29863 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29864 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
29865 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
29866 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
29867 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
29868 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
29869 &%accept%& for details.)
29871 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
29872 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
29873 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
29874 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
29875 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
29877 require message = Host not recognized
29880 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
29883 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
29884 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
29885 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
29886 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
29887 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
29888 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
29889 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
29890 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
29891 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
29894 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
29895 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
29896 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
29898 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
29899 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
29901 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
29902 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
29903 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
29906 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
29907 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
29909 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
29910 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
29911 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
29914 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29915 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
29916 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
29918 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
29919 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
29920 However, the original message is available in the variable
29921 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
29922 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
29923 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
29924 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
29926 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
29927 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
29928 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
29929 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
29930 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
29931 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
29935 .vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29936 .cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
29937 .cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
29938 This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
29940 It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
29942 This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
29943 of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
29944 Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
29945 If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
29948 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29949 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
29950 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
29951 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
29954 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
29955 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
29956 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
29957 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
29960 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
29961 .cindex "UDP communications"
29962 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
29963 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
29964 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
29965 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
29966 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
29967 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
29968 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
29971 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
29972 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
29979 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
29980 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29981 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
29984 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
29985 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
29986 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
29987 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
29988 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
29989 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
29990 not work without it. For example:
29992 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
29993 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
29995 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
29996 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
29997 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
29998 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
29999 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
30002 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
30003 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
30004 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
30005 .cindex "case of local parts"
30006 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
30007 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
30008 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
30009 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
30010 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
30011 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
30014 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
30015 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
30016 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
30017 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
30018 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
30020 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
30021 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
30024 warn control = caseful_local_part
30025 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
30027 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
30029 control = caselower_local_part
30031 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
30032 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
30035 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
30036 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
30037 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
30038 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
30040 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
30041 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
30042 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
30043 is used for all recipients of the message,
30044 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
30045 and data is copied from one to the other.
30047 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
30048 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
30049 If a recipient-verify callout
30051 connection is subsequently
30052 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
30053 any subsequent recipients and the data,
30054 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
30056 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
30057 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
30058 Note also that headers cannot be
30059 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
30060 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
30061 The &'Received-By:'& header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
30062 rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
30063 this will affect the timestamp.
30065 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
30066 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
30067 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
30068 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
30071 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
30072 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
30073 before the entire message has been received from the source.
30074 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
30078 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
30079 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
30080 If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
30081 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
30082 before the acceptance "<=" line.
30084 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
30086 This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
30087 to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
30088 &"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
30089 and does not queue the message.
30090 Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
30092 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
30094 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
30097 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
30098 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
30099 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
30100 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
30101 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
30102 by default called &'debuglog'&.
30103 The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
30104 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
30105 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
30107 Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
30108 with the &'kill'& option.
30109 Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
30113 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
30114 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
30115 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
30116 control = debug/kill
30120 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
30121 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
30122 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
30123 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
30124 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
30127 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
30128 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
30129 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
30130 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
30131 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
30132 strings or to numeric value.
30133 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
30134 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
30135 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
30137 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
30138 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
30139 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
30140 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
30141 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
30144 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
30145 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
30146 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
30147 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
30148 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
30149 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
30150 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
30151 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
30153 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
30154 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
30155 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
30156 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
30157 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
30158 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
30162 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
30163 .cindex "fake defer"
30164 .cindex "defer, fake"
30165 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
30166 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
30167 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
30168 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
30169 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
30171 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
30172 .cindex "fake rejection"
30173 .cindex "rejection, fake"
30174 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
30175 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
30176 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
30177 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
30178 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30179 the same SMTP connection.
30181 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
30182 message is supplied, the following is used:
30184 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
30185 550-kept for evaluation.
30186 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
30187 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
30189 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
30191 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
30192 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
30193 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30194 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30195 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
30196 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
30199 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
30200 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
30201 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
30202 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
30204 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
30205 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
30206 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
30207 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30208 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
30209 disables such output flushing.
30211 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
30212 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30213 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
30214 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30215 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
30216 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
30218 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
30219 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
30220 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
30221 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
30222 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
30223 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
30224 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30225 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
30226 to be useful in production.
30228 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
30229 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
30230 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
30231 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
30232 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
30234 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
30235 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
30236 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
30237 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
30238 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
30239 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
30242 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
30243 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
30244 verification failed"&) is sent.
30246 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
30250 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
30251 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
30253 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
30254 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
30255 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
30256 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
30257 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
30258 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
30259 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
30261 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
30262 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
30263 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
30264 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30265 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30266 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
30267 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
30268 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
30269 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
30270 same SMTP connection.
30272 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
30273 .cindex "message" "submission"
30274 .cindex "submission mode"
30275 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
30276 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
30277 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
30278 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
30279 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
30280 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
30281 late (the message has already been created).
30283 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
30284 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
30285 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
30286 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
30287 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
30289 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
30290 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
30291 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
30292 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
30293 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
30296 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
30297 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
30299 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
30301 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
30304 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
30305 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
30306 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
30307 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
30310 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
30311 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
30313 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
30314 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
30316 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
30320 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
30321 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
30324 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
30326 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
30327 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
30329 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
30331 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
30336 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
30337 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
30338 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
30339 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
30340 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
30341 to an incoming message, as in this example:
30343 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30344 dialup.mail-abuse.org
30345 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
30347 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
30348 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
30349 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
30350 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
30351 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
30354 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
30355 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
30357 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
30358 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
30359 contains one or more newlines that
30360 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
30361 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
30362 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
30364 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
30365 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
30366 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
30367 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
30368 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
30369 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
30370 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
30371 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
30372 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
30373 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
30374 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
30376 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
30377 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
30379 until they are added to the
30380 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
30381 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
30382 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
30383 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
30384 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
30385 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
30386 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
30388 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
30390 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
30391 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
30393 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30394 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
30396 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
30397 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30399 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
30400 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
30401 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
30402 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
30405 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
30406 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
30407 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
30408 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
30409 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
30410 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
30411 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
30414 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
30415 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
30416 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
30417 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
30418 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
30420 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
30421 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
30422 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
30423 to be a header name first.) For example:
30425 warn add_header = \
30426 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
30428 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
30429 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
30430 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
30431 up in reverse order.
30433 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
30434 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
30435 system filter or in a router or transport.
30439 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
30440 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
30441 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
30442 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
30443 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
30444 from an incoming message, as in this example:
30446 warn message = Remove internal headers
30447 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
30449 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
30450 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
30451 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
30452 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
30453 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
30454 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
30456 Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
30457 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
30459 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
30460 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
30461 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
30462 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
30463 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
30465 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
30466 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
30467 warn message = Remove internal headers
30468 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
30470 Header names for removal are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
30471 Matching header lines are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
30472 If multiple header lines match, all are removed.
30473 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor in removing
30474 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
30475 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
30476 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
30477 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
30478 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
30479 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
30480 would have been removed.
30482 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
30483 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
30484 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
30485 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
30486 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
30487 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
30488 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
30489 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
30490 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
30492 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
30493 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
30495 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
30496 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
30498 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
30499 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
30501 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
30502 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
30503 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
30504 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
30507 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
30508 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
30509 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
30514 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
30515 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
30516 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
30517 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
30518 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
30519 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30521 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
30522 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
30523 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
30524 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
30525 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
30526 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
30527 The conditions are as follows:
30531 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
30532 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
30533 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
30534 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
30535 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
30536 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
30537 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
30538 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
30539 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
30540 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
30541 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
30542 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
30544 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
30545 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
30546 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
30547 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
30548 The name and values are expanded separately.
30549 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
30550 will act as argument separators.
30552 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
30553 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
30554 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
30555 conditions are tested.
30557 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
30558 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
30559 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
30560 for different local users or different local domains.
30562 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30563 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
30564 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
30565 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
30566 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
30567 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
30568 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
30573 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
30574 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
30575 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
30576 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
30577 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
30578 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
30579 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
30580 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
30581 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
30582 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
30583 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
30584 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
30587 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
30588 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
30589 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30590 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30591 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
30592 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
30593 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
30594 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30596 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
30597 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
30598 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
30599 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
30600 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
30601 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
30602 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
30603 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
30604 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
30605 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
30607 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30608 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
30609 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
30610 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
30611 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
30612 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
30613 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
30614 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
30615 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
30618 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
30619 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
30622 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30623 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
30624 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
30625 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
30626 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
30627 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
30628 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
30634 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
30635 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
30636 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
30637 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
30638 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
30639 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
30640 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
30642 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30644 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
30645 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
30646 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
30648 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
30649 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
30650 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
30651 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
30652 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
30653 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
30655 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
30656 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
30658 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30659 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
30661 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
30662 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
30663 statement can then check the IP address.
30665 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
30666 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
30667 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
30668 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
30670 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
30671 message = $host_data
30673 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
30675 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
30676 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
30677 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
30678 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
30679 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
30680 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
30681 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
30682 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
30683 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
30684 the next &%local_parts%& test.
30686 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
30687 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
30688 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
30689 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
30690 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30691 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
30692 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30694 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30695 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
30696 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30697 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30698 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30699 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
30700 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
30703 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
30704 .cindex "rate limiting"
30705 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
30706 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
30708 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30709 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
30710 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
30711 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
30712 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
30713 recipient address against a list of recipients.
30715 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30716 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
30717 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30718 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30719 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
30720 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
30721 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30723 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30724 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
30725 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30726 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
30727 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30728 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
30729 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
30730 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
30731 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
30732 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
30733 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
30734 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
30735 influence the sender checking.
30737 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30738 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30740 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30741 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
30742 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30743 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
30744 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
30745 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
30749 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30750 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30752 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
30753 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
30754 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
30755 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30756 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
30757 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30759 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
30760 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30761 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
30762 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
30763 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
30764 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
30765 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
30766 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
30767 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
30768 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
30770 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
30771 .cindex "CSA verification"
30772 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
30773 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
30774 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
30776 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
30777 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30778 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
30779 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
30780 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
30781 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30782 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30783 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
30784 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
30785 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
30787 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
30788 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
30789 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
30791 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
30792 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30793 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
30794 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
30795 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
30796 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
30797 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30798 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30799 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
30800 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
30801 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
30802 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
30803 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
30804 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
30805 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
30807 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
30808 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
30809 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
30810 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
30813 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
30814 !verify = header_sender
30817 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
30818 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30819 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
30820 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
30821 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
30822 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30823 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30824 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
30825 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
30826 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
30827 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
30828 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
30829 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
30832 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
30833 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
30837 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
30838 common as they used to be.
30840 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
30841 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30842 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
30843 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
30844 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
30845 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
30846 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
30847 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
30848 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
30849 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
30850 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
30851 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
30852 independently of this condition.
30854 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
30855 option), this condition is always true.
30858 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind/*&<&'options'&>
30859 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
30860 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
30861 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
30862 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
30863 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
30864 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
30865 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
30866 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
30869 There is one possible option, &`case_insensitive`&. If this is present then
30870 local parts are checked case-insensitively.
30873 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
30874 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
30877 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
30878 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30879 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
30880 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
30881 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
30882 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
30883 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
30884 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
30885 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
30886 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
30887 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
30888 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
30889 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
30890 value for the child address.
30892 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
30893 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30894 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
30895 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
30896 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
30897 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
30898 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
30899 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
30900 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
30901 original IP address.
30903 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
30904 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
30906 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
30907 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
30909 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
30910 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30911 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
30912 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
30913 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
30914 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
30915 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
30916 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
30917 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
30919 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
30920 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
30921 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
30922 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
30923 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
30924 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
30925 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
30927 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
30928 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
30929 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
30931 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
30932 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30933 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
30934 verified as a sender.
30936 Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
30937 (eg. is generated from the received message)
30938 they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
30940 verify = sender=${sg{${address:$h_sender:}}{/}{//}}
30946 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
30947 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
30948 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
30949 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
30950 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
30951 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
30952 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
30953 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
30954 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
30955 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
30957 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
30958 dialups.mail-abuse.org
30960 the following records are looked up:
30962 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30963 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
30965 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
30966 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
30967 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
30968 use two separate conditions:
30970 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30971 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
30973 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
30974 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
30975 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
30978 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
30979 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
30980 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
30981 following special items in the list:
30983 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
30984 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
30985 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
30987 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
30988 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
30989 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
30990 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
30992 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
30994 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
30995 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
30997 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30998 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
30999 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
31001 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
31003 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
31004 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
31005 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
31006 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
31007 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
31008 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
31010 There are a number of DNS lists to choose from, some commercial, some free,
31011 or free for small deployments. An overview can be found at
31012 &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Comparison_of_DNS_blacklists).
31016 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
31017 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
31018 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
31019 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
31020 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
31022 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
31024 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
31025 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
31026 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
31027 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
31032 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
31033 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
31034 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
31035 addresses (see, e.g., the &'domain based zones'& link at
31036 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
31037 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
31038 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
31040 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
31041 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31043 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
31044 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
31045 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
31046 up by this example is
31048 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
31050 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
31051 addresses. For example:
31053 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31054 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31056 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
31057 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
31062 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
31063 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
31064 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
31065 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
31066 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
31067 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
31068 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
31069 either to double the separators like this:
31071 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
31073 or to change the separator character, like this:
31075 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
31077 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
31078 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
31079 occurs. Consider this condition:
31081 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
31083 The DNS lookups that occur are:
31085 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
31086 a.domain.black.list.tld
31088 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
31089 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
31090 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
31091 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
31092 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
31093 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
31094 error for a previous item.
31096 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
31097 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
31099 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
31100 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
31102 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
31103 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
31105 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
31106 $sender_address_domain \
31107 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
31109 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
31110 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
31111 $sender_address_domain} }} }
31113 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
31114 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
31115 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
31116 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
31118 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
31120 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
31121 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
31123 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
31124 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
31129 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
31130 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
31131 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
31132 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
31133 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
31134 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
31138 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
31140 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
31141 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
31142 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
31144 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
31145 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
31146 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
31149 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
31150 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
31151 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
31152 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
31153 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
31154 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
31155 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
31156 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
31157 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
31158 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
31159 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
31160 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
31161 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
31162 cases, for example:
31164 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
31166 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
31167 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
31168 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
31169 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
31171 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
31173 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
31174 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
31176 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
31177 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
31178 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
31179 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
31180 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
31183 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
31184 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
31185 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
31187 deny hosts = !+local_networks
31188 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
31190 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
31195 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
31196 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
31197 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
31198 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
31201 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
31203 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
31204 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
31205 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
31206 describes how multiple records are handled.
31208 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
31209 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
31210 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
31212 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31214 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
31215 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
31216 first. For example:
31218 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
31219 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
31222 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
31223 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
31224 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
31225 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
31226 tested. For example:
31228 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
31230 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
31231 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
31232 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
31234 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
31236 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
31241 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
31242 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
31245 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31247 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31248 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
31250 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31252 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31253 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
31254 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
31255 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
31257 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
31258 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
31260 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
31261 previous example is precisely equivalent to
31263 deny dnslists = a.b.c
31264 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31266 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
31267 Consider this example:
31269 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31271 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
31274 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
31276 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31278 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
31279 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
31280 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
31282 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
31287 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
31288 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
31289 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
31290 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
31291 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
31292 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
31294 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
31296 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
31297 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
31298 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
31299 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
31300 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
31301 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
31304 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
31305 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
31306 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
31308 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
31309 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
31312 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
31314 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31315 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
31317 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
31319 for the condition to be true.
31322 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
31323 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
31325 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
31326 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
31328 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
31330 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31331 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
31333 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
31334 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
31336 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
31338 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31339 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
31341 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
31343 for the condition to be false.
31345 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
31346 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
31351 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
31352 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
31353 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
31354 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
31355 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
31356 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
31357 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
31358 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
31359 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
31362 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
31363 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
31364 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
31365 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
31366 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
31367 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
31368 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
31371 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
31372 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
31374 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
31375 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31377 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
31378 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
31379 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
31380 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
31381 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
31382 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
31384 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
31385 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
31386 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
31389 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
31390 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
31391 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
31392 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31394 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
31395 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
31396 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
31400 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
31401 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
31402 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
31403 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
31404 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
31405 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
31407 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
31408 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31410 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
31411 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
31412 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
31414 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
31416 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
31417 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
31419 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
31420 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
31422 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
31423 dnslists = some.list.example
31426 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
31427 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
31428 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
31430 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
31433 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
31434 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
31435 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
31436 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
31437 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
31438 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
31439 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
31440 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
31441 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
31442 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
31444 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
31446 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
31447 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
31449 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
31450 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
31451 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
31454 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
31455 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
31456 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
31457 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
31458 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
31459 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
31460 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
31461 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
31462 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
31464 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
31465 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
31466 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
31467 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
31469 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
31470 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
31471 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
31472 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
31473 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
31474 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
31475 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
31476 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
31477 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
31478 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
31480 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
31481 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
31482 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
31485 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
31486 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example, messages or recipients
31487 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
31488 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
31489 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
31490 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
31492 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
31493 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
31494 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
31495 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
31496 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
31497 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
31498 the &%count=%& option.
31501 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
31502 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
31503 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
31504 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
31505 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
31507 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
31508 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
31509 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
31510 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
31512 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
31513 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
31514 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
31515 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
31516 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
31517 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
31518 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
31520 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
31521 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
31522 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
31523 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
31524 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
31525 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
31526 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
31528 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
31529 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
31530 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
31531 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
31534 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
31535 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
31536 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
31537 multiple different commands.
31539 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
31540 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
31541 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
31542 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
31543 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
31545 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
31548 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
31549 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
31550 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
31551 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
31552 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
31554 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
31555 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
31557 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
31558 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
31559 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
31560 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
31564 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
31565 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
31566 (max $sender_rate_limit)
31569 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
31570 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
31571 (max $sender_rate_limit)
31574 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
31575 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
31576 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
31577 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
31578 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
31579 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
31582 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
31583 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
31584 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
31585 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
31586 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
31589 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
31590 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
31591 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
31592 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
31593 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
31594 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
31597 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
31598 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
31599 client's average rate of successfully sent email,
31600 up to the given limit.
31601 This is appropriate if the countermeasure when the condition is true
31602 consists of refusing the message, and
31603 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
31604 If the action when true is anything more complex then this option is
31605 likely not what is wanted.
31607 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
31608 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
31609 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
31610 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
31611 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
31612 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
31613 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
31614 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
31616 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
31620 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
31621 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
31622 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
31623 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
31624 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
31625 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
31626 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
31627 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
31628 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
31630 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
31631 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
31632 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
31633 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
31634 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
31635 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
31637 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
31638 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
31641 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
31642 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
31643 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
31644 required increases with larger limits.
31646 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
31647 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
31648 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
31649 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
31650 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
31651 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
31652 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
31653 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
31654 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
31658 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
31659 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
31660 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
31661 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
31662 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
31663 message. For example:
31665 # Log all senders' rates
31666 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
31667 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
31669 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
31670 # at the decimal point.
31671 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
31672 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
31673 $sender_rate_limit }s
31675 # Keep authenticated users under control
31676 deny authenticated = *
31677 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
31679 # System-wide rate limit
31680 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
31681 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
31683 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
31684 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
31685 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
31686 messages per $sender_rate_period
31687 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
31688 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
31689 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
31691 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
31692 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
31693 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
31694 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
31695 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
31696 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
31697 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
31701 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
31702 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
31703 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
31704 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
31705 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
31706 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
31707 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
31708 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
31709 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
31711 verify = sender/callout
31712 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
31714 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
31715 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
31716 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
31717 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
31718 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
31719 The available options are as follows:
31722 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
31723 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
31724 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
31726 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
31727 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
31728 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
31729 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
31731 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
31732 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
31734 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
31735 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
31736 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
31737 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
31740 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
31741 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
31742 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
31743 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31744 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
31745 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
31748 warn !verify = sender
31749 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
31751 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
31752 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
31753 verification failure.
31755 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
31756 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
31759 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
31760 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
31762 &%route%&: Routing failed.
31764 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
31765 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
31766 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
31768 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
31770 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
31773 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
31774 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
31776 The above variables may also be set after a &*successful*&
31777 address verification to:
31780 &%random%&: A random local-part callout succeeded
31786 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
31787 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
31788 .cindex "callout" "verification"
31789 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
31790 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
31791 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
31792 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
31793 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
31794 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
31795 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
31796 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
31797 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
31800 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
31801 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
31802 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
31803 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
31804 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
31805 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
31807 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
31808 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
31809 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
31810 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
31811 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
31813 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
31814 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
31815 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
31816 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
31817 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
31818 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
31819 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
31820 supplies a host list.
31821 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
31823 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
31824 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
31825 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
31826 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
31827 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
31828 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
31829 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
31831 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
31832 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
31833 following SMTP commands are sent:
31835 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
31837 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
31840 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
31843 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
31846 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
31847 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
31848 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
31849 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
31850 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
31851 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
31853 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
31854 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
31855 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
31856 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
31857 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
31859 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
31860 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
31861 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
31862 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
31863 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
31868 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
31869 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
31870 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
31871 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
31873 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
31875 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
31876 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
31877 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
31881 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
31882 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
31883 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
31886 verify = sender/callout=5s
31888 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
31889 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
31890 the &%connect%& parameter.
31893 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
31894 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
31895 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
31896 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
31898 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
31900 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
31902 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
31903 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
31904 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
31905 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
31906 updated in this circumstance.
31908 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
31909 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
31910 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
31911 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
31912 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
31913 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
31916 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
31917 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
31918 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
31919 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
31920 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
31921 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
31922 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
31923 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
31924 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
31925 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
31927 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
31929 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
31932 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
31933 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
31934 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
31937 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
31939 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
31940 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
31941 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
31942 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
31943 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
31946 .vitem &*no_cache*&
31947 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
31948 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
31949 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
31951 .vitem &*postmaster*&
31952 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
31953 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
31954 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
31955 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
31956 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
31957 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
31958 made, until the cache record expires.
31960 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
31961 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
31962 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
31965 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
31967 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
31968 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
31970 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
31972 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
31973 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
31974 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
31975 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
31979 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
31980 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
31981 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
31982 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
31983 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
31985 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
31987 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
31988 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
31989 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
31990 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
31991 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
31993 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
31994 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
31995 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31997 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
31999 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
32000 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
32001 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
32002 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
32003 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
32005 .vitem &*use_sender*&
32006 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32008 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
32010 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
32011 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
32012 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
32013 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
32014 usefulness of callout caching.
32017 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32019 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
32021 It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
32022 and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
32023 Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
32024 when that is used for the connections.
32025 The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
32026 (which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
32027 if the use_sender option is used,
32028 if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
32029 and if no other callouts intervene.
32032 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
32033 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
32034 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
32035 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
32036 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
32037 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
32038 these circumstances.
32040 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
32041 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
32042 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
32043 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
32044 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
32045 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
32046 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
32048 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
32049 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
32050 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
32051 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
32056 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
32057 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
32058 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
32059 .cindex "caching" "callout"
32060 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
32061 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
32062 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
32063 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
32064 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
32065 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
32067 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
32068 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
32071 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
32072 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
32073 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
32075 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
32076 commands up to and including
32080 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
32081 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
32082 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
32083 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
32084 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
32085 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
32086 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
32088 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
32089 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
32090 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
32091 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
32092 will eventually be noticed.
32094 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
32095 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
32096 behaviour will be the same.
32100 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
32101 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
32102 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
32103 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
32104 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
32105 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
32108 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
32110 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
32111 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
32112 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
32113 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
32114 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
32115 550 Sender verification failed
32117 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
32118 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
32119 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
32120 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
32123 verify = sender/no_details
32126 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
32127 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
32128 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
32129 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
32130 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
32131 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
32132 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
32135 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
32136 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
32137 verification also fails.
32139 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
32140 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
32143 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
32144 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
32145 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
32148 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
32150 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
32151 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
32152 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
32153 verification to succeed.
32155 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
32156 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
32157 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
32158 option. For example:
32160 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
32162 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
32163 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
32165 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
32166 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
32167 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
32168 address and a report is output for each of them.
32172 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
32173 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
32174 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
32175 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
32176 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
32177 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
32178 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
32182 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
32183 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
32184 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
32185 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
32186 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
32187 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
32189 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
32190 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
32191 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
32192 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
32195 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
32197 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
32199 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
32200 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
32202 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
32203 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
32206 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
32207 use for the DNS query. The default is:
32209 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
32211 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
32212 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
32213 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
32214 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
32217 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
32219 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
32220 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
32221 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
32223 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
32224 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
32225 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
32226 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
32227 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
32228 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
32229 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
32230 of legitimate HELO domains.
32232 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
32233 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
32234 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
32235 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
32238 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
32240 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
32241 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
32242 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
32247 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
32248 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
32249 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
32250 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
32251 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
32252 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
32253 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
32254 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
32256 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
32257 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
32258 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
32259 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
32260 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
32261 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
32262 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
32263 The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
32265 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
32266 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
32269 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
32270 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
32273 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
32274 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
32277 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
32278 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
32280 recipients = +batv_senders
32282 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
32283 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
32285 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
32286 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
32287 !condition = $prvscheck_result
32289 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
32290 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
32291 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
32292 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
32293 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
32295 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
32296 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
32297 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
32298 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
32299 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
32300 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
32301 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
32303 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
32304 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
32305 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
32306 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
32310 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
32312 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
32313 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
32314 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
32317 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
32320 external_smtp_batv:
32322 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
32323 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
32324 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
32325 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
32328 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
32332 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
32333 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
32334 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
32335 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
32336 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
32337 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
32338 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
32339 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
32340 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
32341 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
32343 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
32344 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
32345 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
32346 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
32347 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
32348 same host is fulfilling both functions,
32350 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
32352 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
32353 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
32354 system to arbitrary domains.
32357 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
32358 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
32359 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
32360 example, suppose you want to do the following:
32363 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
32364 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
32365 &'my.dom2.example'&.
32367 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
32368 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
32370 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
32371 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
32375 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
32377 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
32378 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
32379 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
32381 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
32385 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
32386 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
32388 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
32389 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
32390 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
32391 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
32392 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
32393 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
32394 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
32398 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
32399 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
32400 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
32401 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
32402 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
32407 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32408 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32410 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
32411 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
32412 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
32413 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
32414 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
32415 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
32418 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
32419 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
32420 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
32421 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
32422 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
32424 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
32425 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
32426 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
32429 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
32430 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
32432 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
32433 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
32434 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
32436 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
32437 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
32439 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
32442 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
32445 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
32446 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
32447 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
32448 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
32449 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
32450 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
32452 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
32453 temporarily created in a file called:
32455 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
32457 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
32458 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
32459 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
32460 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
32461 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
32463 control = no_mbox_unspool
32465 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
32466 same directory by default.
32470 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
32471 .cindex "virus scanning"
32472 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
32473 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
32474 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
32475 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
32476 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
32477 in memory and thus are much faster.
32479 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
32480 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
32482 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
32483 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
32484 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
32485 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
32487 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
32489 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
32491 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
32493 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
32495 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
32496 The following scanner types are supported in this release,
32497 though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
32501 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
32502 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
32503 Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
32504 You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
32505 at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
32506 This scanner type takes one option,
32507 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
32508 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
32509 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
32510 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
32511 A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
32512 Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
32513 the daemon as options before the main scan command.
32515 .cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
32516 If &`pass_unscanned`&
32517 is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
32518 decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
32523 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
32524 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
32525 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
32527 If you omit the argument, the default path
32528 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
32530 If you use a remote host,
32531 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
32532 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
32533 For information about available commands and their options you may use
32535 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
32541 If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
32542 permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
32543 written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
32545 .vitem &%aveserver%&
32546 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32547 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
32548 at &url(https://www.kaspersky.com/). This scanner type takes one option,
32549 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
32552 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
32557 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
32558 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
32559 &url(https://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
32560 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
32561 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
32563 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
32564 a UNIX socket specification,
32565 a TCP socket specification,
32566 or a (global) option.
32568 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
32569 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
32570 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
32571 and the second a port number,
32572 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
32573 These per-server options are supported:
32575 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
32578 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
32579 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
32581 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
32585 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
32586 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
32587 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
32588 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
32589 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
32591 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
32593 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
32594 to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
32595 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
32596 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
32598 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
32599 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
32600 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
32601 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
32602 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
32603 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
32604 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
32605 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
32606 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
32608 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
32609 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
32610 (Connection refused)
32613 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
32614 contributing the code for this scanner.
32617 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
32618 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
32619 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
32620 type takes 3 mandatory options:
32623 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
32624 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
32627 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
32628 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
32629 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
32630 the &"trigger"& expression.
32633 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
32634 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
32635 &"name"& expression.
32638 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
32640 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
32642 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
32643 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
32644 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
32645 configuration setting:
32647 av_scanner = cmdline:\
32648 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
32649 found in file:'(.+)'
32652 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
32653 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(https://www.sald.ru/)) interface
32655 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
32656 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
32657 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
32658 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
32661 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
32662 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
32664 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
32665 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
32668 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
32669 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
32670 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
32674 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
32676 If you omit the argument, the default values shown above are used.
32678 .vitem &%f-prot6d%&
32679 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
32680 The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
32681 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
32684 av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
32686 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
32689 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
32690 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(https://www.f-secure.com/)) takes one
32691 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
32693 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
32695 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
32696 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
32698 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
32699 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32700 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
32701 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
32702 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
32705 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
32707 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
32710 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
32711 This was a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users,
32712 though some documentation was available in English.
32713 The history can be shown at &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mks_vir)
32714 and this appears to be a candidate for removal from Exim, unless
32715 we are informed of other virus scanners which use the same protocol
32717 The only option for this scanner type is
32718 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
32719 provided that mksd has
32720 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
32722 av_scanner = mksd:2
32724 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
32727 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
32728 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
32729 running on the local machine.
32730 There are four options:
32731 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
32732 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
32733 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
32734 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
32735 and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
32738 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
32740 Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
32741 there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
32742 The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
32743 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
32744 specify an empty element to get this.
32747 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
32748 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
32749 You can get Sophie at &url(http://sophie.sourceforge.net/). The only option
32750 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
32751 client communication. For example:
32753 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
32755 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
32759 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
32760 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
32763 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
32764 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
32765 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
32766 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
32767 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
32768 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
32771 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
32772 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
32773 The first element can then be one of
32776 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
32777 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
32780 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
32781 the condition fails immediately.
32783 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
32784 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
32785 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
32786 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
32787 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
32790 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
32791 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
32792 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
32794 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
32795 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
32798 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
32800 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
32802 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
32803 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
32804 is set to record the actual address used.
32806 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
32807 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
32808 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
32809 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
32812 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
32813 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
32815 Here is a very simple scanning example:
32817 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32820 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
32822 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32823 malware = */defer_ok
32825 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
32826 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
32828 av_scanner = $acl_m0
32830 in the main Exim configuration.
32832 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32833 set acl_m0 = sophie
32836 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32837 set acl_m0 = aveserver
32842 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
32843 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
32844 .cindex "spam scanning"
32845 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
32847 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
32848 score and a report for the message.
32849 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
32851 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
32852 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
32853 &url(https://spamassassin.apache.org/) and &url(https://www.rspamd.com/)
32855 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
32857 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
32859 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
32860 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
32863 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
32864 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
32865 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
32866 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
32867 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
32868 configuration as follows (example):
32870 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 783
32872 The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
32873 If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
32874 iptables firewall, consider setting
32875 &%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
32876 timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
32877 server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
32878 connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
32882 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
32884 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
32886 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
32889 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
32890 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
32891 filename instead of an address/port pair:
32893 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
32895 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
32896 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
32897 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
32898 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&):
32900 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
32901 192.168.2.11 783 : \
32904 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
32905 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
32906 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
32909 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
32910 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
32911 and changeable in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
32912 take care to not double the separator.
32914 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
32915 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
32916 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
32917 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
32919 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
32921 The supported options are:
32923 pri=<priority> Selection priority
32924 weight=<value> Selection bias
32925 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
32926 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
32927 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
32928 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
32931 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
32932 higher values being tried first.
32933 The default priority is 1.
32935 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
32936 Within a priority set
32937 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
32938 The default value for selection bias is 1.
32940 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
32941 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
32942 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
32943 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
32945 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
32946 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
32948 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
32949 The default value is two minutes.
32951 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
32952 a failed connect is made.
32953 The default is to not retry.
32955 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
32956 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
32957 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
32960 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
32961 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
32962 is set to record the actual address used.
32964 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
32965 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
32967 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32970 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
32971 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
32972 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
32973 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
32974 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
32977 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
32978 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
32979 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
32980 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
32981 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
32983 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
32984 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
32986 or the use of PRDR,
32987 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
32988 are needed to use this feature.
32990 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
32991 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
32992 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
32995 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
32996 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
32997 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
33000 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33001 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
33005 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
33006 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
33007 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
33008 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
33010 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
33011 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
33013 Except for &$spam_report$&,
33014 these variables are saved with the received message so are
33015 available for use at delivery time.
33018 .vitem &$spam_score$&
33019 The spam score of the message, for example, &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
33020 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
33022 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
33023 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
33024 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
33025 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
33026 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
33028 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
33029 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
33030 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
33031 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
33032 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
33033 spam bar is 50 characters.
33035 .vitem &$spam_report$&
33036 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
33037 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
33038 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
33039 Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
33040 when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
33041 unencoded in headers.
33043 .vitem &$spam_action$&
33044 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
33045 spam score versus threshold.
33046 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
33050 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
33051 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
33052 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
33054 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
33055 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
33056 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
33057 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
33058 spam condition, like this:
33060 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33061 spam = joe/defer_ok
33063 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
33065 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
33068 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
33069 warn spam = nobody:true
33070 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
33071 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
33073 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
33074 # is over threshold
33076 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
33078 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
33079 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
33081 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
33086 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
33087 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
33088 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
33089 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
33090 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
33091 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
33092 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
33093 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
33094 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
33095 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
33098 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
33099 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
33100 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
33101 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
33102 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
33103 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
33104 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
33106 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
33107 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
33108 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
33109 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
33110 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
33112 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
33113 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
33114 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
33115 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
33116 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
33119 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
33121 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
33125 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
33127 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
33128 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
33129 a sequential filename consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
33130 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
33132 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
33133 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
33134 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
33135 the full path and filename.
33137 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
33138 filename, and the default path is then used.
33140 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
33141 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
33142 a file with its original, proposed filename using
33144 decode = $mime_filename
33146 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
33147 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
33148 automatically unlinked.
33150 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
33151 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
33152 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
33153 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
33154 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
33156 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
33157 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
33158 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
33160 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
33161 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
33162 available in the MIME ACL:
33165 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
33166 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
33167 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
33168 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
33169 contains the empty string.
33171 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
33172 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
33173 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
33179 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
33180 case-insensitively.
33182 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
33183 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
33184 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
33185 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
33186 only used for display purposes.
33188 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
33189 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
33190 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
33192 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
33193 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
33194 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
33196 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
33197 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33198 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
33199 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
33200 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
33202 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
33203 This variable contains the normalized content of the
33204 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
33205 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
33207 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
33208 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
33209 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
33210 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
33214 application/octet-stream
33218 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
33221 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
33222 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33223 successfully run. It contains the full path and filename of the file
33224 containing the decoded data.
33229 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
33230 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
33231 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
33232 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
33235 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
33237 found, this variable contains the empty string.
33239 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
33240 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
33241 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
33242 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
33244 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
33245 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
33249 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
33252 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
33253 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
33256 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
33257 and the rest are attachments.
33260 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
33263 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
33264 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
33265 coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
33267 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
33268 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
33269 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
33270 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
33272 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
33273 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
33274 &"multipart"&, for example, &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
33275 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
33276 want to carry out specific actions on them.
33278 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
33279 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
33280 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
33281 decoding is fully recursive.
33283 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
33284 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
33285 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
33286 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
33287 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
33288 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
33289 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
33294 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
33295 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
33296 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
33297 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
33298 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
33300 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
33301 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
33302 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
33303 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
33304 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
33306 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
33307 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
33308 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
33309 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
33310 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
33311 32K characters are checked.
33313 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
33314 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
33315 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
33316 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
33317 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
33319 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
33320 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
33322 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
33323 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
33324 matching regular expression.
33325 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
33326 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
33328 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
33336 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33337 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33339 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
33340 "Local scan function"
33341 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
33342 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
33343 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
33344 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
33345 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
33347 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
33348 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
33349 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
33350 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
33351 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
33353 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
33354 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
33355 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
33356 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
33358 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
33359 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
33360 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
33361 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
33363 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
33364 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
33365 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
33366 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
33367 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
33368 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
33369 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
33370 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
33371 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
33375 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
33376 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
33377 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
33378 function is before building Exim, by setting
33379 both HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN and
33380 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
33381 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
33382 directory, so you might set
33384 HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN=yes
33385 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
33387 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
33388 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
33389 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
33390 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
33391 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
33392 _src/local_scan.c_.
33394 If you want to make use of Exim's runtime configuration file to set options
33395 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
33397 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
33399 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
33404 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
33405 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
33406 .cindex &%dlfunc%& "API description"
33407 You must include this line near the start of your code:
33409 #include "local_scan.h"
33411 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
33412 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
33413 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
33414 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
33415 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
33416 strings and pointers to character strings:
33418 #define CS (char *)
33419 #define CCS (const char *)
33420 #define CSS (char **)
33421 #define US (unsigned char *)
33422 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
33423 #define USS (unsigned char **)
33425 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
33427 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
33429 The arguments are as follows:
33432 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
33433 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
33434 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
33436 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
33437 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
33438 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
33439 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
33440 case this changes in some future version.
33442 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
33443 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
33446 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
33449 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
33450 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
33451 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
33452 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
33453 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
33454 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
33456 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
33457 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
33458 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
33460 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
33461 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
33462 queued without immediate delivery.
33464 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
33465 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
33466 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
33467 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
33468 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
33471 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
33472 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
33473 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
33476 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
33477 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
33478 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
33479 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
33480 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
33481 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
33482 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
33484 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
33485 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
33486 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
33489 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
33490 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
33491 &%-oe%& command line options.
33495 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
33496 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
33497 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
33498 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
33499 want to do this, you must have the line
33501 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
33503 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
33504 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
33505 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
33508 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
33509 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
33510 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
33511 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
33512 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
33513 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
33515 static int my_integer_option = 42;
33516 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
33518 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
33519 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
33520 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
33523 int local_scan_options_count =
33524 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
33526 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
33527 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
33531 my_string = some string of text...
33533 The available types of option data are as follows:
33536 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
33537 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
33538 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
33539 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
33540 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
33541 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
33544 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
33545 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
33546 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
33547 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
33550 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
33551 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
33554 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
33555 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
33556 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
33557 printed with the suffix K or M.
33559 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
33560 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
33561 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
33562 always output in octal.
33564 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
33565 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
33566 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
33568 .vitem &*opt_time*&
33569 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
33570 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
33573 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
33574 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
33578 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
33579 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
33580 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
33581 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
33582 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
33583 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
33584 C variables are as follows:
33587 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
33588 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
33589 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
33591 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
33592 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
33593 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
33595 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
33596 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
33597 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
33598 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
33601 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
33602 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
33603 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
33606 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
33607 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
33611 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
33612 selected, you should use code like this:
33614 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
33615 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
33617 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
33618 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
33619 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
33621 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
33622 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
33625 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
33626 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
33628 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
33629 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
33631 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
33632 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
33633 &%-bh%& command line option.
33635 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
33636 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
33637 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
33639 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
33640 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
33641 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
33642 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
33644 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
33645 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
33646 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
33648 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
33649 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
33651 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
33652 The number of accepted recipients.
33654 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
33655 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
33656 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
33657 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
33658 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
33659 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
33660 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
33661 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
33662 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
33663 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
33664 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
33665 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
33667 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
33668 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
33670 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
33671 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
33672 locally-submitted messages.
33674 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
33675 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
33676 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
33678 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
33679 The name of the sending host, if known.
33681 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
33682 The port on the sending host.
33684 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
33685 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
33687 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
33688 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
33690 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
33691 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
33692 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
33696 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
33697 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
33698 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
33699 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
33704 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
33705 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
33707 .vitem &*int&~type*&
33708 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
33709 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
33710 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
33711 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
33712 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
33713 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
33715 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
33716 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
33719 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
33720 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
33721 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
33726 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
33727 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
33730 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
33731 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
33733 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
33734 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
33735 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
33736 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
33738 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
33739 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
33740 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
33741 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
33742 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
33743 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
33744 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
33745 is NULL for all recipients.
33750 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
33751 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
33752 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
33753 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
33757 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
33758 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
33760 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
33761 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
33762 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
33763 for the process in &%newumask%&.
33765 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
33766 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
33767 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
33768 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
33769 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
33771 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
33773 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
33774 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
33775 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
33776 return value is as follows:
33781 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
33787 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
33793 The process timed out.
33797 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
33800 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
33801 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
33802 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
33803 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
33804 forks a subprocess that is running
33806 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
33808 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
33809 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
33810 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
33811 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
33813 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
33814 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
33815 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
33816 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
33819 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
33820 *sender_authentication)*&
33821 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
33824 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
33826 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
33829 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
33830 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
33831 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
33832 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
33833 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
33835 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
33836 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
33839 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
33840 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
33841 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
33842 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
33843 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
33844 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
33845 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
33846 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
33848 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
33849 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
33850 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
33851 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
33852 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
33853 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
33855 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
33856 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
33857 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
33858 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
33860 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
33861 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
33862 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
33863 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
33864 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
33865 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
33866 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
33867 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
33868 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
33869 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
33871 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
33872 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
33874 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
33875 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
33878 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
33879 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
33880 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
33881 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
33882 match the specification, the function does nothing.
33885 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
33886 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
33887 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
33888 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
33889 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
33890 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
33892 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
33894 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
33895 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
33896 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
33897 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
33898 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
33901 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
33902 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
33903 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
33904 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
33905 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
33906 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
33907 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
33908 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
33910 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
33911 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
33912 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
33914 &`OK `& match succeeded
33915 &`FAIL `& match failed
33916 &`DEFER `& match deferred
33918 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
33919 inability to contact a database.
33921 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
33923 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
33924 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
33925 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
33927 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
33929 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
33930 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
33931 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
33933 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
33935 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
33938 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
33940 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
33941 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
33942 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
33943 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
33944 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
33945 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
33948 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
33950 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
33951 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
33952 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
33953 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
33954 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
33955 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
33958 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
33959 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
33960 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
33961 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
33963 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
33964 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
33965 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
33966 value afterwards. For example:
33968 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
33969 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
33970 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
33973 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
33974 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
33975 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
33976 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
33983 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
33984 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
33985 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
33986 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
33987 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
33988 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
33989 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
33990 binary string is returned with an error message.
33992 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
33993 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
33994 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
33996 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
33997 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
33998 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
33999 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
34000 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
34002 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
34003 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
34004 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
34006 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
34007 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
34008 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
34009 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
34013 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
34014 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
34017 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
34018 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
34019 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
34020 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
34021 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
34022 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
34023 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
34024 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
34027 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
34028 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
34030 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
34031 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
34032 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
34033 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
34034 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
34035 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
34036 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
34038 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
34039 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
34041 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
34042 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
34043 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
34044 multiple output lines.
34046 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
34047 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
34048 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
34049 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
34050 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
34051 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
34052 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
34055 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
34056 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
34057 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
34058 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34060 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
34061 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
34062 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34064 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
34067 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
34070 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
34071 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
34072 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
34073 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
34074 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
34075 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
34081 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
34082 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
34083 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
34084 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
34085 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
34086 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
34087 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
34090 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
34091 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
34092 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
34093 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
34095 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
34096 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
34098 store_pool = POOL_PERM
34100 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
34101 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
34102 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
34103 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
34105 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
34106 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
34107 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
34108 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
34115 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34116 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34118 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
34119 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
34120 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
34121 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
34122 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
34123 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
34124 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
34125 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
34127 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
34128 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
34129 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
34130 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
34131 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
34133 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
34134 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
34135 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
34136 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
34137 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
34138 prevent it happening on retries.
34140 .vindex "&$domain$&"
34141 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
34142 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
34143 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
34144 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
34145 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
34146 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
34147 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
34150 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
34151 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
34152 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
34153 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
34154 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
34155 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
34156 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
34158 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
34159 system_filter_user = exim
34161 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
34162 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
34163 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
34164 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
34165 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
34166 by the &%reply%& command.
34169 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
34170 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
34171 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
34172 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
34174 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
34175 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
34179 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
34180 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
34181 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
34182 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
34183 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
34184 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
34187 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
34188 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
34189 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
34190 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
34191 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
34192 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
34193 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
34195 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
34196 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
34197 succeed, it will not be tried again.
34198 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
34199 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
34201 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
34202 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
34203 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
34204 to which users' filter files can refer.
34208 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
34209 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
34210 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
34211 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
34212 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
34216 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
34217 .cindex "freezing messages"
34218 .cindex "message" "freezing"
34219 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
34220 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
34221 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
34222 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
34223 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
34224 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
34225 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
34226 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
34227 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
34229 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
34231 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
34233 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
34234 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
34235 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
34236 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
34237 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
34240 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
34241 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
34242 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
34243 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
34245 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
34246 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
34247 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
34248 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
34249 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
34250 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
34251 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
34252 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
34253 message. For example:
34255 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
34256 because it contains attachments that we are \
34257 not prepared to receive."
34260 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
34261 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
34262 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
34263 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
34264 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
34265 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
34268 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
34269 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
34271 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
34272 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
34273 generated by the filter.
34275 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
34277 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
34278 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
34284 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
34285 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
34290 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
34291 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
34292 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
34293 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
34294 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
34296 headers add <string>
34297 headers remove <string>
34299 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
34300 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
34301 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
34302 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
34303 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
34305 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
34306 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
34307 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
34310 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
34311 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
34314 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
34315 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
34316 space after input continuations is ignored.
34318 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
34319 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
34320 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
34321 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
34322 header with the same name, they are all removed.
34324 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
34325 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
34326 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
34327 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
34328 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
34329 used for all recipients of the message.
34331 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
34332 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
34333 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
34334 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
34335 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
34336 until the message is actually being written (see section
34337 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
34339 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
34340 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
34341 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
34342 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
34343 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
34344 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
34345 modified more than once.
34347 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
34348 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
34351 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
34352 headers remove "Subject"
34353 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
34354 headers remove "Old-Subject"
34359 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
34360 .cindex "envelope sender"
34361 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
34363 errors_to <some address>
34365 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
34366 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
34367 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
34370 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
34372 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
34373 address if its delivery failed.
34377 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
34378 .vindex "&$domain$&"
34379 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
34380 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
34381 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
34382 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
34383 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
34384 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
34385 which implements such a filter:
34390 domains = +local_domains
34391 file = /central/filters/$local_part
34396 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
34397 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
34398 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
34399 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
34401 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
34402 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
34403 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
34404 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
34406 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
34407 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
34408 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
34415 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34416 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34418 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
34419 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
34420 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
34421 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
34422 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
34423 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
34424 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
34425 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
34427 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
34428 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
34429 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
34430 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
34431 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
34433 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
34434 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
34435 loopback interface specially in any way.
34437 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
34438 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
34443 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
34444 .cindex "message" "submission"
34445 .cindex "submission mode"
34446 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
34447 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
34448 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
34449 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
34451 control = submission
34453 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
34454 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
34455 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
34456 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
34457 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
34458 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
34460 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
34461 control = submission
34463 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
34464 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
34465 is used to separate options. For example:
34467 control = submission/sender_retain
34469 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
34470 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
34471 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
34472 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
34473 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
34474 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
34475 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
34477 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
34478 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
34481 control = submission/domain=some.domain
34483 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
34484 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
34485 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
34486 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
34488 accept authenticated = *
34489 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
34490 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
34491 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
34493 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
34494 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
34495 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
34497 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
34499 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
34502 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
34504 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
34505 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
34506 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
34507 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
34509 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
34510 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
34511 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
34512 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
34513 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
34514 spoof another's address.
34516 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
34517 .cindex "line endings"
34518 .cindex "carriage return"
34520 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
34521 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
34522 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
34523 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
34524 use CRLF or just CR.
34526 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
34527 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
34528 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
34529 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
34530 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
34531 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
34532 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
34533 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
34537 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
34539 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
34542 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
34543 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
34546 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
34547 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
34548 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
34549 people trying to play silly games.
34551 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
34552 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
34560 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
34561 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
34562 .cindex "address" "qualification"
34563 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
34564 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
34565 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
34566 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
34567 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
34569 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
34570 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
34571 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
34572 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
34573 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
34575 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
34576 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
34577 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
34578 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
34579 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
34580 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
34581 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
34582 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
34587 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
34588 .cindex "&""From""& line"
34589 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
34590 .cindex "sender" "address"
34591 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
34592 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
34593 .cindex "envelope sender"
34594 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34595 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
34596 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
34597 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
34599 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
34600 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
34602 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
34603 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
34604 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
34605 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
34606 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
34607 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
34608 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
34609 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
34610 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
34612 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
34613 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
34614 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
34615 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
34616 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
34617 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
34618 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
34620 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
34621 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
34622 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
34624 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
34625 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
34626 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
34627 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
34631 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
34632 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
34633 .cindex "header lines" "Resent-"
34634 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
34635 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
34636 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
34637 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
34638 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
34641 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
34642 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
34645 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
34646 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
34650 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
34651 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
34653 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
34654 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
34655 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
34657 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
34660 For a locally-submitted message,
34661 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
34662 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
34663 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
34664 included in log lines in this case.
34666 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
34667 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
34673 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
34674 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
34675 includes the header line:
34677 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
34680 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
34681 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
34682 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
34683 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
34684 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
34685 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
34688 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
34689 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
34690 .cindex "header lines" "Date:"
34691 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
34692 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
34693 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
34695 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
34696 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
34697 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
34698 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
34699 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
34700 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
34701 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
34702 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
34706 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
34707 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
34708 .cindex "header lines" "Envelope-to:"
34709 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
34710 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
34711 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
34712 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
34713 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
34714 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
34718 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
34719 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
34720 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
34721 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34722 .cindex "message" "submission"
34723 .cindex "submission mode"
34724 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
34725 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
34728 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
34729 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
34731 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
34732 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
34734 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34735 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
34736 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
34738 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
34739 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
34741 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
34742 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
34746 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
34748 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
34749 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
34750 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
34751 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34752 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
34753 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
34754 &%qualify_domain%&.
34756 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
34757 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
34758 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
34759 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34762 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
34763 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
34764 .cindex "header lines" "Message-ID:"
34765 .cindex "message" "submission"
34766 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
34767 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
34768 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
34769 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
34770 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
34771 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
34772 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
34773 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
34774 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
34775 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
34778 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
34779 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
34780 .cindex "header lines" "Received:"
34781 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
34782 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
34783 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
34785 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
34786 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
34787 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
34788 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
34790 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
34791 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
34792 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
34795 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
34796 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
34797 .cindex "header lines" "References:"
34798 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
34799 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
34800 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
34801 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
34802 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
34803 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
34804 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
34805 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
34806 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
34810 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
34811 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
34812 .cindex "header lines" "Return-path:"
34813 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
34814 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
34815 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
34816 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
34817 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
34818 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
34822 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
34823 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
34824 .cindex "message" "submission"
34825 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
34826 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
34827 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
34828 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
34829 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
34832 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
34833 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
34834 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
34835 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
34836 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
34837 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
34838 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
34839 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
34840 line is added to the message.
34842 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
34843 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
34844 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
34845 options true at the same time.
34847 .cindex "submission mode"
34848 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
34849 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
34850 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
34851 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
34853 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
34854 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
34855 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
34856 created as follows:
34859 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34860 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
34861 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
34863 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
34864 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
34866 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
34867 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
34870 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
34871 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
34872 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
34873 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
34875 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
34876 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
34877 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
34878 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
34882 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
34883 "SECTheadersaddrem"
34884 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
34885 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
34886 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
34887 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
34888 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
34889 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
34890 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
34892 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
34893 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
34894 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
34895 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
34896 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
34897 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
34899 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
34900 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
34901 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
34903 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
34904 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
34905 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
34907 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
34908 X-added-second: another added header line
34910 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
34912 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
34913 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
34914 Each header-line is separately expanded.
34916 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
34917 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
34918 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
34919 not part of the names. For example:
34921 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
34924 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
34925 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
34926 Each item is separately expanded.
34927 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
34928 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
34929 will act as list separators.
34931 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
34932 items are expanded at routing time,
34933 and then associated with all addresses that are
34934 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
34935 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
34936 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
34938 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
34939 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
34940 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
34941 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
34943 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
34944 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
34945 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
34948 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
34949 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
34950 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
34951 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
34952 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
34953 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
34954 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
34956 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
34957 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
34958 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
34959 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
34961 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
34962 the following consequences:
34965 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
34966 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
34967 to it, at all times.
34969 Header lines that are added by a router's
34970 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
34971 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
34973 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
34974 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
34976 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
34977 a later router or by a transport.
34979 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
34980 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
34982 headers_remove = subject
34983 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
34987 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
34988 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
34994 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
34995 .cindex "address" "constructed"
34996 .cindex "constructed address"
34997 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
35000 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
35004 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
35006 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
35007 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
35008 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
35009 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
35010 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
35011 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
35012 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
35013 there is no password file entry.
35016 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
35017 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
35018 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
35019 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
35020 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
35021 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
35022 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
35023 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
35027 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
35028 .cindex "case of local parts"
35029 .cindex "local part" "case of"
35030 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
35031 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
35032 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
35033 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
35034 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
35035 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
35038 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
35039 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
35040 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
35041 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
35042 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
35046 domains = +local_domains
35047 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
35048 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
35051 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
35052 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
35053 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
35054 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
35055 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
35059 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
35060 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
35061 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
35062 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
35063 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
35064 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
35065 empty components for compatibility.
35069 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
35070 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
35071 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
35072 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
35073 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
35074 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
35076 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
35077 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
35078 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
35079 example, a header such as
35083 might get rewritten as
35085 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
35087 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
35088 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
35091 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
35092 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
35093 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
35094 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
35095 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
35096 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
35097 .ecindex IIDmesproc
35101 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35102 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35104 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
35105 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
35106 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
35107 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
35108 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
35109 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
35110 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
35113 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
35115 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
35117 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
35120 For mail delivery, the following are available:
35123 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
35125 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
35128 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
35131 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
35132 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
35135 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
35136 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
35137 used to contain the envelope information.
35141 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
35142 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
35143 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
35144 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
35145 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
35148 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
35149 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
35150 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
35151 processing is the same in both cases.
35153 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
35154 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
35155 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
35156 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
35157 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
35158 .cindex "transport" "filter"
35159 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
35160 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
35163 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
35164 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
35165 required for the transaction.
35167 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
35168 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
35169 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
35170 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
35171 is called for verification.
35173 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
35174 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
35175 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
35177 .cindex "carriage return"
35179 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
35180 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
35181 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
35184 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
35185 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
35186 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
35187 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
35188 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
35189 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
35190 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
35191 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
35192 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
35194 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
35195 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
35196 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
35197 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
35199 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
35200 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
35201 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
35202 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
35204 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
35205 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
35206 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
35207 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
35208 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
35209 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
35210 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
35211 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
35212 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
35213 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
35215 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
35216 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
35218 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35219 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
35220 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
35221 square bracket of the IP address.
35226 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
35227 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
35228 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
35229 .cindex "host" "error"
35230 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
35231 message errors, and recipient errors.
35234 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
35235 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
35236 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
35239 Connection refused or timed out,
35241 Any error response code on connection,
35243 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
35245 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
35247 I/O errors at any time,
35249 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
35250 the &"."& at the end of the data.
35253 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
35254 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
35255 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
35256 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
35257 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
35258 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
35259 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
35260 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
35262 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
35263 .cindex "message" "error"
35264 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
35265 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
35266 message errors are:
35269 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
35272 Timeout after MAIL,
35274 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
35275 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
35276 connection at any other time.
35279 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
35280 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
35281 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
35282 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
35283 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
35284 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
35285 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
35286 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
35287 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
35288 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
35290 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
35291 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
35292 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
35295 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
35296 .cindex "recipient" "error"
35297 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
35298 recipient errors are:
35301 Any error response to RCPT,
35303 Timeout after RCPT.
35306 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
35307 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
35308 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
35309 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
35310 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
35311 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
35312 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
35313 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
35314 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
35315 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
35316 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
35317 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
35318 the retry clock is reset.
35320 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
35321 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
35322 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
35323 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
35324 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
35325 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
35326 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
35327 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
35328 recipient's retry time.
35331 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
35332 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
35333 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
35334 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
35335 until the next delivery attempt.
35337 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
35338 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
35339 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
35340 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
35341 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
35344 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
35345 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
35346 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
35347 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
35348 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
35349 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
35350 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
35352 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
35353 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
35354 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
35355 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
35356 then to be treated as a host error.
35358 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
35359 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
35360 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
35361 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
35362 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
35367 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
35368 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
35369 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
35372 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
35373 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
35374 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
35376 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
35378 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
35379 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
35380 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
35381 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
35382 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
35383 stream and exits with an error code.
35385 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
35386 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
35387 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
35388 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
35390 .cindex "carriage return"
35392 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
35393 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
35394 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
35396 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
35397 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
35398 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
35400 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
35401 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
35402 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
35403 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
35404 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
35405 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
35406 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
35407 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
35409 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
35410 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
35411 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
35412 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
35413 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
35414 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
35415 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
35416 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
35417 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
35419 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
35420 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
35421 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
35423 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
35424 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
35425 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
35426 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
35427 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
35429 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
35430 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
35431 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
35432 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
35433 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
35434 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
35435 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
35437 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
35438 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
35439 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
35440 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
35441 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
35443 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
35444 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
35445 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
35446 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
35447 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
35448 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
35449 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
35450 a delivery process.
35452 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
35453 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
35454 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
35455 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
35456 however, available with &'inetd'&.
35458 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
35459 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
35460 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
35461 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
35463 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
35464 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
35465 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
35469 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
35470 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
35471 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
35472 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
35473 the error response to the last command. The default value for
35474 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
35475 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
35476 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
35479 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
35480 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
35481 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
35482 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
35483 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
35484 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
35485 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
35486 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
35487 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
35488 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
35489 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
35493 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
35494 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
35495 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
35496 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
35497 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
35498 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
35499 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
35500 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
35502 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
35503 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
35504 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
35505 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
35506 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
35509 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
35510 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
35511 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
35513 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
35514 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
35515 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
35516 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
35517 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
35522 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
35523 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
35524 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
35525 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
35527 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
35528 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
35529 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
35530 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
35531 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
35532 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
35533 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
35534 SMTP response codes.
35536 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
35537 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
35538 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
35539 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
35540 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
35541 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
35542 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
35543 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
35548 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
35549 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
35550 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
35551 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
35552 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
35553 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
35554 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
35556 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
35557 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
35558 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
35559 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
35560 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
35561 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
35562 argument. For example,
35570 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
35571 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
35572 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
35573 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
35574 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
35576 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
35577 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
35578 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
35579 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
35580 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
35581 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
35582 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
35583 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
35585 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
35586 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
35587 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
35588 whatever the form of its argument. For
35591 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
35592 $sender_host_address
35594 .vindex "&$domain$&"
35595 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
35596 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
35597 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
35598 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
35599 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
35600 for it to change them before running the command.
35604 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
35605 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
35606 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
35607 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
35608 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
35609 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
35610 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
35611 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
35612 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
35613 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
35614 runs for RCPT commands:
35618 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
35622 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
35623 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
35624 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
35625 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
35626 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
35627 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
35628 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
35629 envelope along with the message.
35631 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
35632 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
35633 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
35634 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
35635 can be used to specify it.
35637 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
35638 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
35639 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
35640 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
35641 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
35644 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
35645 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
35646 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
35651 driver = manualroute
35652 transport = smtp_appendfile
35653 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
35657 driver = appendfile
35658 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
35663 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
35664 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
35665 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
35669 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
35670 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
35671 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
35672 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
35673 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
35674 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
35675 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
35676 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
35677 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
35678 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
35680 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
35681 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
35683 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
35684 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
35685 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
35686 make some use of automatically, for example:
35688 554 Unexpected end of file
35689 Transaction started in line 10
35690 Error detected in line 14
35692 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
35695 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
35696 The error message was:
35698 501 '>' missing at end of address
35700 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
35701 The error was detected in line 12.
35702 The SMTP command at fault was:
35704 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
35706 1 previous message was successfully processed.
35707 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
35709 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
35710 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
35712 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
35713 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
35717 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35718 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35720 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
35721 "Customizing messages"
35722 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains in the queue for more than a
35723 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
35724 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
35725 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
35726 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
35728 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
35729 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
35730 option. Exim also adds the line
35732 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
35734 to all warning and bounce messages,
35737 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
35738 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
35739 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
35740 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
35741 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
35742 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
35743 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
35745 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
35746 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
35747 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
35748 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
35749 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
35752 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
35753 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
35754 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
35755 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
35756 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
35757 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
35758 option, rounded to a whole number.
35760 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
35763 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
35764 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
35766 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
35767 failing addresses with their error messages.
35769 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
35770 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
35772 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
35773 The fields exist for back-compatibility
35776 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
35777 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
35778 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
35780 Subject: Mail delivery failed
35781 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
35782 {: returning message to sender}}
35784 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
35786 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
35787 {that you sent }{sent by
35791 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
35792 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
35794 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
35796 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
35799 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
35801 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
35804 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
35805 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
35806 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
35807 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
35808 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
35812 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
35813 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
35815 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
35816 the delayed addresses.
35818 The third item then ends the message.
35821 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
35822 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
35824 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
35825 $warn_message_delay
35827 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
35829 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
35830 {that you sent }{sent by
35834 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
35835 more than $warn_message_delay in the queue on $primary_hostname.
35837 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
35838 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
35839 The date of the message is: $h_date
35841 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
35843 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
35844 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
35845 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
35846 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
35847 the message will be returned to you.
35849 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
35850 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
35851 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
35852 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
35853 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
35854 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
35855 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
35856 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
35862 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35863 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35865 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
35866 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
35867 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
35871 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
35872 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
35873 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
35874 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
35875 routing explicitly:
35877 send_to_smart_host:
35878 driver = manualroute
35879 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
35880 transport = remote_smtp
35882 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
35883 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
35884 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
35885 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
35886 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
35891 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
35892 .cindex "mailing lists"
35893 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
35894 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
35895 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
35897 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
35898 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
35899 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
35900 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
35904 domains = lists.example
35905 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
35908 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
35911 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
35912 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
35913 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
35914 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
35916 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
35917 expanded into a filename or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
35920 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
35921 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
35922 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
35923 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
35924 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
35926 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
35927 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
35928 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
35929 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
35930 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
35931 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
35932 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
35933 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
35934 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
35938 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
35939 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
35940 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
35941 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
35942 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
35943 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
35944 addresses are not rigorously checked.
35946 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
35947 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
35948 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
35949 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
35950 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
35954 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
35955 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
35956 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
35957 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
35958 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
35959 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
35960 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
35961 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
35962 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
35963 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
35965 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
35966 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
35967 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
35968 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
35969 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
35970 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
35971 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
35972 pre-existing messages.
35974 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
35975 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
35976 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
35977 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
35978 one level of expansion anyway.
35982 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
35983 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
35984 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
35985 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
35986 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
35987 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
35989 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
35990 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
35994 domains = lists.example
35995 local_part_suffix = -request
35996 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
36001 domains = lists.example
36002 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
36003 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
36004 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
36007 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
36012 domains = lists.example
36014 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
36016 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
36017 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
36018 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
36021 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
36022 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
36023 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
36024 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
36025 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
36026 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
36027 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
36028 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
36029 &"unrouteable address"& error.
36031 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
36032 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
36033 the address, giving a suitable error message.
36038 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
36040 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
36041 .cindex "envelope sender"
36042 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(https://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
36043 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
36044 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
36045 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
36046 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
36047 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
36049 .oindex &%errors_to%&
36050 .oindex &%return_path%&
36051 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
36052 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
36053 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
36054 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
36055 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
36056 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
36057 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
36063 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36064 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
36066 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
36067 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
36068 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
36069 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
36070 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
36071 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
36072 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
36075 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
36077 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
36078 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
36079 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
36080 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
36081 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
36082 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
36084 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
36085 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
36086 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
36087 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
36091 domains = ! +local_domains
36093 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36094 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
36097 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
36098 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
36099 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
36100 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
36103 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
36104 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
36105 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
36106 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
36107 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
36111 domains = ! +local_domains
36112 transport = remote_smtp
36114 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
36115 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
36118 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
36119 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
36120 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
36121 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
36124 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
36125 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
36126 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
36127 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
36128 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
36129 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
36137 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
36138 .cindex "virtual domains"
36139 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
36140 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
36144 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
36145 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
36146 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
36148 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
36149 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
36150 have login accounts on that host.
36153 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
36154 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
36155 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
36156 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
36157 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
36158 to a router of this form:
36162 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
36163 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
36166 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
36167 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
36168 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
36169 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
36170 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
36171 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
36173 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias filenames
36174 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
36175 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
36176 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
36178 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
36179 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
36180 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
36184 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
36185 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
36186 transport = my_mailboxes
36188 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
36189 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
36190 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
36191 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
36192 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
36196 driver = appendfile
36197 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
36200 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
36201 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
36203 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
36204 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
36205 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
36206 information about the domains.
36210 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
36211 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
36212 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
36213 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
36214 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
36215 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
36216 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
36217 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
36218 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
36219 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
36220 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
36221 example, consider this router:
36226 file = $home/.forward
36227 local_part_suffix = -*
36228 local_part_suffix_optional
36231 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
36232 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
36233 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
36234 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
36236 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
36237 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
36240 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
36241 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
36242 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
36243 control over which suffixes are valid.
36245 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
36246 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
36252 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
36253 local_part_suffix = -*
36254 local_part_suffix_optional
36257 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
36258 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
36259 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
36260 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
36261 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
36265 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
36266 .cindex "vacation processing"
36267 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
36268 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
36269 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
36270 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
36271 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
36274 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
36275 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
36276 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
36277 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
36279 spqr, vacation-spqr
36282 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
36283 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
36284 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
36285 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
36286 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
36290 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
36291 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
36295 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
36296 .cindex "message" "copying every"
36297 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
36298 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
36299 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
36300 each day's messages.
36302 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
36303 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
36304 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
36305 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
36309 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
36310 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
36311 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
36312 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
36313 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
36314 permanently connected.
36316 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
36317 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
36318 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
36321 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
36322 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
36323 host to remain in Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
36324 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
36325 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
36326 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
36327 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
36328 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
36330 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
36331 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
36332 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
36333 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
36334 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
36335 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
36338 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
36339 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
36340 intermittent host. For example:
36342 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
36344 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
36345 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
36346 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
36347 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
36348 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
36349 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
36352 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
36353 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
36354 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
36355 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
36356 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
36357 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
36358 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
36362 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
36363 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
36364 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
36365 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
36366 delivered immediately.
36368 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
36369 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
36370 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
36371 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
36372 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
36373 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
36374 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
36375 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
36376 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
36377 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
36378 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
36379 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
36380 single SMTP connection.
36384 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36385 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36387 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
36388 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
36389 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
36390 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
36391 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
36392 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
36393 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
36394 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
36395 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
36396 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
36399 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
36400 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
36401 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
36402 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
36403 email is not desirable.
36405 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
36406 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
36407 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
36408 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
36409 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
36410 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
36411 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
36413 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
36414 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
36415 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
36416 before sending a message to the smart host.
36418 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
36419 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
36420 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
36422 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
36423 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
36424 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
36425 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
36426 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
36427 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
36428 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
36430 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
36434 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
36435 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
36437 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
36438 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
36439 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
36440 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
36441 successful, a zero return code is given.
36443 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
36444 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
36445 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
36446 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
36447 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
36450 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
36451 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
36452 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
36454 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
36455 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
36456 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
36457 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
36458 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
36460 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
36461 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
36462 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
36464 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
36465 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
36466 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
36467 are ever generated.
36469 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
36471 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
36472 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
36473 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
36476 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
36477 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
36478 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
36479 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
36480 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
36481 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
36486 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36487 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36489 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
36490 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
36491 .cindex "log" "types of"
36492 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
36497 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
36498 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
36499 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
36500 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
36501 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
36502 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
36503 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
36504 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
36506 .cindex "reject log"
36507 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
36508 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
36509 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
36510 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
36511 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
36512 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
36513 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
36514 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
36515 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
36518 .cindex "panic log"
36519 .cindex "system log"
36520 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
36521 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
36522 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
36523 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
36524 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
36525 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
36526 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
36527 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
36528 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
36531 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
36532 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
36533 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
36535 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
36538 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
36539 ways of changing this:
36542 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
36547 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
36549 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
36552 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
36556 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
36557 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
36558 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
36559 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
36560 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
36561 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
36566 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
36567 .cindex "log" "destination"
36568 .cindex "log" "to file"
36569 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
36571 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
36572 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
36573 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
36574 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
36575 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
36576 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
36577 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
36579 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
36580 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the runtime
36581 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
36582 references to the host name:
36584 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
36586 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
36587 rather than at runtime, because then the setting is available right from the
36588 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
36589 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
36590 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
36593 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
36594 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
36595 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
36596 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
36597 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
36598 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
36599 implying the use of a default path.
36601 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
36602 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
36603 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
36604 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
36605 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
36606 equivalent to the setting:
36608 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
36610 If you do not specify anything at build time or runtime,
36611 or if you unset the option at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
36612 that is where the logs are written.
36614 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log filenames
36615 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
36617 Here are some examples of possible settings:
36619 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
36620 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
36621 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
36622 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
36624 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
36629 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
36630 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
36631 .cindex "cycling logs"
36632 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
36633 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
36634 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
36635 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
36636 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
36637 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
36638 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
36640 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
36641 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
36642 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
36643 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
36644 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
36645 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
36646 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
36647 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
36648 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
36649 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
36650 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
36655 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
36656 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
36657 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
36658 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
36659 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
36660 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
36661 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
36662 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
36664 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
36665 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
36666 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
36667 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
36669 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
36670 examples of names generated by the above examples:
36672 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
36673 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
36674 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
36675 /var/log/exim/main.200212
36677 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
36678 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
36679 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
36680 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
36682 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
36683 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
36684 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
36685 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
36686 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
36687 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
36690 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36691 /var/log/exim-panic.log
36692 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36693 /var/log/exim/panic
36697 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
36698 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
36699 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
36700 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
36701 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
36702 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
36703 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
36704 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
36705 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
36706 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
36707 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
36708 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
36709 the time and host name to each line.
36710 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
36713 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
36715 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
36717 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
36720 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
36721 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
36722 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
36723 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
36725 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
36726 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
36727 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
36728 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
36729 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
36730 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
36731 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
36732 RFC 3164, you should set
36734 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
36736 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
36737 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
36739 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
36740 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
36741 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
36742 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
36743 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
36744 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
36745 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
36746 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
36747 name, and pid as added by syslog:
36749 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
36750 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
36751 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
36752 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
36755 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
36758 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
36759 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
36760 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
36761 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
36763 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
36764 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
36765 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
36766 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
36767 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
36768 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
36770 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
36771 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
36772 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
36775 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
36777 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
36778 without modification.
36780 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
36781 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
36782 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
36787 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
36788 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
36789 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
36790 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
36791 timestamp. The flags are:
36793 &`<=`& message arrival
36794 &`(=`& message fakereject
36795 &`=>`& normal message delivery
36796 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
36797 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
36798 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
36799 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
36800 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
36804 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
36805 .cindex "log" "reception line"
36806 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
36807 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
36808 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
36810 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
36811 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
36812 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
36814 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
36815 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
36816 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
36820 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
36824 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
36825 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
36826 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
36827 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
36828 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
36829 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
36830 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
36831 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
36832 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
36833 name in parentheses.
36835 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
36836 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
36837 the log containing text like these examples:
36839 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
36840 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
36842 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
36845 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
36846 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
36849 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
36850 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
36851 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
36852 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
36853 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
36854 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
36855 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
36856 suite that was used.
36858 .cindex log protocol
36859 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
36860 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
36861 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
36862 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
36863 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
36864 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
36865 authenticator name.
36867 .cindex "size" "of message"
36868 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
36869 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
36870 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
36871 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
36874 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
36875 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
36879 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
36880 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
36881 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
36882 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
36883 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
36884 to fit it on the page:
36886 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
36887 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
36888 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
36889 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
36890 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
36892 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
36893 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
36894 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
36895 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
36896 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
36898 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
36899 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
36900 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
36901 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
36903 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
36904 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
36906 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
36908 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
36909 parentheses afterwards.
36911 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
36912 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
36913 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
36914 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
36915 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
36916 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
36917 When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
36918 DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
36919 will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
36920 TLS cipher information is still available.
36922 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
36923 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
36924 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
36925 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
36926 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
36928 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
36929 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
36931 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
36932 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
36935 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
36936 .cindex "discarded messages"
36937 .cindex "message" "discarded"
36938 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
36939 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
36940 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
36942 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
36943 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
36945 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
36946 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
36948 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
36949 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
36953 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
36954 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
36956 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
36957 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
36959 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
36960 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
36961 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
36963 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
36964 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
36966 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
36967 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
36968 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
36972 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
36973 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
36974 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
36975 following form is logged:
36977 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
36978 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
36980 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
36981 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
36983 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
36984 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
36985 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
36986 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
36987 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
36989 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
36990 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
36991 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
36992 flagged with &`**`&.
36996 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
36997 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
36998 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
36999 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
37000 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
37004 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
37007 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
37009 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
37010 at the end of its processing.
37015 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
37016 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
37017 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
37018 the following table:
37020 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
37021 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
37022 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37023 &`CV `& certificate verification status
37024 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37025 &`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
37026 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
37027 &`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37028 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
37029 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
37030 &`H `& host name and IP address
37031 &`I `& local interface used
37032 &`id `& message id (from header) for incoming message
37033 &`K `& CHUNKING extension used
37034 &`L `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: PIPELINING extension used
37035 &`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
37036 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
37037 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
37038 &`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
37039 &`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
37040 &`Q `& alternate queue name
37041 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
37042 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
37043 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
37044 &` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
37045 &`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
37046 &`S `& size of message in bytes
37047 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
37048 &`ST `& shadow transport name
37049 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
37050 &`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
37051 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
37052 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
37053 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
37057 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
37058 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
37059 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
37062 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
37063 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
37064 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
37065 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
37066 during the first delivery attempt.
37068 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
37069 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
37070 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
37072 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
37073 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
37074 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
37075 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
37076 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
37079 .cindex "error" "ignored"
37080 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
37083 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
37084 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
37086 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
37087 failed. The delivery was discarded.
37089 A delivery set up by a router configured with
37090 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
37091 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
37095 failed. The delivery was discarded.
37098 .cindex DKIM "log line"
37099 &'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
37100 logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
37107 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
37108 .cindex "log" "selectors"
37109 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
37110 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
37111 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
37114 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
37116 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
37117 selection marked by asterisks:
37119 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
37120 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
37121 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
37122 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
37123 &` arguments `& command line arguments
37124 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
37125 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
37126 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
37127 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
37128 &`*dkim `& DKIM verified domain on <= lines
37129 &` dkim_verbose `& separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature
37130 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
37131 &` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37132 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
37133 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
37134 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
37135 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
37136 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
37137 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
37138 &` millisec `& millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times
37139 &`*msg_id `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value
37140 &` msg_id_created `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value when one had to be added
37141 &` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
37142 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
37143 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
37144 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
37145 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
37146 &` pid `& Exim process id
37147 &` pipelining `& PIPELINING use, on <= and => lines
37148 &` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
37149 &` receive_time `& time taken to receive message
37150 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
37151 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
37152 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
37153 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
37154 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
37155 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
37156 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
37157 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
37158 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
37159 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
37160 &` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
37161 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
37162 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
37163 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
37164 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
37165 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
37166 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
37167 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
37168 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
37169 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
37170 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
37171 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
37173 &` all `& all of the above
37175 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
37176 section &<<SECID99>>&
37178 More details on each of these items follows:
37182 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
37183 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
37184 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
37185 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
37186 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
37187 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
37189 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
37190 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
37191 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
37192 this log selector is set.
37194 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
37195 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
37196 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
37197 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
37198 such users cannot access the log).
37200 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
37201 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
37202 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
37203 parentheses between them.
37205 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
37206 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
37207 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
37208 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
37209 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
37210 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
37211 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
37212 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
37213 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
37214 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
37215 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
37216 between the caller and Exim.
37218 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
37219 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
37220 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
37222 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
37223 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
37224 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
37225 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
37226 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
37227 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
37229 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
37230 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
37231 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
37232 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37233 precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
37235 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
37236 .cindex "size" "of message"
37237 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
37238 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
37240 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
37241 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
37242 &%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
37243 verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
37245 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
37246 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
37247 &%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
37249 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
37250 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
37251 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
37252 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
37253 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
37256 .cindex dnssec logging
37257 &%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
37258 dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
37259 For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
37260 It does not cover helo-name verification.
37261 For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
37263 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
37264 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
37265 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
37266 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
37267 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
37268 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
37270 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
37271 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
37272 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
37273 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
37274 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
37276 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
37277 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
37278 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
37279 client's ident port times out.
37281 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
37282 .cindex "log" "local interface"
37283 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
37284 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
37285 .cindex "interface" "logging"
37286 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
37287 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
37288 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
37289 added to other SMTP log lines, for example, &"SMTP connection from"&, to
37290 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
37291 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
37293 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
37294 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
37295 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
37296 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
37297 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
37298 on a proxied connection
37299 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
37300 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
37302 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
37303 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
37304 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
37305 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
37306 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
37307 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
37308 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
37309 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
37310 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
37311 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
37312 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
37314 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
37315 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
37316 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
37318 .cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
37319 .cindex millisecond logging
37320 .cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
37321 &%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
37322 appended to the seconds value.
37325 .cindex "log" "message id"
37326 &%msg_id%&: The value of the Message-ID: header.
37328 &%msg_id_created%&: The value of the Message-ID: header, when one had to be created.
37329 This will be either because the message is a bounce, or was submitted locally
37330 (submission mode) without one.
37331 The field identifier will have an asterix appended: &"id*="&.
37334 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
37335 .cindex "log" "local interface"
37336 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
37337 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
37338 .cindex "interface" "logging"
37339 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
37340 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
37341 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
37342 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
37344 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
37345 .cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
37346 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
37347 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
37348 containing => tags) following the IP address.
37349 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
37350 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
37351 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
37352 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
37353 local port is a random ephemeral port.
37355 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
37356 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
37357 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
37358 immediately after the time and date.
37360 .cindex log pipelining
37361 .cindex pipelining "logging outgoing"
37362 &%pipelining%&: A field is added to delivery and accept
37363 log lines when the ESMTP PIPELINING extension was used.
37364 The field is a single "L".
37366 On accept lines, where PIPELINING was offered but not used by the client,
37367 the field has a minus appended.
37369 .cindex "log" "queue run"
37370 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
37371 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
37373 .cindex "log" "queue time"
37374 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
37375 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
37376 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
37377 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
37378 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
37379 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
37380 message has been successfully received.
37381 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37382 precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
37384 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
37385 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
37386 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
37387 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
37389 .cindex "log" "receive duration"
37390 &%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
37391 perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
37392 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37393 precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
37395 .cindex "log" "recipients"
37396 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
37397 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
37398 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
37399 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
37401 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
37404 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
37405 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
37406 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
37407 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
37409 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
37410 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
37411 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
37412 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
37413 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
37415 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
37416 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
37417 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
37418 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
37421 .cindex "log" "return path"
37422 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
37423 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
37424 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
37425 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
37427 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
37428 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
37429 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
37430 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
37431 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
37433 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
37434 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
37435 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
37436 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
37439 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
37440 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
37443 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
37444 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
37445 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
37446 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
37448 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
37449 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
37451 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
37452 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
37453 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
37454 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
37455 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
37456 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
37459 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
37460 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
37461 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
37462 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
37463 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
37464 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
37465 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
37466 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
37467 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
37468 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
37470 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
37471 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
37472 reset if the daemon is restarted.
37473 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
37474 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
37475 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
37476 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
37477 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
37479 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
37480 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
37481 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
37482 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
37483 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
37484 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
37486 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
37487 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
37488 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
37489 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
37490 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
37491 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
37492 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
37493 already have their own log lines.
37495 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
37496 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
37497 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
37498 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
37499 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
37500 the same logging options.
37502 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
37503 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
37507 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
37508 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
37509 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
37510 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
37511 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
37513 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
37514 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
37515 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
37516 was accepted or used.
37518 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
37519 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
37520 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
37521 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
37522 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
37523 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
37524 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
37525 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
37527 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
37528 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
37529 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
37530 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
37531 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
37532 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
37533 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
37534 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
37535 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
37537 .cindex "log" "subject"
37538 .cindex "subject, logging"
37539 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
37540 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
37541 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
37542 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
37543 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
37545 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
37547 .cindex DANE logging
37548 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
37549 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
37551 using a CA trust anchor,
37552 &`CA=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
37553 and &`CV=no`& if not.
37555 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
37556 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
37557 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
37558 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
37560 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
37561 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
37562 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
37563 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
37564 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
37566 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
37567 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
37568 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
37569 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
37570 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
37572 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
37573 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
37574 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
37578 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
37579 .cindex "message" "log file for"
37580 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
37581 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
37582 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
37583 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
37584 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
37585 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
37586 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
37587 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
37588 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
37589 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
37590 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
37592 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
37593 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
37594 &%message_logs%& option false.
37600 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37601 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37603 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
37604 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
37605 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
37606 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
37607 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
37609 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
37610 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
37611 "list what Exim processes are doing"
37612 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
37613 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
37614 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
37615 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
37617 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
37618 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
37619 "extract statistics from the log"
37620 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
37621 "check address acceptance from given IP"
37622 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
37623 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
37624 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
37625 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
37626 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
37627 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
37630 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
37631 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
37632 &url(https://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
37637 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
37638 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
37639 .cindex "process, querying"
37641 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
37642 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
37643 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
37644 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
37645 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
37646 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
37647 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
37648 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
37650 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
37651 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
37652 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
37655 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
37656 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
37657 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
37658 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
37659 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
37662 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
37663 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
37664 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
37665 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
37667 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
37669 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
37670 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
37671 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
37672 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
37673 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
37674 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
37676 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
37677 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
37681 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
37682 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
37683 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
37684 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
37688 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
37692 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
37693 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
37695 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
37696 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
37699 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
37700 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37701 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
37705 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
37706 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37707 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
37709 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
37710 Match against the size field.
37712 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
37713 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
37715 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
37716 Match messages that are older than the given time.
37719 Match only frozen messages.
37722 Match only non-frozen messages.
37725 The following options control the format of the output:
37729 Display only the count of matching messages.
37732 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
37736 Display message ids only.
37739 Brief format &-- one line per message.
37742 Display messages in reverse order.
37745 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
37748 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
37752 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
37753 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
37754 .cindex "queue" "summary"
37755 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
37756 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages in the queue. Thus, you use it by
37757 running a command such as
37759 exim -bp | exiqsumm
37761 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
37762 it, as in the following example:
37764 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
37766 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
37767 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
37768 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
37769 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
37771 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
37772 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
37773 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
37774 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
37775 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
37776 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
37779 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
37780 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
37781 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
37782 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
37783 level"& addresses).
37788 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
37790 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
37791 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
37792 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
37793 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
37794 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
37795 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
37796 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
37797 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
37798 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
37799 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
37801 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
37803 If no log filenames are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
37805 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
37806 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
37807 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds in the queue.
37809 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
37810 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
37811 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
37812 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
37813 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
37815 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
37816 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
37817 regular expression.
37819 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
37820 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
37822 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
37823 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
37827 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
37828 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
37829 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
37830 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
37831 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
37832 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
37835 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
37836 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
37837 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
37838 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
37839 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
37842 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
37843 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
37844 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
37845 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
37846 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
37847 the &%--help%& option.
37850 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
37851 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
37852 .cindex "cycling logs"
37853 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
37854 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
37855 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
37856 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
37857 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
37858 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
37859 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
37861 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
37862 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
37864 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
37865 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
37866 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
37870 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the filenames get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
37871 the main log filename is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
37872 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
37873 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
37874 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
37875 logs are handled similarly.
37877 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
37878 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
37879 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
37880 any existing log files.
37882 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
37883 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
37884 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
37885 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
37886 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
37888 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
37890 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
37891 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
37895 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
37896 .cindex "statistics"
37897 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
37898 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
37899 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
37900 . --- 2018-09-07: LogReport's Lire appears to be dead; website is a Yahoo Japan
37901 . --- 404 error and everything else points to that.
37903 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
37904 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
37905 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
37906 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
37907 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
37909 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
37911 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
37912 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
37913 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
37914 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
37915 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
37916 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
37917 also produced per user.
37919 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
37920 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
37921 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
37922 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
37923 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
37925 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
37926 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
37927 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
37928 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
37929 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
37930 an entirely separate message.
37932 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
37933 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
37934 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
37935 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
37936 least one address that failed.
37938 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
37939 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
37940 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
37941 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent in the queue,
37942 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
37943 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
37944 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
37946 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
37947 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
37948 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
37950 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
37951 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
37952 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
37954 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
37957 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
37958 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
37959 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
37960 .cindex "checking access"
37961 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
37962 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
37963 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
37964 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
37965 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
37966 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
37968 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
37969 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
37971 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
37973 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
37974 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
37975 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
37976 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
37979 550 Relay not permitted
37981 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
37982 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
37983 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
37984 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
37987 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
37988 -f himself@there.example
37990 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
37991 mandatory arguments.
37993 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
37994 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
37995 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
37999 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
38000 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
38001 .cindex "building DBM files"
38002 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
38003 .cindex "lower casing"
38004 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
38005 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
38006 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
38007 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
38008 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
38009 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
38011 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
38012 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
38013 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
38014 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
38017 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
38018 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
38019 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
38023 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
38024 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two
38025 filenames must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions
38026 create a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
38028 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
38030 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
38031 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
38033 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
38034 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
38035 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
38036 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
38037 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
38038 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the filename.
38040 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
38041 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
38042 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
38043 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
38044 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
38045 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
38046 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
38052 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
38053 .cindex "retry" "times"
38054 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
38055 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
38056 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
38057 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
38058 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
38059 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
38060 output. For example:
38062 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
38063 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
38064 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38065 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38066 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
38067 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
38068 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
38069 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
38070 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
38071 past final cutoff time
38073 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
38074 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
38075 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
38076 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
38077 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
38078 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
38081 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
38082 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
38083 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
38084 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
38085 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
38086 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
38090 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
38091 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
38092 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
38093 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
38094 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
38095 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
38096 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
38099 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
38101 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
38104 &'callout'&: the callout cache
38106 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
38108 &'misc'&: other hints data
38111 The &'misc'& database is used for
38114 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
38116 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
38117 &(smtp)& transport)
38119 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
38125 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
38126 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
38127 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
38128 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
38129 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
38131 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
38133 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
38135 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
38136 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
38138 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
38139 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
38140 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
38141 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
38142 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
38143 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
38144 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
38145 and a textual description of the error.
38147 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
38148 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
38149 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
38152 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
38153 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
38154 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
38155 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
38156 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
38157 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
38162 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
38163 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
38164 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
38165 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
38166 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
38167 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
38168 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
38169 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
38170 updated sufficiently often.
38172 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
38173 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
38174 the retry database:
38176 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
38178 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
38179 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
38180 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
38181 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
38182 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
38183 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
38184 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
38185 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
38186 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
38187 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
38188 whenever it removes information from the database.
38190 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
38191 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
38192 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
38193 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
38194 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
38196 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
38197 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
38198 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
38199 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
38200 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
38201 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
38202 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
38205 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
38206 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
38211 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
38212 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
38213 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
38214 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
38215 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
38216 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
38217 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
38220 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
38221 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
38222 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
38223 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
38224 by new data, for example:
38228 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
38229 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
38230 used as optional separators.
38235 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
38236 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
38237 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
38238 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
38239 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
38240 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
38241 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
38242 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
38243 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
38244 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
38245 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
38246 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
38247 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
38251 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
38254 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
38257 .vitem &%-interval%&
38258 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
38259 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
38261 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
38262 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
38265 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
38268 Suppress verification output.
38270 .vitem &%-retries%&
38271 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
38272 the lock (default 10).
38274 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
38275 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
38276 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
38277 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
38280 .vitem &%-timeout%&
38281 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
38282 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
38283 default), a non-blocking call is used.
38286 Generate verbose output.
38289 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
38290 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
38291 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
38292 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
38293 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
38294 file does not last forever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
38295 more than 30 minutes old.
38297 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
38298 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
38299 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
38300 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
38301 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
38302 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
38304 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
38305 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
38306 suppresses all output except error messages.
38310 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
38312 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
38314 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
38315 <&'some commands'&>
38318 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
38319 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
38322 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
38323 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
38325 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
38326 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
38330 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38331 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38333 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
38334 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
38335 .cindex "X-windows"
38336 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
38337 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
38338 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
38339 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
38340 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
38341 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
38342 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
38343 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
38347 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
38348 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
38349 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
38350 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
38351 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
38352 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
38353 parameters are for.
38355 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
38356 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
38357 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
38359 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
38361 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
38362 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
38363 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
38364 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
38365 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
38367 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
38368 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
38370 Eximon*background: gray94
38372 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
38373 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
38374 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
38375 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
38376 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
38377 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
38378 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
38381 Eximon*highlight: gray
38384 .cindex "admin user"
38385 In order to see the contents of messages in the queue, and to operate on them,
38386 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
38388 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
38389 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
38390 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
38391 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
38392 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
38394 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
38395 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
38396 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
38397 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
38398 different parts of the display.
38403 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
38404 .cindex "stripchart"
38405 The first stripchart is always a count of messages in the queue. Its name can
38406 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
38407 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
38408 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
38409 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
38410 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
38411 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
38412 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
38413 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
38415 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
38416 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
38417 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
38418 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
38420 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
38421 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
38422 to a single partition.
38424 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
38425 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
38426 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
38427 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
38428 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
38429 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
38430 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
38435 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
38436 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
38437 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
38438 .cindex "window size"
38439 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
38440 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
38441 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
38442 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
38443 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
38444 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
38446 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
38447 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
38448 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
38449 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
38451 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
38452 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
38453 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
38454 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
38455 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
38456 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38458 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
38459 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
38460 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38464 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
38465 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
38466 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
38467 the main log is maintained.
38468 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
38469 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
38470 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
38471 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
38472 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
38474 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
38475 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
38476 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
38477 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
38478 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
38479 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
38480 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
38481 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
38482 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
38483 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
38484 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38486 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
38487 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
38488 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
38489 It cannot go further back up the log.
38491 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
38492 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
38493 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
38494 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
38495 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
38496 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
38498 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
38499 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
38500 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
38501 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
38502 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
38503 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
38505 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
38506 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
38507 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
38508 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
38509 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
38510 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
38511 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
38512 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
38513 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
38518 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
38519 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
38520 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
38521 are in the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
38522 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
38523 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
38524 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
38525 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
38526 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
38527 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
38529 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
38530 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages in the queue. To help
38531 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
38532 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
38533 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
38534 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
38535 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
38537 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
38538 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
38539 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
38540 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
38541 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
38542 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
38543 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
38545 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
38546 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
38547 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
38548 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
38550 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
38551 time it has been in the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
38552 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
38553 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
38554 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
38555 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
38556 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
38559 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
38560 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
38562 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
38563 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
38564 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
38565 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
38566 display is updated.
38570 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
38571 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
38572 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
38573 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
38574 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
38577 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
38578 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
38579 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
38580 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
38581 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
38583 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
38585 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
38589 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
38590 in a new text window.
38592 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
38593 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
38594 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
38596 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
38597 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
38598 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
38599 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at runtime.
38601 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
38602 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
38603 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
38604 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
38605 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
38607 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
38608 that the message be frozen.
38610 .cindex "thawing messages"
38611 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
38612 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
38613 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
38614 that the message be thawed.
38616 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
38617 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
38618 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
38619 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
38621 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
38622 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
38625 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
38626 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
38627 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
38628 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
38629 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
38630 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
38631 which case no action is taken.
38633 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
38634 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
38635 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
38636 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
38637 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
38638 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
38639 case no action is taken.
38641 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
38642 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
38644 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
38645 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
38646 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
38647 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
38648 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
38649 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
38650 the address is qualified with that domain.
38653 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
38654 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
38655 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
38656 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
38657 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
38658 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
38659 if no output is generated.
38661 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
38662 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
38663 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
38664 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
38666 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
38667 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
38668 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
38675 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38676 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38678 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
38679 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
38680 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
38681 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
38683 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
38684 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
38685 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
38686 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
38687 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
38688 its security as compared with other MTAs.
38690 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
38691 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
38692 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
38693 as soon as possible.
38696 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
38697 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
38698 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
38699 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
38700 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
38701 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
38704 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
38705 start of any filenames used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these
38706 filenames are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if
38707 the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
38708 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
38709 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
38711 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
38712 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
38713 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
38714 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
38717 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
38718 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
38719 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
38720 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
38721 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
38722 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
38723 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
38724 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
38725 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
38729 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
38730 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
38731 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
38732 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
38733 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
38734 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
38735 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
38737 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
38740 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
38741 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
38742 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
38743 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
38744 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
38749 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
38751 .cindex "root privilege"
38752 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
38753 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
38754 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
38755 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
38756 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
38757 is required for two things:
38760 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
38761 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
38764 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
38765 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
38769 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
38770 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
38771 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
38772 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
38773 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
38774 group"&. Their values can be changed by the runtime configuration, though this
38775 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
38776 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
38778 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
38779 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
38780 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
38782 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
38783 uid and gid in the following cases:
38788 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
38789 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
38790 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
38791 the calling process.
38792 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
38793 option may not be used at all.
38794 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
38795 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
38796 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
38801 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
38802 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
38805 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
38806 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
38807 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
38808 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
38809 testing address verification
38812 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
38815 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
38816 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
38819 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
38822 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
38823 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
38824 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
38825 will be used during message reception.
38827 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
38828 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
38830 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
38831 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
38832 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
38833 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
38834 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
38835 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
38836 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
38837 generating bounce and warning messages.
38839 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
38840 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
38841 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
38842 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
38844 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
38845 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
38851 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
38852 .cindex "privilege, running without"
38853 .cindex "unprivileged running"
38854 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
38855 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
38856 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
38857 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
38858 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
38859 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
38860 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
38864 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
38865 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
38866 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
38867 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
38869 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
38870 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
38871 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
38872 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
38873 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
38875 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
38876 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
38877 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
38880 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
38881 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
38882 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
38884 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
38885 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
38886 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
38887 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
38888 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
38889 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
38890 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
38891 address this problem at this time.
38893 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
38894 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
38895 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
38896 be used in the most straightforward way.
38898 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
38899 number of restrictions on what you can do:
38902 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
38903 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
38904 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
38905 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
38906 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
38908 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
38909 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
38911 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
38912 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
38913 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
38914 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
38916 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
38917 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
38920 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
38921 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
38922 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
38924 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
38925 owned by the Exim user.
38927 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
38928 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
38929 mailboxes need to be created manually.
38934 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
38935 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
38936 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
38937 gives more security at essentially no cost.
38939 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
38940 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
38945 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
38946 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
38947 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
38951 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
38952 .cindex "security" "local commands"
38953 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
38954 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
38955 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
38956 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
38957 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
38960 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
38961 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
38962 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
38963 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
38964 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
38966 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
38967 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
38968 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
38969 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
38970 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
38971 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
38972 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
38974 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
38975 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
38976 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
38978 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
38979 taint checking might apply to their usage.
38981 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
38982 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
38983 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
38985 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
38986 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
38987 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
38989 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
38990 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
38991 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
38992 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
38998 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
38999 .cindex "security" "data sources"
39000 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
39001 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
39002 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
39003 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
39004 are some issues to be aware of:
39007 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
39009 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
39011 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
39012 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
39013 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
39014 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
39015 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
39016 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
39019 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
39020 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
39021 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
39023 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
39024 expected to yield one result.
39030 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
39031 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
39032 .cindex "IP source routing"
39033 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
39034 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
39035 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
39036 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
39040 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
39041 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
39042 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
39047 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
39048 .cindex "trusted users"
39049 .cindex "admin user"
39050 .cindex "privileged user"
39051 .cindex "user" "trusted"
39052 .cindex "user" "admin"
39053 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
39054 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
39055 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
39056 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
39057 permit a remote host to be specified.
39060 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
39061 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
39062 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
39063 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
39064 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
39065 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
39067 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
39068 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
39069 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
39070 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
39071 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
39073 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
39074 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
39075 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
39076 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
39077 includes the contents of files on the spool.
39081 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
39082 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
39083 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
39084 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
39085 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
39086 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
39088 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
39089 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
39090 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
39091 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
39092 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
39093 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
39096 By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
39097 introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
39098 setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
39099 This affects most of the checking options,
39100 such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
39103 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
39104 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
39105 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
39106 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
39107 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
39108 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
39112 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
39113 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
39114 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
39115 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
39116 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
39121 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
39122 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
39123 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
39124 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
39129 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
39130 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
39131 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
39132 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
39133 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
39137 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
39138 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
39139 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
39143 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
39144 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
39145 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
39146 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
39147 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
39148 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
39149 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
39151 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
39152 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
39157 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
39158 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
39159 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
39160 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
39164 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
39165 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
39166 enough to hold the result.
39167 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
39172 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39173 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39175 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
39176 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
39177 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
39178 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
39179 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
39180 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
39181 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
39182 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
39183 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
39184 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
39185 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
39186 themselves are recoverable.
39188 The file formats may be changed, or new formats added, at any release.
39189 Spool files are not intended as an interface to other programs
39190 and should not be used as such.
39192 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
39193 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
39194 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
39197 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
39198 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
39199 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
39200 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
39201 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
39203 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
39204 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
39205 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
39206 cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
39208 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
39210 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
39213 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
39215 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
39216 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
39217 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
39218 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
39219 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
39220 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
39221 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
39222 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
39225 Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
39226 These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
39227 They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
39228 relics of crashes and can be removed.
39230 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
39231 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
39232 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
39233 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
39234 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
39235 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
39236 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
39237 normally the Exim user.
39239 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
39240 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
39241 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
39242 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
39243 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
39244 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
39245 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
39246 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
39248 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
39249 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
39250 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
39251 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
39253 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
39254 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
39257 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39258 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
39259 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
39260 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
39261 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
39262 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
39263 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
39264 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
39265 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
39268 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39269 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
39270 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
39271 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
39272 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
39273 character. It may contain internal newlines.
39275 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39276 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
39277 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
39278 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
39279 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
39280 character. It may contain internal newlines.
39282 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
39283 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
39284 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
39286 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
39287 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
39288 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
39289 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
39290 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
39292 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
39293 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
39294 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
39295 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
39296 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
39298 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
39299 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
39300 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
39302 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
39303 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
39304 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
39306 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
39307 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
39308 present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
39310 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
39311 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
39312 present if the number is greater than zero.
39314 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
39315 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
39316 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
39318 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
39319 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
39320 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
39322 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
39323 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
39326 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
39327 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
39328 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
39331 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
39332 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
39333 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
39334 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
39336 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
39337 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
39338 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
39340 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
39341 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
39342 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
39343 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
39344 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
39345 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
39347 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
39348 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
39349 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
39350 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
39351 supplied by the remote host, if any.
39353 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
39354 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
39355 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
39356 generated messages.
39359 The message is from a local sender.
39361 .vitem &%-localerror%&
39362 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
39364 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
39365 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
39366 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
39367 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
39369 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
39370 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
39371 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
39374 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
39375 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
39378 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
39379 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
39380 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
39382 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
39383 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
39384 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
39386 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
39387 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
39388 of &$spam_score_int$&.
39390 .vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
39391 The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
39392 rather than Unix-format.
39393 The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
39394 There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
39396 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
39397 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
39398 certificate was verified by the server.
39400 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
39401 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
39402 name of the cipher suite that was used.
39404 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
39405 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
39406 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
39410 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
39411 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
39412 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
39413 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
39414 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
39415 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
39416 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
39417 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
39418 addresses are complete.
39420 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
39421 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
39422 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
39423 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
39424 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
39425 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
39427 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
39428 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
39429 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39431 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
39432 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
39433 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
39434 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
39438 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39439 darcy@austen.fict.example
39441 alice@wonderland.fict.example
39443 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
39444 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
39445 line is of the following form:
39447 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
39448 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
39450 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
39451 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
39452 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
39453 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
39454 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
39455 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
39456 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
39457 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
39460 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
39461 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
39462 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
39463 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
39464 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
39468 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
39469 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
39470 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
39471 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
39472 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
39473 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
39474 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
39475 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
39476 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
39477 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
39480 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
39481 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
39482 typical set of headers:
39484 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
39485 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
39486 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
39487 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
39488 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
39489 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
39490 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
39491 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39492 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
39493 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39494 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
39496 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
39497 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
39498 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
39499 .ecindex IIDforspo1
39500 .ecindex IIDforspo2
39501 .ecindex IIDforspo3
39503 .section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
39504 The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
39505 an ASCII newline character.
39506 However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
39507 can have an alternate format.
39508 This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
39509 The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
39510 suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
39511 ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
39512 Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
39513 There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
39515 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39516 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39518 .chapter "DKIM and SPF" "CHAPdkim" &&&
39519 "DKIM and SPF Support"
39522 .section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
39524 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
39525 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
39526 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
39527 DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
39529 As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
39530 by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
39531 any original DKIM signature.
39533 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
39534 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
39536 Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
39538 Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
39539 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
39540 (including transport filters)
39541 except cutthrough delivery.
39543 Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
39544 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
39545 different signature contexts.
39548 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
39549 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
39550 Exim's standard controls.
39552 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
39553 on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
39555 Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
39556 When set, for each signature in incoming email,
39557 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
39558 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
39560 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
39561 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
39562 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
39563 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
39566 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
39567 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
39568 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
39569 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
39573 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
39574 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
39576 For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
39577 Note that RFC 8301 (which does not cover EC keys) says:
39579 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39581 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
39582 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
39585 Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
39586 in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
39587 for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
39588 (equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
39589 but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
39591 Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
39592 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
39594 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
39595 The domain(s) you want to sign with.
39596 After expansion, this can be a list.
39597 Each element in turn,
39601 is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
39602 while expanding the remaining signing options.
39603 If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
39604 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
39606 .option dkim_selector smtp string list&!! unset
39607 This sets the key selector string.
39608 After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
39609 Each element in turn is put in the expansion
39610 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
39611 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
39612 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
39613 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
39615 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
39616 This sets the private key to use.
39617 You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
39618 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
39619 The result can either
39621 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
39623 with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
39624 be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
39626 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
39629 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
39630 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
39634 To generate keys under OpenSSL:
39636 openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
39637 openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
39639 Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
39640 for the DNS TXT record.
39641 See section 3.6 of RFC6376 for the record specification.
39645 certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
39646 certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
39649 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39651 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
39652 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
39656 EC keys for DKIM are defined by RFC 8463.
39658 They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
39659 As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
39660 (by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
39661 for some transition period.
39662 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
39665 OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
39667 openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
39668 certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
39671 To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
39673 openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
39674 certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
39678 Exim also supports an alternate format
39679 of Ed25519 keys in DNS which was a candidate during development
39680 of the standard, but not adopted.
39681 A future release will probably drop that support.
39684 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
39685 Can be set to any one of the supported hash methods, which are:
39687 &`sha1`& &-- should not be used, is old and insecure
39689 &`sha256`& &-- the default
39691 &`sha512`& &-- possibly more secure but less well supported
39694 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39696 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39699 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
39700 If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
39701 the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
39702 syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
39703 local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
39704 tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
39706 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
39707 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
39708 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
39709 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
39710 only supports signing with the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
39712 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
39713 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
39714 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
39715 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
39716 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
39719 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
39720 If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
39721 list of header names.
39722 Headers with these names, or the absence or such a header, will be included
39723 in the message signature.
39724 When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
39725 whether or not each header is present in the message.
39726 The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
39727 "_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS".
39729 If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
39730 will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
39731 message are signed first, if there are multiples.
39733 A name can be prefixed with either an '=' or a '+' character.
39734 If an '=' prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
39736 If a '+' prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
39737 will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
39738 name will be appended.
39740 .option dkim_timestamps smtp integer&!! unset
39741 This option controls the inclusion of timestamp information in the signature.
39742 If not set, no such information will be included.
39743 Otherwise, must be an unsigned number giving an offset in seconds from the current time
39745 (eg. 1209600 for two weeks);
39746 both creation (t=) and expiry (x=) tags will be included.
39748 RFC 6376 lists these tags as RECOMMENDED.
39751 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECDKIMVFY"
39752 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
39754 Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is done for all
39755 messages for which an ACL control &%dkim_disable_verify%& has not been set.
39756 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
39757 Performing verification sets up information used by the
39758 &$authresults$& expansion item.
39760 The results of that verification are then made available to the
39761 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL, which can examine and modify them.
39762 By default, this ACL is called once for each
39763 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
39764 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
39765 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
39766 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
39767 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
39769 To evaluate the verification result in the ACL
39770 a large number of expansion variables
39771 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
39772 runtime of the ACL.
39774 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
39775 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
39776 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
39777 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
39779 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
39780 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
39781 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
39782 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
39783 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
39784 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
39787 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
39789 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
39790 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
39791 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
39793 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
39795 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
39796 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
39797 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
39799 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
39802 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
39803 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
39806 Note that if the option is set using untrustworthy data
39807 (such as the From: header)
39808 care should be taken to force lowercase for domains
39809 and for the domain part if identities.
39810 The default setting can be regarded as trustworthy in this respect.
39813 If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
39814 for each matching signature.
39817 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
39818 available (from most to least important):
39822 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
39823 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
39824 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
39825 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
39827 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
39828 Within the DKIM ACL,
39829 a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
39831 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
39832 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39834 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
39835 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
39837 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
39838 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
39840 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
39843 This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
39844 This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
39845 hash-method or key-size:
39847 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
39848 condition = ${if eq {${length_3:$dkim_algo}}{rsa}}
39849 condition = ${if or {{eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
39850 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}}}}
39851 logwrite = NOTE: forcing DKIM verify fail (was pass)
39852 set dkim_verify_status = fail
39853 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
39856 So long as a DKIM ACL is defined (it need do no more than accept),
39857 after all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
39858 colon-separated list of the values after each run.
39859 This is maintained for the mime, prdr and data ACLs.
39861 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
39862 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
39863 "fail" or "invalid". One of
39865 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
39866 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
39868 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
39869 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
39871 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
39872 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
39873 means that the message body was modified in transit.
39875 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
39876 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
39877 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
39878 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
39881 This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
39883 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
39884 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
39885 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
39886 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39888 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
39889 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
39890 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
39891 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39893 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
39894 The key record selector string.
39896 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
39897 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
39898 If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
39899 may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
39900 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
39903 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39905 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39907 DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
39908 algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
39911 To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
39912 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
39914 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
39915 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
39917 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
39918 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
39920 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
39921 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
39922 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
39923 Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
39924 not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
39925 strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
39927 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
39928 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
39929 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
39930 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
39931 &*Note:*& The presence of the signature tag specifying a signing body length
39932 is one possible route to spoofing of valid DKIM signatures.
39933 A paranoid implementation might wish to regard signature where this variable
39934 shows less than the "no limit" return as being invalid.
39936 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
39937 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
39938 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
39940 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
39941 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
39942 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
39943 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
39944 integer size comparisons against this value.
39945 Note that Exim does not check this value.
39947 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
39948 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
39950 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
39951 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
39953 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
39954 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
39956 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
39957 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
39960 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
39961 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
39964 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
39965 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
39967 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
39968 Number of bits in the key.
39970 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39972 Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
39973 less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
39976 To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
39977 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
39978 As EC keys are much smaller, the check should only do this for RSA keys.
39982 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
39985 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
39986 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
39987 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
39988 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
39989 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
39992 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
39993 warn log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
39994 sender_domains = gmail.com
39995 dkim_signers = gmail.com
39999 Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
40000 for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
40002 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
40003 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
40004 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
40005 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
40008 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
40009 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
40010 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
40011 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
40014 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
40015 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
40016 for more information of what they mean.
40022 .section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
40023 .cindex SPF verification
40025 SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
40026 messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
40027 For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.openspf.org).
40028 . --- 2018-09-07: still not https
40030 Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
40031 This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
40033 SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
40034 &_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
40035 &url(https://www.libspf2.org/).
40036 There is no Exim involvement in the transmission of messages;
40037 publishing certain DNS records is all that is required.
40039 For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
40040 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
40041 Performing verification sets up information used by the
40042 &$authresults$& expansion item.
40045 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40046 .cindex ACL "spf condition"
40047 The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
40048 It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
40049 and will succeed for any matching outcome.
40053 The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
40056 The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
40057 domain in the envelope-from address.
40059 .vitem &%softfail%&
40060 The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
40064 The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
40067 The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
40068 published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
40069 its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
40071 .vitem &%permerror%&
40072 This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
40073 You may deny messages when this occurs.
40075 .vitem &%temperror%&
40076 This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
40077 SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
40080 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
40081 its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
40082 "fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
40083 short-circuit fashion.
40088 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
40089 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
40090 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
40091 Please see http://www.openspf.org/Why?scope=\
40092 ${if def:sender_address_domain {mfrom}{helo}};\
40093 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
40094 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
40095 ip=$sender_host_address
40098 When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
40101 .cindex SPF "verification variables"
40103 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
40104 .vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
40105 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
40106 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
40107 it for logging purposes.
40109 .vitem &$spf_received$&
40110 .vindex &$spf_received$&
40111 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header that can be
40112 added to the message. Please note that according to the SPF
40113 draft, this header must be added at the top of the header
40114 list. Please see section 10 on how you can do this.
40116 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
40117 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
40119 .vitem &$spf_result$&
40120 .vindex &$spf_result$&
40121 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
40122 one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror or
40125 .vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
40126 .vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
40127 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
40128 and required in order to obtain a result.
40130 .vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40131 .vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40132 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
40133 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
40137 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40138 .cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
40139 .cindex SPF "best guess"
40140 In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
40141 "Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
40142 SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
40144 Refer to &url(http://www.openspf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
40145 for a description of what it means.
40146 . --- 2018-09-07: still not https:
40148 To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
40149 of the spf one. For example:
40152 deny spf_guess = fail
40153 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
40156 In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
40157 should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
40158 is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
40161 When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
40162 variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
40164 Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
40165 what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
40166 &%spf_guess%& option.
40167 For example, the following:
40170 spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
40173 would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
40176 .cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
40178 A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
40179 address as the key and an IP address as the database:
40182 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
40185 The lookup will return the same result strings as can appear in
40186 &$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
40187 Currently, only IPv4 addresses are supported.
40192 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40193 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40195 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
40197 .cindex "proxy support"
40198 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
40200 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
40201 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
40204 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
40205 .cindex proxy inbound
40206 .cindex proxy "server side"
40207 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
40208 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
40210 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
40211 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
40212 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
40215 It was built on the HAProxy specification, found at
40216 &url(https://www.haproxy.org/download/1.8/doc/proxy-protocol.txt).
40218 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
40219 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
40220 to distribute load.
40221 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
40222 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
40223 There is no logging if a host passes or
40224 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
40225 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
40227 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
40228 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
40229 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
40230 Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
40231 automatically determines which version is in use.
40233 The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
40234 and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
40235 negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
40236 Exim and the proxy server.
40238 The following expansion variables are usable
40239 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
40242 &'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
40243 &'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
40244 &'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
40245 &'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
40246 &'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
40248 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
40249 there was a protocol error.
40250 The variables &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&
40251 will have values for the actual client system, not the proxy.
40253 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
40254 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
40255 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
40256 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
40257 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
40258 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
40259 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
40260 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
40261 A possible solution is:
40263 # Set max number of connections per host
40265 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
40266 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
40268 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
40269 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
40274 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
40275 .cindex proxy outbound
40276 .cindex proxy "client side"
40277 .cindex proxy SOCKS
40278 .cindex SOCKS proxy
40279 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
40280 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
40281 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
40284 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
40285 on an smtp transport.
40286 The option value is expanded and should then be a list
40287 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
40288 Each proxy specifier is a list
40289 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
40290 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
40292 Options are a string <name>=<value>.
40293 The list of options is in the following table:
40295 &'auth '& authentication method
40296 &'name '& authentication username
40297 &'pass '& authentication password
40299 &'tmo '& connection timeout
40301 &'weight '& selection bias
40304 More details on each of these options follows:
40307 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
40308 .cindex proxy authentication
40309 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
40310 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
40311 for access to the proxy.
40312 Default is &"none"&.
40314 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
40317 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
40320 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
40323 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
40326 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
40327 higher values being tried first.
40328 The default priority is 1.
40330 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
40331 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
40332 weighted by this value.
40333 The default value for selection bias is 1.
40336 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
40337 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
40338 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
40340 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
40341 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
40342 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
40343 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
40345 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40346 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40348 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
40349 "Internationalisation""
40350 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
40353 .cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
40355 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
40356 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
40357 Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
40359 If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
40360 instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
40361 requirement, upon libidn2.
40363 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
40364 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
40365 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
40366 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
40367 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
40368 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
40370 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
40371 international handling for the message is enabled and
40372 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
40374 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
40375 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
40376 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
40377 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
40379 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
40380 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
40381 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
40382 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
40384 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
40385 components expanded to a-label form,
40386 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
40389 .cindex log protocol
40390 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
40391 .cindex i18n logging
40392 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
40393 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
40395 The following expansion operators can be used:
40397 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
40398 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
40399 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
40400 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
40403 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
40404 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
40406 may use the following modifier:
40408 control = utf8_downconvert
40409 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
40411 This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
40412 a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
40413 Message Submission Agent context.
40414 If a value is appended it may be:
40416 &`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
40417 &`0 `& no downconversion
40418 &`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
40421 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
40422 is initially set to -1.
40424 The smtp transport has an option &%utf8_downconvert%&.
40425 If set it must expand to one of the three values described above,
40426 and it overrides any previously set value.
40429 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
40430 Configurations supporting these should inspect
40431 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
40433 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
40434 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
40435 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
40437 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
40438 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
40442 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
40443 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
40444 the following expansion operator can be used:
40446 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
40449 The string is converted from the charset specified by
40450 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
40451 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
40453 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
40454 with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
40455 (which has to be a single character)
40456 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
40457 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
40459 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
40460 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
40462 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
40463 by many other IMAP servers.
40467 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
40468 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
40469 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
40472 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
40473 must be representable in UTF-16.
40476 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40477 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40479 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
40483 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
40484 of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
40485 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
40486 processing actions.
40488 Most installations will never need to use Events.
40489 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
40490 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
40492 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
40493 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
40494 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
40496 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
40497 An example might look like:
40498 .cindex logging custom
40500 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
40501 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
40502 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
40503 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
40504 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
40505 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
40506 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
40507 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
40508 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
40512 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
40513 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
40514 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
40516 The current list of events is:
40518 &`dane:fail after transport `& per connection
40519 &`msg:complete after main `& per message
40520 &`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
40521 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
40522 &`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
40523 &`msg:host:defer after transport `& per attempt
40524 &`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
40525 &`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
40526 &`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
40527 &`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
40528 &`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
40529 &`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
40531 New event types may be added in future.
40533 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
40534 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
40535 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
40537 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
40538 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
40539 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
40541 The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
40542 should define the event action.
40544 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
40545 with the event type:
40547 &`dane:fail `& failure reason
40548 &`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
40549 &`msg:fail:internal `& failure reason
40550 &`msg:fail:delivery `& smtp error message
40551 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
40552 &`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
40553 &`msg:host:defer `& error string
40554 &`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
40555 &`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
40558 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
40560 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
40561 however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
40562 the course of its processing:
40564 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
40567 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
40568 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
40570 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
40571 a useful way of writing to the main log.
40573 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
40574 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
40575 following will be forced:
40577 &`tcp:connect `& do not connect
40578 &`tls:cert `& refuse verification
40579 &`smtp:connect `& close connection
40581 All other message types ignore the result string, and
40582 no other use is made of it.
40584 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
40585 then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
40588 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
40589 chain element received on the connection.
40590 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
40593 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40594 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40596 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
40597 "Adding drivers or lookups"
40598 .cindex "adding drivers"
40599 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
40600 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
40601 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
40602 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
40605 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
40606 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
40608 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
40610 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
40612 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
40613 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
40614 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
40616 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
40618 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
40621 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
40622 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
40624 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
40625 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
40626 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
40627 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
40628 simple form that most lookups have.
40630 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
40631 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
40632 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
40634 Edit &_OS/Makefile-Base_& adding a &_.o_& file for the predefined-macros, to the
40635 definition of OBJ_MACRO. Add a set of line to do the compile also.
40637 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
40640 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
40641 as for other drivers and lookups.
40644 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
40645 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
40646 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
40647 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
40648 searched using a binary chop procedure.
40650 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
40651 the interface that is expected.
40656 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40657 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40659 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40660 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
40661 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
40662 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
40664 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40669 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
40670 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
40674 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
40675 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
40676 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
40679 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40680 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////